PowerPC64 tls_get_addr_desc static support
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elf64-ppc.c
1 /* PowerPC64-specific support for 64-bit ELF.
2 Copyright (C) 1999-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Written by Linus Nordberg, Swox AB <info@swox.com>,
4 based on elf32-ppc.c by Ian Lance Taylor.
5 Largely rewritten by Alan Modra.
6
7 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
8
9 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
10 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
11 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
12 (at your option) any later version.
13
14 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
15 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
16 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
17 GNU General Public License for more details.
18
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
20 with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
21 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
22
23
24 /* The 64-bit PowerPC ELF ABI may be found at
25 http://www.linuxbase.org/spec/ELF/ppc64/PPC-elf64abi.txt, and
26 http://www.linuxbase.org/spec/ELF/ppc64/spec/book1.html */
27
28 #include "sysdep.h"
29 #include <stdarg.h>
30 #include "bfd.h"
31 #include "bfdlink.h"
32 #include "libbfd.h"
33 #include "elf-bfd.h"
34 #include "elf/ppc64.h"
35 #include "elf64-ppc.h"
36 #include "dwarf2.h"
37
38 /* All users of this file have bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, sec) == 1. */
39 #define OCTETS_PER_BYTE(ABFD, SEC) 1
40
41 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_ha_reloc
42 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
43 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_branch_reloc
44 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
45 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc
46 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
47 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc
48 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
49 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_sectoff_ha_reloc
50 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
51 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_toc_reloc
52 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
53 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_toc_ha_reloc
54 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
55 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_toc64_reloc
56 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
57 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc
58 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
59 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc
60 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
61 static bfd_vma opd_entry_value
62 (asection *, bfd_vma, asection **, bfd_vma *, bfd_boolean);
63
64 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM powerpc_elf64_le_vec
65 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME "elf64-powerpcle"
66 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf64_vec
67 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf64-powerpc"
68 #define ELF_ARCH bfd_arch_powerpc
69 #define ELF_TARGET_ID PPC64_ELF_DATA
70 #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE EM_PPC64
71 #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE 0x10000
72 #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE 0x1000
73 #define ELF_RELROPAGESIZE ELF_MAXPAGESIZE
74 #define elf_info_to_howto ppc64_elf_info_to_howto
75
76 #define elf_backend_want_got_sym 0
77 #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym 0
78 #define elf_backend_plt_alignment 3
79 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 1
80 #define elf_backend_got_header_size 8
81 #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro 1
82 #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections 1
83 #define elf_backend_can_refcount 1
84 #define elf_backend_rela_normal 1
85 #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt 1
86 #define elf_backend_default_execstack 0
87
88 #define bfd_elf64_mkobject ppc64_elf_mkobject
89 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_reloc_type_lookup ppc64_elf_reloc_type_lookup
90 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_reloc_name_lookup ppc64_elf_reloc_name_lookup
91 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data ppc64_elf_merge_private_bfd_data
92 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_print_private_bfd_data ppc64_elf_print_private_bfd_data
93 #define bfd_elf64_new_section_hook ppc64_elf_new_section_hook
94 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_link_hash_table_create ppc64_elf_link_hash_table_create
95 #define bfd_elf64_get_synthetic_symtab ppc64_elf_get_synthetic_symtab
96 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_link_just_syms ppc64_elf_link_just_syms
97 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_gc_sections ppc64_elf_gc_sections
98
99 #define elf_backend_object_p ppc64_elf_object_p
100 #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus ppc64_elf_grok_prstatus
101 #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo ppc64_elf_grok_psinfo
102 #define elf_backend_write_core_note ppc64_elf_write_core_note
103 #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections
104 #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol
105 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook ppc64_elf_add_symbol_hook
106 #define elf_backend_check_directives ppc64_elf_before_check_relocs
107 #define elf_backend_notice_as_needed ppc64_elf_notice_as_needed
108 #define elf_backend_archive_symbol_lookup ppc64_elf_archive_symbol_lookup
109 #define elf_backend_check_relocs ppc64_elf_check_relocs
110 #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible _bfd_elf_relocs_compatible
111 #define elf_backend_gc_keep ppc64_elf_gc_keep
112 #define elf_backend_gc_mark_dynamic_ref ppc64_elf_gc_mark_dynamic_ref
113 #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook ppc64_elf_gc_mark_hook
114 #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol ppc64_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol
115 #define elf_backend_hide_symbol ppc64_elf_hide_symbol
116 #define elf_backend_maybe_function_sym ppc64_elf_maybe_function_sym
117 #define elf_backend_always_size_sections ppc64_elf_func_desc_adjust
118 #define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections ppc64_elf_size_dynamic_sections
119 #define elf_backend_hash_symbol ppc64_elf_hash_symbol
120 #define elf_backend_init_index_section _bfd_elf_init_2_index_sections
121 #define elf_backend_action_discarded ppc64_elf_action_discarded
122 #define elf_backend_relocate_section ppc64_elf_relocate_section
123 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol
124 #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class ppc64_elf_reloc_type_class
125 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_sections
126 #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook ppc64_elf_output_symbol_hook
127 #define elf_backend_special_sections ppc64_elf_special_sections
128 #define elf_backend_merge_symbol_attribute ppc64_elf_merge_symbol_attribute
129 #define elf_backend_merge_symbol ppc64_elf_merge_symbol
130 #define elf_backend_get_reloc_section bfd_get_section_by_name
131
132 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
133 section. */
134 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
135
136 /* The size in bytes of an entry in the procedure linkage table. */
137 #define PLT_ENTRY_SIZE(htab) (htab->opd_abi ? 24 : 8)
138 #define LOCAL_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE(htab) (htab->opd_abi ? 16 : 8)
139
140 /* The initial size of the plt reserved for the dynamic linker. */
141 #define PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE(htab) (htab->opd_abi ? 24 : 16)
142
143 /* Offsets to some stack save slots. */
144 #define STK_LR 16
145 #define STK_TOC(htab) (htab->opd_abi ? 40 : 24)
146 /* This one is dodgy. ELFv2 does not have a linker word, so use the
147 CR save slot. Used only by optimised __tls_get_addr call stub,
148 relying on __tls_get_addr_opt not saving CR.. */
149 #define STK_LINKER(htab) (htab->opd_abi ? 32 : 8)
150
151 /* TOC base pointers offset from start of TOC. */
152 #define TOC_BASE_OFF 0x8000
153 /* TOC base alignment. */
154 #define TOC_BASE_ALIGN 256
155
156 /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block. */
157 #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
158 #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
159
160 /* .plt call stub instructions. The normal stub is like this, but
161 sometimes the .plt entry crosses a 64k boundary and we need to
162 insert an addi to adjust r11. */
163 #define STD_R2_0R1 0xf8410000 /* std %r2,0+40(%r1) */
164 #define ADDIS_R11_R2 0x3d620000 /* addis %r11,%r2,xxx@ha */
165 #define LD_R12_0R11 0xe98b0000 /* ld %r12,xxx+0@l(%r11) */
166 #define MTCTR_R12 0x7d8903a6 /* mtctr %r12 */
167 #define LD_R2_0R11 0xe84b0000 /* ld %r2,xxx+8@l(%r11) */
168 #define LD_R11_0R11 0xe96b0000 /* ld %r11,xxx+16@l(%r11) */
169 #define BCTR 0x4e800420 /* bctr */
170
171 #define ADDI_R11_R11 0x396b0000 /* addi %r11,%r11,off@l */
172 #define ADDI_R12_R11 0x398b0000 /* addi %r12,%r11,off@l */
173 #define ADDI_R12_R12 0x398c0000 /* addi %r12,%r12,off@l */
174 #define ADDIS_R2_R2 0x3c420000 /* addis %r2,%r2,off@ha */
175 #define ADDI_R2_R2 0x38420000 /* addi %r2,%r2,off@l */
176
177 #define XOR_R2_R12_R12 0x7d826278 /* xor %r2,%r12,%r12 */
178 #define ADD_R11_R11_R2 0x7d6b1214 /* add %r11,%r11,%r2 */
179 #define XOR_R11_R12_R12 0x7d8b6278 /* xor %r11,%r12,%r12 */
180 #define ADD_R2_R2_R11 0x7c425a14 /* add %r2,%r2,%r11 */
181 #define CMPLDI_R2_0 0x28220000 /* cmpldi %r2,0 */
182 #define BNECTR 0x4ca20420 /* bnectr+ */
183 #define BNECTR_P4 0x4ce20420 /* bnectr+ */
184
185 #define LD_R12_0R2 0xe9820000 /* ld %r12,xxx+0(%r2) */
186 #define LD_R11_0R2 0xe9620000 /* ld %r11,xxx+0(%r2) */
187 #define LD_R2_0R2 0xe8420000 /* ld %r2,xxx+0(%r2) */
188
189 #define LD_R2_0R1 0xe8410000 /* ld %r2,0(%r1) */
190 #define LD_R2_0R12 0xe84c0000 /* ld %r2,0(%r12) */
191 #define ADD_R2_R2_R12 0x7c426214 /* add %r2,%r2,%r12 */
192
193 #define LI_R11_0 0x39600000 /* li %r11,0 */
194 #define LIS_R2 0x3c400000 /* lis %r2,xxx@ha */
195 #define LIS_R11 0x3d600000 /* lis %r11,xxx@ha */
196 #define LIS_R12 0x3d800000 /* lis %r12,xxx@ha */
197 #define ADDIS_R2_R12 0x3c4c0000 /* addis %r2,%r12,xxx@ha */
198 #define ADDIS_R12_R2 0x3d820000 /* addis %r12,%r2,xxx@ha */
199 #define ADDIS_R12_R11 0x3d8b0000 /* addis %r12,%r11,xxx@ha */
200 #define ADDIS_R12_R12 0x3d8c0000 /* addis %r12,%r12,xxx@ha */
201 #define ORIS_R12_R12_0 0x658c0000 /* oris %r12,%r12,xxx@hi */
202 #define ORI_R11_R11_0 0x616b0000 /* ori %r11,%r11,xxx@l */
203 #define ORI_R12_R12_0 0x618c0000 /* ori %r12,%r12,xxx@l */
204 #define LD_R12_0R12 0xe98c0000 /* ld %r12,xxx@l(%r12) */
205 #define SLDI_R11_R11_34 0x796b1746 /* sldi %r11,%r11,34 */
206 #define SLDI_R12_R12_32 0x799c07c6 /* sldi %r12,%r12,32 */
207 #define LDX_R12_R11_R12 0x7d8b602a /* ldx %r12,%r11,%r12 */
208 #define ADD_R12_R11_R12 0x7d8b6214 /* add %r12,%r11,%r12 */
209 #define PADDI_R12_PC 0x0610000039800000ULL
210 #define PLD_R12_PC 0x04100000e5800000ULL
211 #define PNOP 0x0700000000000000ULL
212
213 /* __glink_PLTresolve stub instructions. We enter with the index in R0. */
214 #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE(htab) \
215 (8u + (htab->opd_abi ? 11 * 4 : 14 * 4))
216 /* 0: */
217 /* .quad plt0-1f */
218 /* __glink: */
219 #define MFLR_R12 0x7d8802a6 /* mflr %12 */
220 #define BCL_20_31 0x429f0005 /* bcl 20,31,1f */
221 /* 1: */
222 #define MFLR_R11 0x7d6802a6 /* mflr %11 */
223 /* ld %2,(0b-1b)(%11) */
224 #define MTLR_R12 0x7d8803a6 /* mtlr %12 */
225 #define ADD_R11_R2_R11 0x7d625a14 /* add %11,%2,%11 */
226 /* ld %12,0(%11) */
227 /* ld %2,8(%11) */
228 /* mtctr %12 */
229 /* ld %11,16(%11) */
230 /* bctr */
231 #define MFLR_R0 0x7c0802a6 /* mflr %r0 */
232 #define MTLR_R0 0x7c0803a6 /* mtlr %r0 */
233 #define SUB_R12_R12_R11 0x7d8b6050 /* subf %r12,%r11,%r12 */
234 #define ADDI_R0_R12 0x380c0000 /* addi %r0,%r12,0 */
235 #define SRDI_R0_R0_2 0x7800f082 /* rldicl %r0,%r0,62,2 */
236
237 /* Pad with this. */
238 #define NOP 0x60000000
239
240 /* Some other nops. */
241 #define CROR_151515 0x4def7b82
242 #define CROR_313131 0x4ffffb82
243
244 /* .glink entries for the first 32k functions are two instructions. */
245 #define LI_R0_0 0x38000000 /* li %r0,0 */
246 #define B_DOT 0x48000000 /* b . */
247
248 /* After that, we need two instructions to load the index, followed by
249 a branch. */
250 #define LIS_R0_0 0x3c000000 /* lis %r0,0 */
251 #define ORI_R0_R0_0 0x60000000 /* ori %r0,%r0,0 */
252
253 /* Instructions used by the save and restore reg functions. */
254 #define STD_R0_0R1 0xf8010000 /* std %r0,0(%r1) */
255 #define STD_R0_0R12 0xf80c0000 /* std %r0,0(%r12) */
256 #define LD_R0_0R1 0xe8010000 /* ld %r0,0(%r1) */
257 #define LD_R0_0R12 0xe80c0000 /* ld %r0,0(%r12) */
258 #define STFD_FR0_0R1 0xd8010000 /* stfd %fr0,0(%r1) */
259 #define LFD_FR0_0R1 0xc8010000 /* lfd %fr0,0(%r1) */
260 #define LI_R12_0 0x39800000 /* li %r12,0 */
261 #define STVX_VR0_R12_R0 0x7c0c01ce /* stvx %v0,%r12,%r0 */
262 #define LVX_VR0_R12_R0 0x7c0c00ce /* lvx %v0,%r12,%r0 */
263 #define MTLR_R0 0x7c0803a6 /* mtlr %r0 */
264 #define BLR 0x4e800020 /* blr */
265
266 /* Since .opd is an array of descriptors and each entry will end up
267 with identical R_PPC64_RELATIVE relocs, there is really no need to
268 propagate .opd relocs; The dynamic linker should be taught to
269 relocate .opd without reloc entries. */
270 #ifndef NO_OPD_RELOCS
271 #define NO_OPD_RELOCS 0
272 #endif
273
274 #ifndef ARRAY_SIZE
275 #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0]))
276 #endif
277
278 static inline int
279 abiversion (bfd *abfd)
280 {
281 return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC64_ABI;
282 }
283
284 static inline void
285 set_abiversion (bfd *abfd, int ver)
286 {
287 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC64_ABI;
288 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags |= ver & EF_PPC64_ABI;
289 }
290 \f
291 /* Relocation HOWTO's. */
292 /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple
293 field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is
294 always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative.
295 PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at
296 the LSB. For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24
297 and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here,
298 rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0. */
299 #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \
300 complain, special_func) \
301 HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0, \
302 complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func, \
303 #type, FALSE, 0, mask, pc_relative)
304
305 static reloc_howto_type *ppc64_elf_howto_table[(int) R_PPC64_max];
306
307 static reloc_howto_type ppc64_elf_howto_raw[] =
308 {
309 /* This reloc does nothing. */
310 HOW (R_PPC64_NONE, 3, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
311 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
312
313 /* A standard 32 bit relocation. */
314 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
315 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
316
317 /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
318 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
319 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR24, 2, 26, 0x03fffffc, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
320 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
321
322 /* A standard 16 bit relocation. */
323 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
324 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
325
326 /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow. */
327 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
328 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
329
330 /* Bits 16-31 of an address. */
331 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
332 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
333
334 /* Bits 16-31 of an address, plus 1 if the contents of the low 16
335 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
336 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
337 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
338
339 /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
340 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
341 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR14, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
342 ppc64_elf_branch_reloc),
343
344 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
345 indicate that the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two
346 bits must be zero. */
347 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
348 ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc),
349
350 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
351 indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower
352 two bits must be zero. */
353 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
354 ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc),
355
356 /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
357 HOW (R_PPC64_REL24, 2, 26, 0x03fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
358 ppc64_elf_branch_reloc),
359
360 /* A variant of R_PPC64_REL24, used when r2 is not the toc pointer. */
361 HOW (R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC, 2, 26, 0x03fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
362 ppc64_elf_branch_reloc),
363
364 /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
365 HOW (R_PPC64_REL14, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
366 ppc64_elf_branch_reloc),
367
368 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
369 the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two bits must be
370 zero. */
371 HOW (R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
372 ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc),
373
374 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
375 the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower two bits must
376 be zero. */
377 HOW (R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
378 ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc),
379
380 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the
381 symbol. */
382 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
383 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
384
385 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for
386 the symbol. */
387 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
388 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
389
390 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for
391 the symbol. */
392 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
393 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
394
395 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for
396 the symbol. */
397 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
398 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
399
400 /* This is used only by the dynamic linker. The symbol should exist
401 both in the object being run and in some shared library. The
402 dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the
403 shared library into the object, because the object being
404 run has to have the data at some particular address. */
405 HOW (R_PPC64_COPY, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
406 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
407
408 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR64, but used when setting global offset table
409 entries. */
410 HOW (R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
411 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
412
413 /* Created by the link editor. Marks a procedure linkage table
414 entry for a symbol. */
415 HOW (R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
416 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
417
418 /* Used only by the dynamic linker. When the object is run, this
419 doubleword64 is set to the load address of the object, plus the
420 addend. */
421 HOW (R_PPC64_RELATIVE, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
422 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
423
424 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR32, but may be unaligned. */
425 HOW (R_PPC64_UADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
426 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
427
428 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16, but may be unaligned. */
429 HOW (R_PPC64_UADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
430 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
431
432 /* 32-bit PC relative. */
433 HOW (R_PPC64_REL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
434 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
435
436 /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table. */
437 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
438 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
439
440 /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
441 FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTREL32 not supported. */
442 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
443 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
444
445 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for
446 the symbol. */
447 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
448 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
449
450 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for
451 the symbol. */
452 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
453 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
454
455 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for
456 the symbol. */
457 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
458 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
459
460 /* 16-bit section relative relocation. */
461 HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
462 ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc),
463
464 /* Like R_PPC64_SECTOFF, but no overflow warning. */
465 HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
466 ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc),
467
468 /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation. */
469 HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
470 ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc),
471
472 /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation. */
473 HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
474 ppc64_elf_sectoff_ha_reloc),
475
476 /* Like R_PPC64_REL24 without touching the two least significant bits. */
477 HOW (R_PPC64_REL30, 2, 30, 0xfffffffc, 2, TRUE, dont,
478 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
479
480 /* Relocs in the 64-bit PowerPC ELF ABI, not in the 32-bit ABI. */
481
482 /* A standard 64-bit relocation. */
483 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
484 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
485
486 /* The bits 32-47 of an address. */
487 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, FALSE, dont,
488 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
489
490 /* The bits 32-47 of an address, plus 1 if the contents of the low
491 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
492 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, FALSE, dont,
493 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
494
495 /* The bits 48-63 of an address. */
496 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, FALSE, dont,
497 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
498
499 /* The bits 48-63 of an address, plus 1 if the contents of the low
500 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
501 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, FALSE, dont,
502 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
503
504 /* Like ADDR64, but may be unaligned. */
505 HOW (R_PPC64_UADDR64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
506 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
507
508 /* 64-bit relative relocation. */
509 HOW (R_PPC64_REL64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, TRUE, dont,
510 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
511
512 /* 64-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table. */
513 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
514 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
515
516 /* 64-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage
517 table. */
518 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTREL64 not supported. */
519 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTREL64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, TRUE, dont,
520 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
521
522 /* 16 bit TOC-relative relocation. */
523 /* R_PPC64_TOC16 47 half16* S + A - .TOC. */
524 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
525 ppc64_elf_toc_reloc),
526
527 /* 16 bit TOC-relative relocation without overflow. */
528 /* R_PPC64_TOC16_LO 48 half16 #lo (S + A - .TOC.) */
529 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
530 ppc64_elf_toc_reloc),
531
532 /* 16 bit TOC-relative relocation, high 16 bits. */
533 /* R_PPC64_TOC16_HI 49 half16 #hi (S + A - .TOC.) */
534 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
535 ppc64_elf_toc_reloc),
536
537 /* 16 bit TOC-relative relocation, high 16 bits, plus 1 if the
538 contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is
539 negative. */
540 /* R_PPC64_TOC16_HA 50 half16 #ha (S + A - .TOC.) */
541 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
542 ppc64_elf_toc_ha_reloc),
543
544 /* 64-bit relocation; insert value of TOC base (.TOC.). */
545 /* R_PPC64_TOC 51 doubleword64 .TOC. */
546 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
547 ppc64_elf_toc64_reloc),
548
549 /* Like R_PPC64_GOT16, but also informs the link editor that the
550 value to relocate may (!) refer to a PLT entry which the link
551 editor (a) may replace with the symbol value. If the link editor
552 is unable to fully resolve the symbol, it may (b) create a PLT
553 entry and store the address to the new PLT entry in the GOT.
554 This permits lazy resolution of function symbols at run time.
555 The link editor may also skip all of this and just (c) emit a
556 R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT to tie the symbol to the GOT entry. */
557 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16 not implemented. */
558 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE,signed,
559 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
560
561 /* Like R_PPC64_PLTGOT16, but without overflow. */
562 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO not implemented. */
563 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
564 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
565
566 /* Like R_PPC64_PLT_GOT16, but using bits 16-31 of the address. */
567 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HI not implemented. */
568 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
569 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
570
571 /* Like R_PPC64_PLT_GOT16, but using bits 16-31 of the address, plus
572 1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number,
573 is negative. */
574 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA not implemented. */
575 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
576 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
577
578 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16, but for instructions with a DS field. */
579 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
580 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
581
582 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO, but for instructions with a DS field. */
583 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
584 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
585
586 /* Like R_PPC64_GOT16, but for instructions with a DS field. */
587 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
588 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
589
590 /* Like R_PPC64_GOT16_LO, but for instructions with a DS field. */
591 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
592 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
593
594 /* Like R_PPC64_PLT16_LO, but for instructions with a DS field. */
595 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
596 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
597
598 /* Like R_PPC64_SECTOFF, but for instructions with a DS field. */
599 HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
600 ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc),
601
602 /* Like R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO, but for instructions with a DS field. */
603 HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
604 ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc),
605
606 /* Like R_PPC64_TOC16, but for instructions with a DS field. */
607 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
608 ppc64_elf_toc_reloc),
609
610 /* Like R_PPC64_TOC16_LO, but for instructions with a DS field. */
611 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
612 ppc64_elf_toc_reloc),
613
614 /* Like R_PPC64_PLTGOT16, but for instructions with a DS field. */
615 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS not implemented. */
616 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
617 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
618
619 /* Like R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO, but for instructions with a DS field. */
620 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO not implemented. */
621 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
622 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
623
624 /* Marker relocs for TLS. */
625 HOW (R_PPC64_TLS, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
626 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
627
628 HOW (R_PPC64_TLSGD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
629 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
630
631 HOW (R_PPC64_TLSLD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
632 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
633
634 /* Marker reloc for optimizing r2 save in prologue rather than on
635 each plt call stub. */
636 HOW (R_PPC64_TOCSAVE, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
637 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
638
639 /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions. */
640 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTSEQ, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
641 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
642
643 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTCALL, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
644 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
645
646 /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the
647 definition of its TLS sym. */
648 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPMOD64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
649 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
650
651 /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value
652 of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that
653 contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000. */
654 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
655 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
656
657 /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc. */
658 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
659 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
660
661 /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
662 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
663 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
664
665 /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
666 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
667 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
668
669 /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
670 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
671 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
672
673 /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
674 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHER, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, FALSE, dont,
675 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
676
677 /* Like DTPREL16_HIGHER, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
678 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, FALSE, dont,
679 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
680
681 /* Like DTPREL16_HIGHER, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
682 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHEST, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, FALSE, dont,
683 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
684
685 /* Like DTPREL16_HIGHEST, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
686 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, FALSE, dont,
687 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
688
689 /* Like DTPREL16, but for insns with a DS field. */
690 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
691 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
692
693 /* Like DTPREL16_DS, but no overflow. */
694 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
695 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
696
697 /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of
698 sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13). */
699 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
700 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
701
702 /* A 16 bit tprel reloc. */
703 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
704 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
705
706 /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow. */
707 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
708 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
709
710 /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
711 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
712 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
713
714 /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
715 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
716 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
717
718 /* Like TPREL16_HI, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
719 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, FALSE, dont,
720 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
721
722 /* Like TPREL16_HIGHER, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
723 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, FALSE, dont,
724 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
725
726 /* Like TPREL16_HIGHER, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
727 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, FALSE, dont,
728 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
729
730 /* Like TPREL16_HIGHEST, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
731 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, FALSE, dont,
732 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
733
734 /* Like TPREL16, but for insns with a DS field. */
735 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
736 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
737
738 /* Like TPREL16_DS, but no overflow. */
739 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
740 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
741
742 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
743 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset
744 to the first entry relative to the TOC base (r2). */
745 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
746 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
747
748 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow. */
749 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
750 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
751
752 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
753 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
754 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
755
756 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
757 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
758 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
759
760 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
761 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the
762 first entry relative to the TOC base (r2). */
763 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
764 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
765
766 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow. */
767 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
768 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
769
770 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
771 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
772 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
773
774 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
775 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
776 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
777
778 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes
779 the offset to the entry relative to the TOC base (r2). */
780 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
781 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
782
783 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_DS, but no overflow. */
784 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
785 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
786
787 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
788 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
789 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
790
791 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
792 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
793 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
794
795 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the
796 offset to the entry relative to the TOC base (r2). */
797 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
798 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
799
800 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_DS, but no overflow. */
801 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
802 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
803
804 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
805 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
806 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
807
808 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
809 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
810 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
811
812 HOW (R_PPC64_JMP_IREL, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
813 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
814
815 HOW (R_PPC64_IRELATIVE, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
816 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
817
818 /* A 16 bit relative relocation. */
819 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
820 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
821
822 /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow. */
823 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
824 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
825
826 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address. */
827 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, signed,
828 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
829
830 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of
831 the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
832 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, signed,
833 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
834
835 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGH, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
836 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
837
838 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
839 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
840
841 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, TRUE, dont,
842 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
843
844 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, TRUE, dont,
845 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
846
847 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, TRUE, dont,
848 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
849
850 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, TRUE, dont,
851 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
852
853 /* Like R_PPC64_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis. */
854 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, TRUE, signed,
855 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
856
857 /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only). */
858 HOW (R_PPC64_16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, FALSE, signed,
859 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
860
861 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI, but no overflow. */
862 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
863 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
864
865 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA, but no overflow. */
866 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
867 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
868
869 /* Like R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HI, but no overflow. */
870 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGH, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
871 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
872
873 /* Like R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA, but no overflow. */
874 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
875 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
876
877 /* Like R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI, but no overflow. */
878 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
879 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
880
881 /* Like R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA, but no overflow. */
882 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
883 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
884
885 /* Marker reloc on ELFv2 large-model function entry. */
886 HOW (R_PPC64_ENTRY, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
887 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
888
889 /* Like ADDR64, but use local entry point of function. */
890 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR64_LOCAL, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
891 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
892
893 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTSEQ_NOTOC, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
894 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
895
896 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
897 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
898
899 HOW (R_PPC64_PCREL_OPT, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
900 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
901
902 HOW (R_PPC64_D34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, FALSE, signed,
903 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
904
905 HOW (R_PPC64_D34_LO, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
906 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
907
908 HOW (R_PPC64_D34_HI30, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 34, FALSE, dont,
909 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
910
911 HOW (R_PPC64_D34_HA30, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 34, FALSE, dont,
912 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
913
914 HOW (R_PPC64_PCREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
915 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
916
917 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
918 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
919
920 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
921 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
922
923 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
924 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
925
926 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, FALSE, signed,
927 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
928
929 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, FALSE, signed,
930 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
931
932 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
933 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
934
935 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
936 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
937
938 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
939 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
940
941 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
942 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
943
944 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 34, FALSE, dont,
945 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
946
947 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 34, FALSE, dont,
948 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
949
950 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 50, FALSE, dont,
951 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
952
953 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 50, FALSE, dont,
954 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
955
956 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 34, TRUE, dont,
957 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
958
959 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 34, TRUE, dont,
960 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
961
962 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 50, TRUE, dont,
963 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
964
965 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 50, TRUE, dont,
966 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
967
968 HOW (R_PPC64_D28, 4, 28, 0xfff0000ffffULL, 0, FALSE, signed,
969 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
970
971 HOW (R_PPC64_PCREL28, 4, 28, 0xfff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
972 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
973
974 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy. */
975 HOW (R_PPC64_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
976 NULL),
977
978 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage. */
979 HOW (R_PPC64_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
980 NULL),
981 };
982
983 \f
984 /* Initialize the ppc64_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can
985 be done. */
986
987 static void
988 ppc_howto_init (void)
989 {
990 unsigned int i, type;
991
992 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (ppc64_elf_howto_raw); i++)
993 {
994 type = ppc64_elf_howto_raw[i].type;
995 BFD_ASSERT (type < ARRAY_SIZE (ppc64_elf_howto_table));
996 ppc64_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc64_elf_howto_raw[i];
997 }
998 }
999
1000 static reloc_howto_type *
1001 ppc64_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd,
1002 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
1003 {
1004 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r = R_PPC64_NONE;
1005
1006 if (!ppc64_elf_howto_table[R_PPC64_ADDR32])
1007 /* Initialize howto table if needed. */
1008 ppc_howto_init ();
1009
1010 switch (code)
1011 {
1012 default:
1013 /* xgettext:c-format */
1014 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"), abfd,
1015 (int) code);
1016 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
1017 return NULL;
1018
1019 case BFD_RELOC_NONE: r = R_PPC64_NONE;
1020 break;
1021 case BFD_RELOC_32: r = R_PPC64_ADDR32;
1022 break;
1023 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26: r = R_PPC64_ADDR24;
1024 break;
1025 case BFD_RELOC_16: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16;
1026 break;
1027 case BFD_RELOC_LO16: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO;
1028 break;
1029 case BFD_RELOC_HI16: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI;
1030 break;
1031 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH;
1032 break;
1033 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA;
1034 break;
1035 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA;
1036 break;
1037 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16: r = R_PPC64_ADDR14;
1038 break;
1039 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN;
1040 break;
1041 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN;
1042 break;
1043 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26: r = R_PPC64_REL24;
1044 break;
1045 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC: r = R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC;
1046 break;
1047 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16: r = R_PPC64_REL14;
1048 break;
1049 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN;
1050 break;
1051 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN;
1052 break;
1053 case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC64_GOT16;
1054 break;
1055 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC64_GOT16_LO;
1056 break;
1057 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC64_GOT16_HI;
1058 break;
1059 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC64_GOT16_HA;
1060 break;
1061 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY: r = R_PPC64_COPY;
1062 break;
1063 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT: r = R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT;
1064 break;
1065 case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_REL32;
1066 break;
1067 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC64_PLT32;
1068 break;
1069 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_PLTREL32;
1070 break;
1071 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC64_PLT16_LO;
1072 break;
1073 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC64_PLT16_HI;
1074 break;
1075 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC64_PLT16_HA;
1076 break;
1077 case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF;
1078 break;
1079 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO;
1080 break;
1081 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HI;
1082 break;
1083 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL: r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HA;
1084 break;
1085 case BFD_RELOC_CTOR: r = R_PPC64_ADDR64;
1086 break;
1087 case BFD_RELOC_64: r = R_PPC64_ADDR64;
1088 break;
1089 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_HIGHER: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER;
1090 break;
1091 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_HIGHER_S: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA;
1092 break;
1093 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_HIGHEST: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST;
1094 break;
1095 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_HIGHEST_S: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA;
1096 break;
1097 case BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_REL64;
1098 break;
1099 case BFD_RELOC_64_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC64_PLT64;
1100 break;
1101 case BFD_RELOC_64_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_PLTREL64;
1102 break;
1103 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16: r = R_PPC64_TOC16;
1104 break;
1105 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_LO: r = R_PPC64_TOC16_LO;
1106 break;
1107 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_HI: r = R_PPC64_TOC16_HI;
1108 break;
1109 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_HA: r = R_PPC64_TOC16_HA;
1110 break;
1111 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC: r = R_PPC64_TOC;
1112 break;
1113 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16: r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16;
1114 break;
1115 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO: r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO;
1116 break;
1117 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HI: r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HI;
1118 break;
1119 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA: r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA;
1120 break;
1121 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS;
1122 break;
1123 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS;
1124 break;
1125 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS: r = R_PPC64_GOT16_DS;
1126 break;
1127 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS;
1128 break;
1129 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS;
1130 break;
1131 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS: r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS;
1132 break;
1133 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS;
1134 break;
1135 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS: r = R_PPC64_TOC16_DS;
1136 break;
1137 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS;
1138 break;
1139 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS: r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS;
1140 break;
1141 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO_DS;
1142 break;
1143 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TLS_PCREL:
1144 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS: r = R_PPC64_TLS;
1145 break;
1146 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD: r = R_PPC64_TLSGD;
1147 break;
1148 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD: r = R_PPC64_TLSLD;
1149 break;
1150 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD: r = R_PPC64_DTPMOD64;
1151 break;
1152 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16;
1153 break;
1154 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO;
1155 break;
1156 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI;
1157 break;
1158 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH;
1159 break;
1160 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA;
1161 break;
1162 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA;
1163 break;
1164 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL: r = R_PPC64_TPREL64;
1165 break;
1166 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16;
1167 break;
1168 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO;
1169 break;
1170 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HI;
1171 break;
1172 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGH: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGH;
1173 break;
1174 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA;
1175 break;
1176 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA;
1177 break;
1178 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL64;
1179 break;
1180 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16;
1181 break;
1182 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO;
1183 break;
1184 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI;
1185 break;
1186 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA;
1187 break;
1188 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16;
1189 break;
1190 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO;
1191 break;
1192 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI;
1193 break;
1194 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA;
1195 break;
1196 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS;
1197 break;
1198 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS;
1199 break;
1200 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI;
1201 break;
1202 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA;
1203 break;
1204 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS;
1205 break;
1206 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS;
1207 break;
1208 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HI;
1209 break;
1210 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA;
1211 break;
1212 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS;
1213 break;
1214 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS;
1215 break;
1216 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER;
1217 break;
1218 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA;
1219 break;
1220 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST;
1221 break;
1222 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA;
1223 break;
1224 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS;
1225 break;
1226 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS;
1227 break;
1228 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHER: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHER;
1229 break;
1230 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA;
1231 break;
1232 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHEST: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHEST;
1233 break;
1234 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA;
1235 break;
1236 case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_REL16;
1237 break;
1238 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_REL16_LO;
1239 break;
1240 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HI;
1241 break;
1242 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HA;
1243 break;
1244 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGH: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGH;
1245 break;
1246 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA;
1247 break;
1248 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER;
1249 break;
1250 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA;
1251 break;
1252 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST;
1253 break;
1254 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA;
1255 break;
1256 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA: r = R_PPC64_16DX_HA;
1257 break;
1258 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA: r = R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA;
1259 break;
1260 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ENTRY: r = R_PPC64_ENTRY;
1261 break;
1262 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR64_LOCAL: r = R_PPC64_ADDR64_LOCAL;
1263 break;
1264 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_D34: r = R_PPC64_D34;
1265 break;
1266 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_D34_LO: r = R_PPC64_D34_LO;
1267 break;
1268 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_D34_HI30: r = R_PPC64_D34_HI30;
1269 break;
1270 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_D34_HA30: r = R_PPC64_D34_HA30;
1271 break;
1272 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PCREL34: r = R_PPC64_PCREL34;
1273 break;
1274 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34: r = R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34;
1275 break;
1276 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34: r = R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34;
1277 break;
1278 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL34: r = R_PPC64_TPREL34;
1279 break;
1280 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL34: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL34;
1281 break;
1282 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD34: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD34;
1283 break;
1284 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD34: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD34;
1285 break;
1286 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT_TPREL34: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL34;
1287 break;
1288 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL34: r = R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL34;
1289 break;
1290 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER34: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER34;
1291 break;
1292 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34;
1293 break;
1294 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST34: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST34;
1295 break;
1296 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34;
1297 break;
1298 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER34: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER34;
1299 break;
1300 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34;
1301 break;
1302 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST34: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST34;
1303 break;
1304 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34;
1305 break;
1306 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_D28: r = R_PPC64_D28;
1307 break;
1308 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PCREL28: r = R_PPC64_PCREL28;
1309 break;
1310 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT: r = R_PPC64_GNU_VTINHERIT;
1311 break;
1312 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY: r = R_PPC64_GNU_VTENTRY;
1313 break;
1314 }
1315
1316 return ppc64_elf_howto_table[r];
1317 };
1318
1319 static reloc_howto_type *
1320 ppc64_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1321 const char *r_name)
1322 {
1323 unsigned int i;
1324
1325 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (ppc64_elf_howto_raw); i++)
1326 if (ppc64_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL
1327 && strcasecmp (ppc64_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0)
1328 return &ppc64_elf_howto_raw[i];
1329
1330 return NULL;
1331 }
1332
1333 /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc. */
1334
1335 static bfd_boolean
1336 ppc64_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd, arelent *cache_ptr,
1337 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
1338 {
1339 unsigned int type;
1340
1341 /* Initialize howto table if needed. */
1342 if (!ppc64_elf_howto_table[R_PPC64_ADDR32])
1343 ppc_howto_init ();
1344
1345 type = ELF64_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
1346 if (type >= ARRAY_SIZE (ppc64_elf_howto_table))
1347 {
1348 /* xgettext:c-format */
1349 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
1350 abfd, type);
1351 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
1352 return FALSE;
1353 }
1354 cache_ptr->howto = ppc64_elf_howto_table[type];
1355 if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL || cache_ptr->howto->name == NULL)
1356 {
1357 /* xgettext:c-format */
1358 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
1359 abfd, type);
1360 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
1361 return FALSE;
1362 }
1363
1364 return TRUE;
1365 }
1366
1367 /* Handle the R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA and similar relocs. */
1368
1369 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1370 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1371 void *data, asection *input_section,
1372 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1373 {
1374 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
1375 long insn;
1376 bfd_size_type octets;
1377 bfd_vma value;
1378
1379 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1380 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1381 link time. */
1382 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1383 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1384 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1385
1386 /* Adjust the addend for sign extension of the low 16 (or 34) bits.
1387 We won't actually be using the low bits, so trashing them
1388 doesn't matter. */
1389 r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
1390 if (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34
1391 || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34
1392 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34
1393 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34)
1394 reloc_entry->addend += 1ULL << 33;
1395 else
1396 reloc_entry->addend += 1U << 15;
1397 if (r_type != R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA)
1398 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1399
1400 value = 0;
1401 if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1402 value = symbol->value;
1403 value += (reloc_entry->addend
1404 + symbol->section->output_offset
1405 + symbol->section->output_section->vma);
1406 value -= (reloc_entry->address
1407 + input_section->output_offset
1408 + input_section->output_section->vma);
1409 value = (bfd_signed_vma) value >> 16;
1410
1411 octets = reloc_entry->address * OCTETS_PER_BYTE (abfd, input_section);
1412 insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
1413 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
1414 insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15);
1415 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
1416 if (value + 0x8000 > 0xffff)
1417 return bfd_reloc_overflow;
1418 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1419 }
1420
1421 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1422 ppc64_elf_branch_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1423 void *data, asection *input_section,
1424 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1425 {
1426 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1427 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1428 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1429
1430 if (strcmp (symbol->section->name, ".opd") == 0
1431 && (symbol->section->owner->flags & DYNAMIC) == 0)
1432 {
1433 bfd_vma dest = opd_entry_value (symbol->section,
1434 symbol->value + reloc_entry->addend,
1435 NULL, NULL, FALSE);
1436 if (dest != (bfd_vma) -1)
1437 reloc_entry->addend = dest - (symbol->value
1438 + symbol->section->output_section->vma
1439 + symbol->section->output_offset);
1440 }
1441 else
1442 {
1443 elf_symbol_type *elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) symbol;
1444
1445 if (symbol->section->owner != abfd
1446 && symbol->section->owner != NULL
1447 && abiversion (symbol->section->owner) >= 2)
1448 {
1449 unsigned int i;
1450
1451 for (i = 0; i < symbol->section->owner->symcount; ++i)
1452 {
1453 asymbol *symdef = symbol->section->owner->outsymbols[i];
1454
1455 if (strcmp (symdef->name, symbol->name) == 0)
1456 {
1457 elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) symdef;
1458 break;
1459 }
1460 }
1461 }
1462 reloc_entry->addend
1463 += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_other);
1464 }
1465 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1466 }
1467
1468 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1469 ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1470 void *data, asection *input_section,
1471 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1472 {
1473 long insn;
1474 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
1475 bfd_size_type octets;
1476 /* Assume 'at' branch hints. */
1477 bfd_boolean is_isa_v2 = TRUE;
1478
1479 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1480 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1481 link time. */
1482 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1483 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1484 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1485
1486 octets = reloc_entry->address * OCTETS_PER_BYTE (abfd, input_section);
1487 insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
1488 insn &= ~(0x01 << 21);
1489 r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
1490 if (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
1491 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN)
1492 insn |= 0x01 << 21; /* 'y' or 't' bit, lowest bit of BO field. */
1493
1494 if (is_isa_v2)
1495 {
1496 /* Set 'a' bit. This is 0b00010 in BO field for branch
1497 on CR(BI) insns (BO == 001at or 011at), and 0b01000
1498 for branch on CTR insns (BO == 1a00t or 1a01t). */
1499 if ((insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x04 << 21))
1500 insn |= 0x02 << 21;
1501 else if ((insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x10 << 21))
1502 insn |= 0x08 << 21;
1503 else
1504 goto out;
1505 }
1506 else
1507 {
1508 bfd_vma target = 0;
1509 bfd_vma from;
1510
1511 if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1512 target = symbol->value;
1513 target += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1514 target += symbol->section->output_offset;
1515 target += reloc_entry->addend;
1516
1517 from = (reloc_entry->address
1518 + input_section->output_offset
1519 + input_section->output_section->vma);
1520
1521 /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default. */
1522 if ((bfd_signed_vma) (target - from) < 0)
1523 insn ^= 0x01 << 21;
1524 }
1525 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
1526 out:
1527 return ppc64_elf_branch_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1528 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1529 }
1530
1531 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1532 ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1533 void *data, asection *input_section,
1534 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1535 {
1536 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1537 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1538 link time. */
1539 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1540 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1541 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1542
1543 /* Subtract the symbol section base address. */
1544 reloc_entry->addend -= symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1545 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1546 }
1547
1548 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1549 ppc64_elf_sectoff_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1550 void *data, asection *input_section,
1551 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1552 {
1553 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1554 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1555 link time. */
1556 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1557 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1558 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1559
1560 /* Subtract the symbol section base address. */
1561 reloc_entry->addend -= symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1562
1563 /* Adjust the addend for sign extension of the low 16 bits. */
1564 reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
1565 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1566 }
1567
1568 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1569 ppc64_elf_toc_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1570 void *data, asection *input_section,
1571 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1572 {
1573 bfd_vma TOCstart;
1574
1575 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1576 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1577 link time. */
1578 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1579 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1580 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1581
1582 TOCstart = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_section->output_section->owner);
1583 if (TOCstart == 0)
1584 TOCstart = ppc64_elf_set_toc (NULL, input_section->output_section->owner);
1585
1586 /* Subtract the TOC base address. */
1587 reloc_entry->addend -= TOCstart + TOC_BASE_OFF;
1588 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1589 }
1590
1591 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1592 ppc64_elf_toc_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1593 void *data, asection *input_section,
1594 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1595 {
1596 bfd_vma TOCstart;
1597
1598 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1599 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1600 link time. */
1601 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1602 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1603 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1604
1605 TOCstart = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_section->output_section->owner);
1606 if (TOCstart == 0)
1607 TOCstart = ppc64_elf_set_toc (NULL, input_section->output_section->owner);
1608
1609 /* Subtract the TOC base address. */
1610 reloc_entry->addend -= TOCstart + TOC_BASE_OFF;
1611
1612 /* Adjust the addend for sign extension of the low 16 bits. */
1613 reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
1614 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1615 }
1616
1617 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1618 ppc64_elf_toc64_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1619 void *data, asection *input_section,
1620 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1621 {
1622 bfd_vma TOCstart;
1623 bfd_size_type octets;
1624
1625 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1626 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1627 link time. */
1628 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1629 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1630 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1631
1632 TOCstart = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_section->output_section->owner);
1633 if (TOCstart == 0)
1634 TOCstart = ppc64_elf_set_toc (NULL, input_section->output_section->owner);
1635
1636 octets = reloc_entry->address * OCTETS_PER_BYTE (abfd, input_section);
1637 bfd_put_64 (abfd, TOCstart + TOC_BASE_OFF, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
1638 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1639 }
1640
1641 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1642 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1643 void *data, asection *input_section,
1644 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1645 {
1646 uint64_t insn;
1647 bfd_vma targ;
1648
1649 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1650 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1651 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1652
1653 insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address);
1654 insn <<= 32;
1655 insn |= bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address + 4);
1656
1657 targ = (symbol->section->output_section->vma
1658 + symbol->section->output_offset
1659 + reloc_entry->addend);
1660 if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1661 targ += symbol->value;
1662 if (reloc_entry->howto->type == R_PPC64_D34_HA30)
1663 targ += 1ULL << 33;
1664 if (reloc_entry->howto->pc_relative)
1665 {
1666 bfd_vma from = (reloc_entry->address
1667 + input_section->output_offset
1668 + input_section->output_section->vma);
1669 targ -=from;
1670 }
1671 targ >>= reloc_entry->howto->rightshift;
1672 insn &= ~reloc_entry->howto->dst_mask;
1673 insn |= ((targ << 16) | (targ & 0xffff)) & reloc_entry->howto->dst_mask;
1674 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn >> 32, (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address);
1675 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address + 4);
1676 if (reloc_entry->howto->complain_on_overflow == complain_overflow_signed
1677 && (targ + (1ULL << (reloc_entry->howto->bitsize - 1))
1678 >= 1ULL << reloc_entry->howto->bitsize))
1679 return bfd_reloc_overflow;
1680 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1681 }
1682
1683 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1684 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1685 void *data, asection *input_section,
1686 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1687 {
1688 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1689 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1690 link time. */
1691 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1692 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1693 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1694
1695 if (error_message != NULL)
1696 {
1697 static char buf[60];
1698 sprintf (buf, "generic linker can't handle %s",
1699 reloc_entry->howto->name);
1700 *error_message = buf;
1701 }
1702 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
1703 }
1704
1705 /* Track GOT entries needed for a given symbol. We might need more
1706 than one got entry per symbol. */
1707 struct got_entry
1708 {
1709 struct got_entry *next;
1710
1711 /* The symbol addend that we'll be placing in the GOT. */
1712 bfd_vma addend;
1713
1714 /* Unlike other ELF targets, we use separate GOT entries for the same
1715 symbol referenced from different input files. This is to support
1716 automatic multiple TOC/GOT sections, where the TOC base can vary
1717 from one input file to another. After partitioning into TOC groups
1718 we merge entries within the group.
1719
1720 Point to the BFD owning this GOT entry. */
1721 bfd *owner;
1722
1723 /* Zero for non-tls entries, or TLS_TLS and one of TLS_GD, TLS_LD,
1724 TLS_TPREL or TLS_DTPREL for tls entries. */
1725 unsigned char tls_type;
1726
1727 /* Non-zero if got.ent points to real entry. */
1728 unsigned char is_indirect;
1729
1730 /* Reference count until size_dynamic_sections, GOT offset thereafter. */
1731 union
1732 {
1733 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
1734 bfd_vma offset;
1735 struct got_entry *ent;
1736 } got;
1737 };
1738
1739 /* The same for PLT. */
1740 struct plt_entry
1741 {
1742 struct plt_entry *next;
1743
1744 bfd_vma addend;
1745
1746 union
1747 {
1748 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
1749 bfd_vma offset;
1750 } plt;
1751 };
1752
1753 struct ppc64_elf_obj_tdata
1754 {
1755 struct elf_obj_tdata elf;
1756
1757 /* Shortcuts to dynamic linker sections. */
1758 asection *got;
1759 asection *relgot;
1760
1761 /* Used during garbage collection. We attach global symbols defined
1762 on removed .opd entries to this section so that the sym is removed. */
1763 asection *deleted_section;
1764
1765 /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling. Support for multiple GOT
1766 sections means we potentially need one of these for each input bfd. */
1767 struct got_entry tlsld_got;
1768
1769 union
1770 {
1771 /* A copy of relocs before they are modified for --emit-relocs. */
1772 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs;
1773
1774 /* Section contents. */
1775 bfd_byte *contents;
1776 } opd;
1777
1778 /* Nonzero if this bfd has small toc/got relocs, ie. that expect
1779 the reloc to be in the range -32768 to 32767. */
1780 unsigned int has_small_toc_reloc : 1;
1781
1782 /* Set if toc/got ha relocs detected not using r2, or lo reloc
1783 instruction not one we handle. */
1784 unsigned int unexpected_toc_insn : 1;
1785
1786 /* Set if PLT/GOT/TOC relocs that can be optimised are present in
1787 this file. */
1788 unsigned int has_optrel : 1;
1789 };
1790
1791 #define ppc64_elf_tdata(bfd) \
1792 ((struct ppc64_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
1793
1794 #define ppc64_tlsld_got(bfd) \
1795 (&ppc64_elf_tdata (bfd)->tlsld_got)
1796
1797 #define is_ppc64_elf(bfd) \
1798 (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
1799 && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC64_ELF_DATA)
1800
1801 /* Override the generic function because we store some extras. */
1802
1803 static bfd_boolean
1804 ppc64_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
1805 {
1806 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc64_elf_obj_tdata),
1807 PPC64_ELF_DATA);
1808 }
1809
1810 /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 64 bit input bfd when the
1811 default is 32 bit. Also select arch based on apuinfo. */
1812
1813 static bfd_boolean
1814 ppc64_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
1815 {
1816 if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default)
1817 return TRUE;
1818
1819 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32)
1820 {
1821 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1822
1823 if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
1824 {
1825 /* Relies on arch after 32 bit default being 64 bit default. */
1826 abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next;
1827 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64);
1828 }
1829 }
1830 return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd);
1831 }
1832
1833 /* Support for core dump NOTE sections. */
1834
1835 static bfd_boolean
1836 ppc64_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1837 {
1838 size_t offset, size;
1839
1840 if (note->descsz != 504)
1841 return FALSE;
1842
1843 /* pr_cursig */
1844 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
1845
1846 /* pr_pid */
1847 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 32);
1848
1849 /* pr_reg */
1850 offset = 112;
1851 size = 384;
1852
1853 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
1854 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
1855 size, note->descpos + offset);
1856 }
1857
1858 static bfd_boolean
1859 ppc64_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1860 {
1861 if (note->descsz != 136)
1862 return FALSE;
1863
1864 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
1865 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
1866 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
1867 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 40, 16);
1868 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
1869 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 56, 80);
1870
1871 return TRUE;
1872 }
1873
1874 static char *
1875 ppc64_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type,
1876 ...)
1877 {
1878 switch (note_type)
1879 {
1880 default:
1881 return NULL;
1882
1883 case NT_PRPSINFO:
1884 {
1885 char data[136] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING;
1886 va_list ap;
1887
1888 va_start (ap, note_type);
1889 memset (data, 0, sizeof (data));
1890 strncpy (data + 40, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16);
1891 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1892 DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH;
1893 /* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with
1894 -Wstringop-truncation:
1895 https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643
1896 */
1897 DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION;
1898 #endif
1899 strncpy (data + 56, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80);
1900 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1901 DIAGNOSTIC_POP;
1902 #endif
1903 va_end (ap);
1904 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1905 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1906 }
1907
1908 case NT_PRSTATUS:
1909 {
1910 char data[504];
1911 va_list ap;
1912 long pid;
1913 int cursig;
1914 const void *greg;
1915
1916 va_start (ap, note_type);
1917 memset (data, 0, 112);
1918 pid = va_arg (ap, long);
1919 bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 32);
1920 cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
1921 bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12);
1922 greg = va_arg (ap, const void *);
1923 memcpy (data + 112, greg, 384);
1924 memset (data + 496, 0, 8);
1925 va_end (ap);
1926 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1927 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1928 }
1929 }
1930 }
1931
1932 /* Add extra PPC sections. */
1933
1934 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc64_elf_special_sections[] =
1935 {
1936 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, 0 },
1937 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1938 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1939 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".toc"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1940 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".toc1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1941 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tocbss"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1942 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
1943 };
1944
1945 enum _ppc64_sec_type {
1946 sec_normal = 0,
1947 sec_opd = 1,
1948 sec_toc = 2
1949 };
1950
1951 struct _ppc64_elf_section_data
1952 {
1953 struct bfd_elf_section_data elf;
1954
1955 union
1956 {
1957 /* An array with one entry for each opd function descriptor,
1958 and some spares since opd entries may be either 16 or 24 bytes. */
1959 #define OPD_NDX(OFF) ((OFF) >> 4)
1960 struct _opd_sec_data
1961 {
1962 /* Points to the function code section for local opd entries. */
1963 asection **func_sec;
1964
1965 /* After editing .opd, adjust references to opd local syms. */
1966 long *adjust;
1967 } opd;
1968
1969 /* An array for toc sections, indexed by offset/8. */
1970 struct _toc_sec_data
1971 {
1972 /* Specifies the relocation symbol index used at a given toc offset. */
1973 unsigned *symndx;
1974
1975 /* And the relocation addend. */
1976 bfd_vma *add;
1977 } toc;
1978 } u;
1979
1980 enum _ppc64_sec_type sec_type:2;
1981
1982 /* Flag set when small branches are detected. Used to
1983 select suitable defaults for the stub group size. */
1984 unsigned int has_14bit_branch:1;
1985
1986 /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected. */
1987 unsigned int has_pltcall:1;
1988
1989 /* Flag set when section has PLT/GOT/TOC relocations that can be
1990 optimised. */
1991 unsigned int has_optrel:1;
1992 };
1993
1994 #define ppc64_elf_section_data(sec) \
1995 ((struct _ppc64_elf_section_data *) elf_section_data (sec))
1996
1997 static bfd_boolean
1998 ppc64_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
1999 {
2000 if (!sec->used_by_bfd)
2001 {
2002 struct _ppc64_elf_section_data *sdata;
2003 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*sdata);
2004
2005 sdata = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2006 if (sdata == NULL)
2007 return FALSE;
2008 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
2009 }
2010
2011 return _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
2012 }
2013
2014 static struct _opd_sec_data *
2015 get_opd_info (asection * sec)
2016 {
2017 if (sec != NULL
2018 && ppc64_elf_section_data (sec) != NULL
2019 && ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->sec_type == sec_opd)
2020 return &ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->u.opd;
2021 return NULL;
2022 }
2023 \f
2024 /* Parameters for the qsort hook. */
2025 static bfd_boolean synthetic_relocatable;
2026 static asection *synthetic_opd;
2027
2028 /* qsort comparison function for ppc64_elf_get_synthetic_symtab. */
2029
2030 static int
2031 compare_symbols (const void *ap, const void *bp)
2032 {
2033 const asymbol *a = *(const asymbol **) ap;
2034 const asymbol *b = *(const asymbol **) bp;
2035
2036 /* Section symbols first. */
2037 if ((a->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) && !(b->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM))
2038 return -1;
2039 if (!(a->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) && (b->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM))
2040 return 1;
2041
2042 /* then .opd symbols. */
2043 if (synthetic_opd != NULL)
2044 {
2045 if (strcmp (a->section->name, ".opd") == 0
2046 && strcmp (b->section->name, ".opd") != 0)
2047 return -1;
2048 if (strcmp (a->section->name, ".opd") != 0
2049 && strcmp (b->section->name, ".opd") == 0)
2050 return 1;
2051 }
2052
2053 /* then other code symbols. */
2054 if (((a->section->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))
2055 == (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC))
2056 && ((b->section->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))
2057 != (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC)))
2058 return -1;
2059
2060 if (((a->section->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))
2061 != (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC))
2062 && ((b->section->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))
2063 == (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC)))
2064 return 1;
2065
2066 if (synthetic_relocatable)
2067 {
2068 if (a->section->id < b->section->id)
2069 return -1;
2070
2071 if (a->section->id > b->section->id)
2072 return 1;
2073 }
2074
2075 if (a->value + a->section->vma < b->value + b->section->vma)
2076 return -1;
2077
2078 if (a->value + a->section->vma > b->value + b->section->vma)
2079 return 1;
2080
2081 /* For syms with the same value, prefer strong dynamic global function
2082 syms over other syms. */
2083 if ((a->flags & BSF_GLOBAL) != 0 && (b->flags & BSF_GLOBAL) == 0)
2084 return -1;
2085
2086 if ((a->flags & BSF_GLOBAL) == 0 && (b->flags & BSF_GLOBAL) != 0)
2087 return 1;
2088
2089 if ((a->flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0 && (b->flags & BSF_FUNCTION) == 0)
2090 return -1;
2091
2092 if ((a->flags & BSF_FUNCTION) == 0 && (b->flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
2093 return 1;
2094
2095 if ((a->flags & BSF_WEAK) == 0 && (b->flags & BSF_WEAK) != 0)
2096 return -1;
2097
2098 if ((a->flags & BSF_WEAK) != 0 && (b->flags & BSF_WEAK) == 0)
2099 return 1;
2100
2101 if ((a->flags & BSF_DYNAMIC) != 0 && (b->flags & BSF_DYNAMIC) == 0)
2102 return -1;
2103
2104 if ((a->flags & BSF_DYNAMIC) == 0 && (b->flags & BSF_DYNAMIC) != 0)
2105 return 1;
2106
2107 /* Finally, sort on where the symbol is in memory. The symbols will
2108 be in at most two malloc'd blocks, one for static syms, one for
2109 dynamic syms, and we distinguish the two blocks above by testing
2110 BSF_DYNAMIC. Since we are sorting the symbol pointers which were
2111 originally in the same order as the symbols (and we're not
2112 sorting the symbols themselves), this ensures a stable sort. */
2113 if (a < b)
2114 return -1;
2115 if (a > b)
2116 return 1;
2117 return 0;
2118 }
2119
2120 /* Search SYMS for a symbol of the given VALUE. */
2121
2122 static asymbol *
2123 sym_exists_at (asymbol **syms, size_t lo, size_t hi, unsigned int id,
2124 bfd_vma value)
2125 {
2126 size_t mid;
2127
2128 if (id == (unsigned) -1)
2129 {
2130 while (lo < hi)
2131 {
2132 mid = (lo + hi) >> 1;
2133 if (syms[mid]->value + syms[mid]->section->vma < value)
2134 lo = mid + 1;
2135 else if (syms[mid]->value + syms[mid]->section->vma > value)
2136 hi = mid;
2137 else
2138 return syms[mid];
2139 }
2140 }
2141 else
2142 {
2143 while (lo < hi)
2144 {
2145 mid = (lo + hi) >> 1;
2146 if (syms[mid]->section->id < id)
2147 lo = mid + 1;
2148 else if (syms[mid]->section->id > id)
2149 hi = mid;
2150 else if (syms[mid]->value < value)
2151 lo = mid + 1;
2152 else if (syms[mid]->value > value)
2153 hi = mid;
2154 else
2155 return syms[mid];
2156 }
2157 }
2158 return NULL;
2159 }
2160
2161 static bfd_boolean
2162 section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr)
2163 {
2164 bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr;
2165 return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
2166 && section->vma <= vma
2167 && vma < section->vma + section->size);
2168 }
2169
2170 /* Create synthetic symbols, effectively restoring "dot-symbol" function
2171 entry syms. Also generate @plt symbols for the glink branch table.
2172 Returns count of synthetic symbols in RET or -1 on error. */
2173
2174 static long
2175 ppc64_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
2176 long static_count, asymbol **static_syms,
2177 long dyn_count, asymbol **dyn_syms,
2178 asymbol **ret)
2179 {
2180 asymbol *s;
2181 size_t i, j, count;
2182 char *names;
2183 size_t symcount, codesecsym, codesecsymend, secsymend, opdsymend;
2184 asection *opd = NULL;
2185 bfd_boolean relocatable = (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0;
2186 asymbol **syms;
2187 int abi = abiversion (abfd);
2188
2189 *ret = NULL;
2190
2191 if (abi < 2)
2192 {
2193 opd = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".opd");
2194 if (opd == NULL && abi == 1)
2195 return 0;
2196 }
2197
2198 syms = NULL;
2199 codesecsym = 0;
2200 codesecsymend = 0;
2201 secsymend = 0;
2202 opdsymend = 0;
2203 symcount = 0;
2204 if (opd != NULL)
2205 {
2206 symcount = static_count;
2207 if (!relocatable)
2208 symcount += dyn_count;
2209 if (symcount == 0)
2210 return 0;
2211
2212 syms = bfd_malloc ((symcount + 1) * sizeof (*syms));
2213 if (syms == NULL)
2214 return -1;
2215
2216 if (!relocatable && static_count != 0 && dyn_count != 0)
2217 {
2218 /* Use both symbol tables. */
2219 memcpy (syms, static_syms, static_count * sizeof (*syms));
2220 memcpy (syms + static_count, dyn_syms,
2221 (dyn_count + 1) * sizeof (*syms));
2222 }
2223 else if (!relocatable && static_count == 0)
2224 memcpy (syms, dyn_syms, (symcount + 1) * sizeof (*syms));
2225 else
2226 memcpy (syms, static_syms, (symcount + 1) * sizeof (*syms));
2227
2228 /* Trim uninteresting symbols. Interesting symbols are section,
2229 function, and notype symbols. */
2230 for (i = 0, j = 0; i < symcount; ++i)
2231 if ((syms[i]->flags & (BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL
2232 | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) == 0)
2233 syms[j++] = syms[i];
2234 symcount = j;
2235
2236 synthetic_relocatable = relocatable;
2237 synthetic_opd = opd;
2238 qsort (syms, symcount, sizeof (*syms), compare_symbols);
2239
2240 if (!relocatable && symcount > 1)
2241 {
2242 /* Trim duplicate syms, since we may have merged the normal
2243 and dynamic symbols. Actually, we only care about syms
2244 that have different values, so trim any with the same
2245 value. Don't consider ifunc and ifunc resolver symbols
2246 duplicates however, because GDB wants to know whether a
2247 text symbol is an ifunc resolver. */
2248 for (i = 1, j = 1; i < symcount; ++i)
2249 {
2250 const asymbol *s0 = syms[i - 1];
2251 const asymbol *s1 = syms[i];
2252
2253 if ((s0->value + s0->section->vma
2254 != s1->value + s1->section->vma)
2255 || ((s0->flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION)
2256 != (s1->flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION)))
2257 syms[j++] = syms[i];
2258 }
2259 symcount = j;
2260 }
2261
2262 i = 0;
2263 /* Note that here and in compare_symbols we can't compare opd and
2264 sym->section directly. With separate debug info files, the
2265 symbols will be extracted from the debug file while abfd passed
2266 to this function is the real binary. */
2267 if (strcmp (syms[i]->section->name, ".opd") == 0)
2268 ++i;
2269 codesecsym = i;
2270
2271 for (; i < symcount; ++i)
2272 if (((syms[i]->section->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC
2273 | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))
2274 != (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC))
2275 || (syms[i]->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
2276 break;
2277 codesecsymend = i;
2278
2279 for (; i < symcount; ++i)
2280 if ((syms[i]->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
2281 break;
2282 secsymend = i;
2283
2284 for (; i < symcount; ++i)
2285 if (strcmp (syms[i]->section->name, ".opd") != 0)
2286 break;
2287 opdsymend = i;
2288
2289 for (; i < symcount; ++i)
2290 if (((syms[i]->section->flags
2291 & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)))
2292 != (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC))
2293 break;
2294 symcount = i;
2295 }
2296 count = 0;
2297
2298 if (relocatable)
2299 {
2300 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
2301 arelent *r;
2302 size_t size;
2303 size_t relcount;
2304
2305 if (opdsymend == secsymend)
2306 goto done;
2307
2308 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
2309 relcount = (opd->flags & SEC_RELOC) ? opd->reloc_count : 0;
2310 if (relcount == 0)
2311 goto done;
2312
2313 if (!(*slurp_relocs) (abfd, opd, static_syms, FALSE))
2314 {
2315 count = -1;
2316 goto done;
2317 }
2318
2319 size = 0;
2320 for (i = secsymend, r = opd->relocation; i < opdsymend; ++i)
2321 {
2322 asymbol *sym;
2323
2324 while (r < opd->relocation + relcount
2325 && r->address < syms[i]->value + opd->vma)
2326 ++r;
2327
2328 if (r == opd->relocation + relcount)
2329 break;
2330
2331 if (r->address != syms[i]->value + opd->vma)
2332 continue;
2333
2334 if (r->howto->type != R_PPC64_ADDR64)
2335 continue;
2336
2337 sym = *r->sym_ptr_ptr;
2338 if (!sym_exists_at (syms, opdsymend, symcount,
2339 sym->section->id, sym->value + r->addend))
2340 {
2341 ++count;
2342 size += sizeof (asymbol);
2343 size += strlen (syms[i]->name) + 2;
2344 }
2345 }
2346
2347 if (size == 0)
2348 goto done;
2349 s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
2350 if (s == NULL)
2351 {
2352 count = -1;
2353 goto done;
2354 }
2355
2356 names = (char *) (s + count);
2357
2358 for (i = secsymend, r = opd->relocation; i < opdsymend; ++i)
2359 {
2360 asymbol *sym;
2361
2362 while (r < opd->relocation + relcount
2363 && r->address < syms[i]->value + opd->vma)
2364 ++r;
2365
2366 if (r == opd->relocation + relcount)
2367 break;
2368
2369 if (r->address != syms[i]->value + opd->vma)
2370 continue;
2371
2372 if (r->howto->type != R_PPC64_ADDR64)
2373 continue;
2374
2375 sym = *r->sym_ptr_ptr;
2376 if (!sym_exists_at (syms, opdsymend, symcount,
2377 sym->section->id, sym->value + r->addend))
2378 {
2379 size_t len;
2380
2381 *s = *syms[i];
2382 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2383 s->section = sym->section;
2384 s->value = sym->value + r->addend;
2385 s->name = names;
2386 *names++ = '.';
2387 len = strlen (syms[i]->name);
2388 memcpy (names, syms[i]->name, len + 1);
2389 names += len + 1;
2390 /* Have udata.p point back to the original symbol this
2391 synthetic symbol was derived from. */
2392 s->udata.p = syms[i];
2393 s++;
2394 }
2395 }
2396 }
2397 else
2398 {
2399 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
2400 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
2401 size_t size;
2402 size_t plt_count = 0;
2403 bfd_vma glink_vma = 0, resolv_vma = 0;
2404 asection *dynamic, *glink = NULL, *relplt = NULL;
2405 arelent *p;
2406
2407 if (opd != NULL && !bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, opd, &contents))
2408 {
2409 free_contents_and_exit_err:
2410 count = -1;
2411 free_contents_and_exit:
2412 if (contents)
2413 free (contents);
2414 goto done;
2415 }
2416
2417 size = 0;
2418 for (i = secsymend; i < opdsymend; ++i)
2419 {
2420 bfd_vma ent;
2421
2422 /* Ignore bogus symbols. */
2423 if (syms[i]->value > opd->size - 8)
2424 continue;
2425
2426 ent = bfd_get_64 (abfd, contents + syms[i]->value);
2427 if (!sym_exists_at (syms, opdsymend, symcount, -1, ent))
2428 {
2429 ++count;
2430 size += sizeof (asymbol);
2431 size += strlen (syms[i]->name) + 2;
2432 }
2433 }
2434
2435 /* Get start of .glink stubs from DT_PPC64_GLINK. */
2436 if (dyn_count != 0
2437 && (dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic")) != NULL)
2438 {
2439 bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend;
2440 size_t extdynsize;
2441 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
2442
2443 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf))
2444 goto free_contents_and_exit_err;
2445
2446 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
2447 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
2448
2449 extdyn = dynbuf;
2450 extdynend = extdyn + dynamic->size;
2451 for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
2452 {
2453 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
2454 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
2455
2456 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
2457 break;
2458
2459 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC64_GLINK)
2460 {
2461 /* The first glink stub starts at DT_PPC64_GLINK plus 32.
2462 See comment in ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_sections. */
2463 glink_vma = dyn.d_un.d_val + 8 * 4;
2464 /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final
2465 link; search for the section (usually .text) where the
2466 glink stubs now reside. */
2467 glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma,
2468 &glink_vma);
2469 break;
2470 }
2471 }
2472
2473 free (dynbuf);
2474 }
2475
2476 if (glink != NULL)
2477 {
2478 /* Determine __glink trampoline by reading the relative branch
2479 from the first glink stub. */
2480 bfd_byte buf[4];
2481 unsigned int off = 0;
2482
2483 while (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
2484 glink_vma + off - glink->vma, 4))
2485 {
2486 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
2487 insn ^= B_DOT;
2488 if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0)
2489 {
2490 resolv_vma
2491 = glink_vma + off + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000;
2492 break;
2493 }
2494 off += 4;
2495 if (off > 4)
2496 break;
2497 }
2498
2499 if (resolv_vma)
2500 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
2501
2502 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
2503 if (relplt != NULL)
2504 {
2505 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
2506 if (!(*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dyn_syms, TRUE))
2507 goto free_contents_and_exit_err;
2508
2509 plt_count = relplt->size / sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
2510 size += plt_count * sizeof (asymbol);
2511
2512 p = relplt->relocation;
2513 for (i = 0; i < plt_count; i++, p++)
2514 {
2515 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
2516 if (p->addend != 0)
2517 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 16;
2518 }
2519 }
2520 }
2521
2522 if (size == 0)
2523 goto free_contents_and_exit;
2524 s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
2525 if (s == NULL)
2526 goto free_contents_and_exit_err;
2527
2528 names = (char *) (s + count + plt_count + (resolv_vma != 0));
2529
2530 for (i = secsymend; i < opdsymend; ++i)
2531 {
2532 bfd_vma ent;
2533
2534 if (syms[i]->value > opd->size - 8)
2535 continue;
2536
2537 ent = bfd_get_64 (abfd, contents + syms[i]->value);
2538 if (!sym_exists_at (syms, opdsymend, symcount, -1, ent))
2539 {
2540 size_t lo, hi;
2541 size_t len;
2542 asection *sec = abfd->sections;
2543
2544 *s = *syms[i];
2545 lo = codesecsym;
2546 hi = codesecsymend;
2547 while (lo < hi)
2548 {
2549 size_t mid = (lo + hi) >> 1;
2550 if (syms[mid]->section->vma < ent)
2551 lo = mid + 1;
2552 else if (syms[mid]->section->vma > ent)
2553 hi = mid;
2554 else
2555 {
2556 sec = syms[mid]->section;
2557 break;
2558 }
2559 }
2560
2561 if (lo >= hi && lo > codesecsym)
2562 sec = syms[lo - 1]->section;
2563
2564 for (; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
2565 {
2566 if (sec->vma > ent)
2567 break;
2568 /* SEC_LOAD may not be set if SEC is from a separate debug
2569 info file. */
2570 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
2571 break;
2572 if ((sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
2573 s->section = sec;
2574 }
2575 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2576 s->value = ent - s->section->vma;
2577 s->name = names;
2578 *names++ = '.';
2579 len = strlen (syms[i]->name);
2580 memcpy (names, syms[i]->name, len + 1);
2581 names += len + 1;
2582 /* Have udata.p point back to the original symbol this
2583 synthetic symbol was derived from. */
2584 s->udata.p = syms[i];
2585 s++;
2586 }
2587 }
2588 free (contents);
2589
2590 if (glink != NULL && relplt != NULL)
2591 {
2592 if (resolv_vma)
2593 {
2594 /* Add a symbol for the main glink trampoline. */
2595 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
2596 s->the_bfd = abfd;
2597 s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2598 s->section = glink;
2599 s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma;
2600 s->name = names;
2601 memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve",
2602 sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"));
2603 names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
2604 s++;
2605 count++;
2606 }
2607
2608 /* FIXME: It would be very much nicer to put sym@plt on the
2609 stub rather than on the glink branch table entry. The
2610 objdump disassembler would then use a sensible symbol
2611 name on plt calls. The difficulty in doing so is
2612 a) finding the stubs, and,
2613 b) matching stubs against plt entries, and,
2614 c) there can be multiple stubs for a given plt entry.
2615
2616 Solving (a) could be done by code scanning, but older
2617 ppc64 binaries used different stubs to current code.
2618 (b) is the tricky one since you need to known the toc
2619 pointer for at least one function that uses a pic stub to
2620 be able to calculate the plt address referenced.
2621 (c) means gdb would need to set multiple breakpoints (or
2622 find the glink branch itself) when setting breakpoints
2623 for pending shared library loads. */
2624 p = relplt->relocation;
2625 for (i = 0; i < plt_count; i++, p++)
2626 {
2627 size_t len;
2628
2629 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
2630 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
2631 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
2632 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
2633 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
2634 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2635 s->section = glink;
2636 s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma;
2637 s->name = names;
2638 s->udata.p = NULL;
2639 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
2640 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
2641 names += len;
2642 if (p->addend != 0)
2643 {
2644 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
2645 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
2646 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend);
2647 names += strlen (names);
2648 }
2649 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
2650 names += sizeof ("@plt");
2651 s++;
2652 if (abi < 2)
2653 {
2654 glink_vma += 8;
2655 if (i >= 0x8000)
2656 glink_vma += 4;
2657 }
2658 else
2659 glink_vma += 4;
2660 }
2661 count += plt_count;
2662 }
2663 }
2664
2665 done:
2666 free (syms);
2667 return count;
2668 }
2669 \f
2670 /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while
2671 functions above are used generally. Those named ppc64_elf_* are
2672 called by the main ELF linker code. They appear in this file more
2673 or less in the order in which they are called. eg.
2674 ppc64_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process,
2675 ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions
2676 called.
2677
2678 PowerPC64-ELF uses a similar scheme to PowerPC64-XCOFF in that
2679 functions have both a function code symbol and a function descriptor
2680 symbol. A call to foo in a relocatable object file looks like:
2681
2682 . .text
2683 . x:
2684 . bl .foo
2685 . nop
2686
2687 The function definition in another object file might be:
2688
2689 . .section .opd
2690 . foo: .quad .foo
2691 . .quad .TOC.@tocbase
2692 . .quad 0
2693 .
2694 . .text
2695 . .foo: blr
2696
2697 When the linker resolves the call during a static link, the branch
2698 unsurprisingly just goes to .foo and the .opd information is unused.
2699 If the function definition is in a shared library, things are a little
2700 different: The call goes via a plt call stub, the opd information gets
2701 copied to the plt, and the linker patches the nop.
2702
2703 . x:
2704 . bl .foo_stub
2705 . ld 2,40(1)
2706 .
2707 .
2708 . .foo_stub:
2709 . std 2,40(1) # in practice, the call stub
2710 . addis 11,2,Lfoo@toc@ha # is slightly optimized, but
2711 . addi 11,11,Lfoo@toc@l # this is the general idea
2712 . ld 12,0(11)
2713 . ld 2,8(11)
2714 . mtctr 12
2715 . ld 11,16(11)
2716 . bctr
2717 .
2718 . .section .plt
2719 . Lfoo: reloc (R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT, foo)
2720
2721 The "reloc ()" notation is supposed to indicate that the linker emits
2722 an R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT reloc against foo. The dynamic linker does the opd
2723 copying.
2724
2725 What are the difficulties here? Well, firstly, the relocations
2726 examined by the linker in check_relocs are against the function code
2727 sym .foo, while the dynamic relocation in the plt is emitted against
2728 the function descriptor symbol, foo. Somewhere along the line, we need
2729 to carefully copy dynamic link information from one symbol to the other.
2730 Secondly, the generic part of the elf linker will make .foo a dynamic
2731 symbol as is normal for most other backends. We need foo dynamic
2732 instead, at least for an application final link. However, when
2733 creating a shared library containing foo, we need to have both symbols
2734 dynamic so that references to .foo are satisfied during the early
2735 stages of linking. Otherwise the linker might decide to pull in a
2736 definition from some other object, eg. a static library.
2737
2738 Update: As of August 2004, we support a new convention. Function
2739 calls may use the function descriptor symbol, ie. "bl foo". This
2740 behaves exactly as "bl .foo". */
2741
2742 /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this
2743 function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared
2744 library or PIE, even when the symbol is local. */
2745
2746 static int
2747 must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2748 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type)
2749 {
2750 switch (r_type)
2751 {
2752 default:
2753 /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load
2754 address isn't fixed. DTPREL64 is excluded because the
2755 dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from
2756 local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC64_OPT_TLS is set. */
2757 return 1;
2758
2759 case R_PPC64_REL32:
2760 case R_PPC64_REL64:
2761 case R_PPC64_REL30:
2762 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
2763 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
2764 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
2765 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
2766 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
2767 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
2768 return 0;
2769
2770 case R_PPC64_TPREL16:
2771 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
2772 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI:
2773 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
2774 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
2775 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
2776 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:
2777 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
2778 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:
2779 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
2780 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:
2781 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
2782 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
2783 case R_PPC64_TPREL34:
2784 /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the
2785 linker doesn't know the thread pointer base. */
2786 return bfd_link_dll (info);
2787 }
2788 }
2789
2790 /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
2791 copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's .dynbss
2792 section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
2793 shared lib. With code that gcc generates it is vital that this be
2794 enabled; In the PowerPC64 ELFv1 ABI the address of a function is
2795 actually the address of a function descriptor which resides in the
2796 .opd section. gcc uses the descriptor directly rather than going
2797 via the GOT as some other ABIs do, which means that initialized
2798 function pointers reference the descriptor. Thus, a function
2799 pointer initialized to the address of a function in a shared
2800 library will either require a .dynbss copy and a copy reloc, or a
2801 dynamic reloc. Using a .dynbss copy redefines the function
2802 descriptor symbol to point to the copy. This presents a problem as
2803 a PLT entry for that function is also initialized from the function
2804 descriptor symbol and the copy may not be initialized first. */
2805 #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
2806
2807 /* Section name for stubs is the associated section name plus this
2808 string. */
2809 #define STUB_SUFFIX ".stub"
2810
2811 /* Linker stubs.
2812 ppc_stub_long_branch:
2813 Used when a 14 bit branch (or even a 24 bit branch) can't reach its
2814 destination, but a 24 bit branch in a stub section will reach.
2815 . b dest
2816
2817 ppc_stub_plt_branch:
2818 Similar to the above, but a 24 bit branch in the stub section won't
2819 reach its destination.
2820 . addis %r11,%r2,xxx@toc@ha
2821 . ld %r12,xxx@toc@l(%r11)
2822 . mtctr %r12
2823 . bctr
2824
2825 ppc_stub_plt_call:
2826 Used to call a function in a shared library. If it so happens that
2827 the plt entry referenced crosses a 64k boundary, then an extra
2828 "addi %r11,%r11,xxx@toc@l" will be inserted before the "mtctr".
2829 ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save starts with "std %r2,40(%r1)".
2830 . addis %r11,%r2,xxx@toc@ha
2831 . ld %r12,xxx+0@toc@l(%r11)
2832 . mtctr %r12
2833 . ld %r2,xxx+8@toc@l(%r11)
2834 . ld %r11,xxx+16@toc@l(%r11)
2835 . bctr
2836
2837 ppc_stub_long_branch and ppc_stub_plt_branch may also have additional
2838 code to adjust the value and save r2 to support multiple toc sections.
2839 A ppc_stub_long_branch with an r2 offset looks like:
2840 . std %r2,40(%r1)
2841 . addis %r2,%r2,off@ha
2842 . addi %r2,%r2,off@l
2843 . b dest
2844
2845 A ppc_stub_plt_branch with an r2 offset looks like:
2846 . std %r2,40(%r1)
2847 . addis %r11,%r2,xxx@toc@ha
2848 . ld %r12,xxx@toc@l(%r11)
2849 . addis %r2,%r2,off@ha
2850 . addi %r2,%r2,off@l
2851 . mtctr %r12
2852 . bctr
2853
2854 All of the above stubs are shown as their ELFv1 variants. ELFv2
2855 variants exist too, simpler for plt calls since a new toc pointer
2856 and static chain are not loaded by the stub. In addition, ELFv2
2857 has some more complex stubs to handle calls marked with NOTOC
2858 relocs from functions where r2 is not a valid toc pointer. These
2859 come in two flavours, the ones shown below, and _both variants that
2860 start with "std %r2,24(%r1)" to save r2 in the unlikely event that
2861 one call is from a function where r2 is used as the toc pointer but
2862 needs a toc adjusting stub for small-model multi-toc, and another
2863 call is from a function where r2 is not valid.
2864 ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc:
2865 . mflr %r12
2866 . bcl 20,31,1f
2867 . 1:
2868 . mflr %r11
2869 . mtlr %r12
2870 . addis %r12,%r11,dest-1b@ha
2871 . addi %r12,%r12,dest-1b@l
2872 . b dest
2873
2874 ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc:
2875 . mflr %r12
2876 . bcl 20,31,1f
2877 . 1:
2878 . mflr %r11
2879 . mtlr %r12
2880 . lis %r12,xxx-1b@highest
2881 . ori %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@higher
2882 . sldi %r12,%r12,32
2883 . oris %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@high
2884 . ori %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@l
2885 . add %r12,%r11,%r12
2886 . mtctr %r12
2887 . bctr
2888
2889 ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc:
2890 . mflr %r12
2891 . bcl 20,31,1f
2892 . 1:
2893 . mflr %r11
2894 . mtlr %r12
2895 . lis %r12,xxx-1b@highest
2896 . ori %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@higher
2897 . sldi %r12,%r12,32
2898 . oris %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@high
2899 . ori %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@l
2900 . ldx %r12,%r11,%r12
2901 . mtctr %r12
2902 . bctr
2903
2904 There are also ELFv1 powerxx variants of these stubs.
2905 ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc:
2906 . pla %r12,dest@pcrel
2907 . b dest
2908 ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc:
2909 . lis %r11,(dest-1f)@highesta34
2910 . ori %r11,%r11,(dest-1f)@highera34
2911 . sldi %r11,%r11,34
2912 . 1: pla %r12,dest@pcrel
2913 . add %r12,%r11,%r12
2914 . mtctr %r12
2915 . bctr
2916 ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc:
2917 . lis %r11,(xxx-1f)@highesta34
2918 . ori %r11,%r11,(xxx-1f)@highera34
2919 . sldi %r11,%r11,34
2920 . 1: pla %r12,xxx@pcrel
2921 . ldx %r12,%r11,%r12
2922 . mtctr %r12
2923 . bctr
2924
2925 In cases where the high instructions would add zero, they are
2926 omitted and following instructions modified in some cases.
2927 For example, a powerxx ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc might simplify down
2928 to
2929 . pld %r12,xxx@pcrel
2930 . mtctr %r12
2931 . bctr
2932
2933 For a given stub group (a set of sections all using the same toc
2934 pointer value) there will be just one stub type used for any
2935 particular function symbol. For example, if printf is called from
2936 code with the tocsave optimization (ie. r2 saved in function
2937 prologue) and therefore calls use a ppc_stub_plt_call linkage stub,
2938 and from other code without the tocsave optimization requiring a
2939 ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save linkage stub, a single stub of the latter
2940 type will be created. Calls with the tocsave optimization will
2941 enter this stub after the instruction saving r2. A similar
2942 situation exists when calls are marked with R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
2943 relocations. These require a ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc linkage stub
2944 to call an external function like printf. If other calls to printf
2945 require a ppc_stub_plt_call linkage stub then a single
2946 ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc linkage stub will be used for both types of
2947 call. If other calls to printf require a ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save
2948 linkage stub then a single ppc_stub_plt_call_both linkage stub will
2949 be created and calls not requiring r2 to be saved will enter the
2950 stub after the r2 save instruction. There is an analogous
2951 hierarchy of long branch and plt branch stubs for local call
2952 linkage. */
2953
2954 enum ppc_stub_type
2955 {
2956 ppc_stub_none,
2957 ppc_stub_long_branch,
2958 ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off,
2959 ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc,
2960 ppc_stub_long_branch_both, /* r2off and notoc variants both needed. */
2961 ppc_stub_plt_branch,
2962 ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off,
2963 ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc,
2964 ppc_stub_plt_branch_both,
2965 ppc_stub_plt_call,
2966 ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save,
2967 ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc,
2968 ppc_stub_plt_call_both,
2969 ppc_stub_global_entry,
2970 ppc_stub_save_res
2971 };
2972
2973 /* Information on stub grouping. */
2974 struct map_stub
2975 {
2976 /* The stub section. */
2977 asection *stub_sec;
2978 /* This is the section to which stubs in the group will be attached. */
2979 asection *link_sec;
2980 /* Next group. */
2981 struct map_stub *next;
2982 /* Whether to emit a copy of register save/restore functions in this
2983 group. */
2984 int needs_save_res;
2985 /* Current offset within stubs after the insn restoring lr in a
2986 _notoc or _both stub using bcl for pc-relative addressing, or
2987 after the insn restoring lr in a __tls_get_addr_opt plt stub. */
2988 unsigned int lr_restore;
2989 /* Accumulated size of EH info emitted to describe return address
2990 if stubs modify lr. Does not include 17 byte FDE header. */
2991 unsigned int eh_size;
2992 /* Offset in glink_eh_frame to the start of EH info for this group. */
2993 unsigned int eh_base;
2994 };
2995
2996 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry
2997 {
2998 /* Base hash table entry structure. */
2999 struct bfd_hash_entry root;
3000
3001 enum ppc_stub_type stub_type;
3002
3003 /* Group information. */
3004 struct map_stub *group;
3005
3006 /* Offset within stub_sec of the beginning of this stub. */
3007 bfd_vma stub_offset;
3008
3009 /* Given the symbol's value and its section we can determine its final
3010 value when building the stubs (so the stub knows where to jump. */
3011 bfd_vma target_value;
3012 asection *target_section;
3013
3014 /* The symbol table entry, if any, that this was derived from. */
3015 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h;
3016 struct plt_entry *plt_ent;
3017
3018 /* Symbol type. */
3019 unsigned char symtype;
3020
3021 /* Symbol st_other. */
3022 unsigned char other;
3023 };
3024
3025 struct ppc_branch_hash_entry
3026 {
3027 /* Base hash table entry structure. */
3028 struct bfd_hash_entry root;
3029
3030 /* Offset within branch lookup table. */
3031 unsigned int offset;
3032
3033 /* Generation marker. */
3034 unsigned int iter;
3035 };
3036
3037 /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols. */
3038 struct ppc_dyn_relocs
3039 {
3040 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next;
3041
3042 /* The input section of the reloc. */
3043 asection *sec;
3044
3045 /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section. */
3046 unsigned int count : 31;
3047
3048 /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols. */
3049 unsigned int ifunc : 1;
3050 };
3051
3052 struct ppc_link_hash_entry
3053 {
3054 struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
3055
3056 union
3057 {
3058 /* A pointer to the most recently used stub hash entry against this
3059 symbol. */
3060 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_cache;
3061
3062 /* A pointer to the next symbol starting with a '.' */
3063 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *next_dot_sym;
3064 } u;
3065
3066 /* Track dynamic relocs copied for this symbol. */
3067 struct elf_dyn_relocs *dyn_relocs;
3068
3069 /* Link between function code and descriptor symbols. */
3070 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *oh;
3071
3072 /* Flag function code and descriptor symbols. */
3073 unsigned int is_func:1;
3074 unsigned int is_func_descriptor:1;
3075 unsigned int fake:1;
3076
3077 /* Whether global opd/toc sym has been adjusted or not.
3078 After ppc64_elf_edit_opd/ppc64_elf_edit_toc has run, this flag
3079 should be set for all globals defined in any opd/toc section. */
3080 unsigned int adjust_done:1;
3081
3082 /* Set if this is an out-of-line register save/restore function,
3083 with non-standard calling convention. */
3084 unsigned int save_res:1;
3085
3086 /* Set if a duplicate symbol with non-zero localentry is detected,
3087 even when the duplicate symbol does not provide a definition. */
3088 unsigned int non_zero_localentry:1;
3089
3090 /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT (or TOC).
3091 Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are
3092 encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any
3093 of the other TLS bits are set. tls_optimize clears bits when
3094 optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not
3095 needed. If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared. tls_optimize may also
3096 set TLS_GDIE when a GD reloc turns into an IE one.
3097 These flags are also kept for local symbols. */
3098 #define TLS_TLS 1 /* Any TLS reloc. */
3099 #define TLS_GD 2 /* GD reloc. */
3100 #define TLS_LD 4 /* LD reloc. */
3101 #define TLS_TPREL 8 /* TPREL reloc, => IE. */
3102 #define TLS_DTPREL 16 /* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */
3103 #define TLS_MARK 32 /* __tls_get_addr call marked. */
3104 #define TLS_GDIE 64 /* GOT TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */
3105 #define TLS_EXPLICIT 256 /* TOC section TLS reloc, not stored. */
3106 unsigned char tls_mask;
3107
3108 /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols. In which
3109 case TLS_TLS will be 0. */
3110 #define PLT_IFUNC 2 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
3111 #define PLT_KEEP 4 /* inline plt call requires plt entry. */
3112 #define NON_GOT 256 /* local symbol plt, not stored. */
3113 };
3114
3115 static inline struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
3116 ppc_elf_hash_entry (struct elf_link_hash_entry *ent)
3117 {
3118 return (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) ent;
3119 }
3120
3121 /* ppc64 ELF linker hash table. */
3122
3123 struct ppc_link_hash_table
3124 {
3125 struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
3126
3127 /* The stub hash table. */
3128 struct bfd_hash_table stub_hash_table;
3129
3130 /* Another hash table for plt_branch stubs. */
3131 struct bfd_hash_table branch_hash_table;
3132
3133 /* Hash table for function prologue tocsave. */
3134 htab_t tocsave_htab;
3135
3136 /* Various options and other info passed from the linker. */
3137 struct ppc64_elf_params *params;
3138
3139 /* The size of sec_info below. */
3140 unsigned int sec_info_arr_size;
3141
3142 /* Per-section array of extra section info. Done this way rather
3143 than as part of ppc64_elf_section_data so we have the info for
3144 non-ppc64 sections. */
3145 struct
3146 {
3147 /* Along with elf_gp, specifies the TOC pointer used by this section. */
3148 bfd_vma toc_off;
3149
3150 union
3151 {
3152 /* The section group that this section belongs to. */
3153 struct map_stub *group;
3154 /* A temp section list pointer. */
3155 asection *list;
3156 } u;
3157 } *sec_info;
3158
3159 /* Linked list of groups. */
3160 struct map_stub *group;
3161
3162 /* Temp used when calculating TOC pointers. */
3163 bfd_vma toc_curr;
3164 bfd *toc_bfd;
3165 asection *toc_first_sec;
3166
3167 /* Used when adding symbols. */
3168 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *dot_syms;
3169
3170 /* Shortcuts to get to dynamic linker sections. */
3171 asection *glink;
3172 asection *global_entry;
3173 asection *sfpr;
3174 asection *pltlocal;
3175 asection *relpltlocal;
3176 asection *brlt;
3177 asection *relbrlt;
3178 asection *glink_eh_frame;
3179
3180 /* Shortcut to .__tls_get_addr and __tls_get_addr. */
3181 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr;
3182 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr_fd;
3183 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *tga_desc;
3184 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *tga_desc_fd;
3185 struct map_stub *tga_group;
3186
3187 /* The size of reliplt used by got entry relocs. */
3188 bfd_size_type got_reli_size;
3189
3190 /* Statistics. */
3191 unsigned long stub_count[ppc_stub_global_entry];
3192
3193 /* Number of stubs against global syms. */
3194 unsigned long stub_globals;
3195
3196 /* Set if we're linking code with function descriptors. */
3197 unsigned int opd_abi:1;
3198
3199 /* Support for multiple toc sections. */
3200 unsigned int do_multi_toc:1;
3201 unsigned int multi_toc_needed:1;
3202 unsigned int second_toc_pass:1;
3203 unsigned int do_toc_opt:1;
3204
3205 /* Set if tls optimization is enabled. */
3206 unsigned int do_tls_opt:1;
3207
3208 /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls. */
3209 unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1;
3210
3211 /* Set on error. */
3212 unsigned int stub_error:1;
3213
3214 /* Whether func_desc_adjust needs to be run over symbols. */
3215 unsigned int need_func_desc_adj:1;
3216
3217 /* Whether there exist local gnu indirect function resolvers,
3218 referenced by dynamic relocations. */
3219 unsigned int local_ifunc_resolver:1;
3220 unsigned int maybe_local_ifunc_resolver:1;
3221
3222 /* Whether plt calls for ELFv2 localentry:0 funcs have been optimized. */
3223 unsigned int has_plt_localentry0:1;
3224
3225 /* Whether calls are made via the PLT from NOTOC functions. */
3226 unsigned int notoc_plt:1;
3227
3228 /* Whether to use powerxx instructions in linkage stubs. */
3229 unsigned int powerxx_stubs:1;
3230
3231 /* Incremented every time we size stubs. */
3232 unsigned int stub_iteration;
3233
3234 /* Small local sym cache. */
3235 struct sym_cache sym_cache;
3236 };
3237
3238 /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
3239 are used here. */
3240
3241 /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations. */
3242 #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0
3243
3244 /* Nonzero if this section has a call to __tls_get_addr lacking marker
3245 relocations. */
3246 #define nomark_tls_get_addr sec_flg1
3247
3248 /* Nonzero if this section has any toc or got relocs. */
3249 #define has_toc_reloc sec_flg2
3250
3251 /* Nonzero if this section has a call to another section that uses
3252 the toc or got. */
3253 #define makes_toc_func_call sec_flg3
3254
3255 /* Recursion protection when determining above flag. */
3256 #define call_check_in_progress sec_flg4
3257 #define call_check_done sec_flg5
3258
3259 /* Get the ppc64 ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
3260
3261 #define ppc_hash_table(p) \
3262 (elf_hash_table_id ((struct elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) \
3263 == PPC64_ELF_DATA ? ((struct ppc_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) : NULL)
3264
3265 #define ppc_stub_hash_lookup(table, string, create, copy) \
3266 ((struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *) \
3267 bfd_hash_lookup ((table), (string), (create), (copy)))
3268
3269 #define ppc_branch_hash_lookup(table, string, create, copy) \
3270 ((struct ppc_branch_hash_entry *) \
3271 bfd_hash_lookup ((table), (string), (create), (copy)))
3272
3273 /* Create an entry in the stub hash table. */
3274
3275 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
3276 stub_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
3277 struct bfd_hash_table *table,
3278 const char *string)
3279 {
3280 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
3281 subclass. */
3282 if (entry == NULL)
3283 {
3284 entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry));
3285 if (entry == NULL)
3286 return entry;
3287 }
3288
3289 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
3290 entry = bfd_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
3291 if (entry != NULL)
3292 {
3293 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *eh;
3294
3295 /* Initialize the local fields. */
3296 eh = (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *) entry;
3297 eh->stub_type = ppc_stub_none;
3298 eh->group = NULL;
3299 eh->stub_offset = 0;
3300 eh->target_value = 0;
3301 eh->target_section = NULL;
3302 eh->h = NULL;
3303 eh->plt_ent = NULL;
3304 eh->other = 0;
3305 }
3306
3307 return entry;
3308 }
3309
3310 /* Create an entry in the branch hash table. */
3311
3312 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
3313 branch_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
3314 struct bfd_hash_table *table,
3315 const char *string)
3316 {
3317 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
3318 subclass. */
3319 if (entry == NULL)
3320 {
3321 entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct ppc_branch_hash_entry));
3322 if (entry == NULL)
3323 return entry;
3324 }
3325
3326 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
3327 entry = bfd_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
3328 if (entry != NULL)
3329 {
3330 struct ppc_branch_hash_entry *eh;
3331
3332 /* Initialize the local fields. */
3333 eh = (struct ppc_branch_hash_entry *) entry;
3334 eh->offset = 0;
3335 eh->iter = 0;
3336 }
3337
3338 return entry;
3339 }
3340
3341 /* Create an entry in a ppc64 ELF linker hash table. */
3342
3343 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
3344 link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
3345 struct bfd_hash_table *table,
3346 const char *string)
3347 {
3348 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
3349 subclass. */
3350 if (entry == NULL)
3351 {
3352 entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct ppc_link_hash_entry));
3353 if (entry == NULL)
3354 return entry;
3355 }
3356
3357 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
3358 entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
3359 if (entry != NULL)
3360 {
3361 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) entry;
3362
3363 memset (&eh->u.stub_cache, 0,
3364 (sizeof (struct ppc_link_hash_entry)
3365 - offsetof (struct ppc_link_hash_entry, u.stub_cache)));
3366
3367 /* When making function calls, old ABI code references function entry
3368 points (dot symbols), while new ABI code references the function
3369 descriptor symbol. We need to make any combination of reference and
3370 definition work together, without breaking archive linking.
3371
3372 For a defined function "foo" and an undefined call to "bar":
3373 An old object defines "foo" and ".foo", references ".bar" (possibly
3374 "bar" too).
3375 A new object defines "foo" and references "bar".
3376
3377 A new object thus has no problem with its undefined symbols being
3378 satisfied by definitions in an old object. On the other hand, the
3379 old object won't have ".bar" satisfied by a new object.
3380
3381 Keep a list of newly added dot-symbols. */
3382
3383 if (string[0] == '.')
3384 {
3385 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3386
3387 htab = (struct ppc_link_hash_table *) table;
3388 eh->u.next_dot_sym = htab->dot_syms;
3389 htab->dot_syms = eh;
3390 }
3391 }
3392
3393 return entry;
3394 }
3395
3396 struct tocsave_entry
3397 {
3398 asection *sec;
3399 bfd_vma offset;
3400 };
3401
3402 static hashval_t
3403 tocsave_htab_hash (const void *p)
3404 {
3405 const struct tocsave_entry *e = (const struct tocsave_entry *) p;
3406 return ((bfd_vma) (intptr_t) e->sec ^ e->offset) >> 3;
3407 }
3408
3409 static int
3410 tocsave_htab_eq (const void *p1, const void *p2)
3411 {
3412 const struct tocsave_entry *e1 = (const struct tocsave_entry *) p1;
3413 const struct tocsave_entry *e2 = (const struct tocsave_entry *) p2;
3414 return e1->sec == e2->sec && e1->offset == e2->offset;
3415 }
3416
3417 /* Destroy a ppc64 ELF linker hash table. */
3418
3419 static void
3420 ppc64_elf_link_hash_table_free (bfd *obfd)
3421 {
3422 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3423
3424 htab = (struct ppc_link_hash_table *) obfd->link.hash;
3425 if (htab->tocsave_htab)
3426 htab_delete (htab->tocsave_htab);
3427 bfd_hash_table_free (&htab->branch_hash_table);
3428 bfd_hash_table_free (&htab->stub_hash_table);
3429 _bfd_elf_link_hash_table_free (obfd);
3430 }
3431
3432 /* Create a ppc64 ELF linker hash table. */
3433
3434 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
3435 ppc64_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
3436 {
3437 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3438 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct ppc_link_hash_table);
3439
3440 htab = bfd_zmalloc (amt);
3441 if (htab == NULL)
3442 return NULL;
3443
3444 if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&htab->elf, abfd, link_hash_newfunc,
3445 sizeof (struct ppc_link_hash_entry),
3446 PPC64_ELF_DATA))
3447 {
3448 free (htab);
3449 return NULL;
3450 }
3451
3452 /* Init the stub hash table too. */
3453 if (!bfd_hash_table_init (&htab->stub_hash_table, stub_hash_newfunc,
3454 sizeof (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry)))
3455 {
3456 _bfd_elf_link_hash_table_free (abfd);
3457 return NULL;
3458 }
3459
3460 /* And the branch hash table. */
3461 if (!bfd_hash_table_init (&htab->branch_hash_table, branch_hash_newfunc,
3462 sizeof (struct ppc_branch_hash_entry)))
3463 {
3464 bfd_hash_table_free (&htab->stub_hash_table);
3465 _bfd_elf_link_hash_table_free (abfd);
3466 return NULL;
3467 }
3468
3469 htab->tocsave_htab = htab_try_create (1024,
3470 tocsave_htab_hash,
3471 tocsave_htab_eq,
3472 NULL);
3473 if (htab->tocsave_htab == NULL)
3474 {
3475 ppc64_elf_link_hash_table_free (abfd);
3476 return NULL;
3477 }
3478 htab->elf.root.hash_table_free = ppc64_elf_link_hash_table_free;
3479
3480 /* Initializing two fields of the union is just cosmetic. We really
3481 only care about glist, but when compiled on a 32-bit host the
3482 bfd_vma fields are larger. Setting the bfd_vma to zero makes
3483 debugger inspection of these fields look nicer. */
3484 htab->elf.init_got_refcount.refcount = 0;
3485 htab->elf.init_got_refcount.glist = NULL;
3486 htab->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0;
3487 htab->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL;
3488 htab->elf.init_got_offset.offset = 0;
3489 htab->elf.init_got_offset.glist = NULL;
3490 htab->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0;
3491 htab->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL;
3492
3493 return &htab->elf.root;
3494 }
3495
3496 /* Create sections for linker generated code. */
3497
3498 static bfd_boolean
3499 create_linkage_sections (bfd *dynobj, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3500 {
3501 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3502 flagword flags;
3503
3504 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
3505
3506 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY
3507 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3508 if (htab->params->save_restore_funcs)
3509 {
3510 /* Create .sfpr for code to save and restore fp regs. */
3511 htab->sfpr = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".sfpr",
3512 flags);
3513 if (htab->sfpr == NULL
3514 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->sfpr, 2))
3515 return FALSE;
3516 }
3517
3518 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
3519 return TRUE;
3520
3521 /* Create .glink for lazy dynamic linking support. */
3522 htab->glink = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".glink",
3523 flags);
3524 if (htab->glink == NULL
3525 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->glink, 3))
3526 return FALSE;
3527
3528 /* The part of .glink used by global entry stubs, separate so that
3529 it can be aligned appropriately without affecting htab->glink. */
3530 htab->global_entry = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".glink",
3531 flags);
3532 if (htab->global_entry == NULL
3533 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->global_entry, 2))
3534 return FALSE;
3535
3536 if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info)
3537 {
3538 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
3539 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3540 htab->glink_eh_frame = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj,
3541 ".eh_frame",
3542 flags);
3543 if (htab->glink_eh_frame == NULL
3544 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->glink_eh_frame, 2))
3545 return FALSE;
3546 }
3547
3548 flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
3549 htab->elf.iplt = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".iplt", flags);
3550 if (htab->elf.iplt == NULL
3551 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->elf.iplt, 3))
3552 return FALSE;
3553
3554 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
3555 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3556 htab->elf.irelplt
3557 = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".rela.iplt", flags);
3558 if (htab->elf.irelplt == NULL
3559 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->elf.irelplt, 3))
3560 return FALSE;
3561
3562 /* Create branch lookup table for plt_branch stubs. */
3563 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
3564 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3565 htab->brlt = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".branch_lt",
3566 flags);
3567 if (htab->brlt == NULL
3568 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->brlt, 3))
3569 return FALSE;
3570
3571 /* Local plt entries, put in .branch_lt but a separate section for
3572 convenience. */
3573 htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".branch_lt",
3574 flags);
3575 if (htab->pltlocal == NULL
3576 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->pltlocal, 3))
3577 return FALSE;
3578
3579 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
3580 return TRUE;
3581
3582 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
3583 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3584 htab->relbrlt
3585 = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
3586 if (htab->relbrlt == NULL
3587 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->relbrlt, 3))
3588 return FALSE;
3589
3590 htab->relpltlocal
3591 = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
3592 if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL
3593 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->relpltlocal, 3))
3594 return FALSE;
3595
3596 return TRUE;
3597 }
3598
3599 /* Satisfy the ELF linker by filling in some fields in our fake bfd. */
3600
3601 bfd_boolean
3602 ppc64_elf_init_stub_bfd (struct bfd_link_info *info,
3603 struct ppc64_elf_params *params)
3604 {
3605 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3606
3607 elf_elfheader (params->stub_bfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = ELFCLASS64;
3608
3609 /* Always hook our dynamic sections into the first bfd, which is the
3610 linker created stub bfd. This ensures that the GOT header is at
3611 the start of the output TOC section. */
3612 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
3613 htab->elf.dynobj = params->stub_bfd;
3614 htab->params = params;
3615
3616 return create_linkage_sections (htab->elf.dynobj, info);
3617 }
3618
3619 /* Build a name for an entry in the stub hash table. */
3620
3621 static char *
3622 ppc_stub_name (const asection *input_section,
3623 const asection *sym_sec,
3624 const struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h,
3625 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
3626 {
3627 char *stub_name;
3628 ssize_t len;
3629
3630 /* rel->r_addend is actually 64 bit, but who uses more than +/- 2^31
3631 offsets from a sym as a branch target? In fact, we could
3632 probably assume the addend is always zero. */
3633 BFD_ASSERT (((int) rel->r_addend & 0xffffffff) == rel->r_addend);
3634
3635 if (h)
3636 {
3637 len = 8 + 1 + strlen (h->elf.root.root.string) + 1 + 8 + 1;
3638 stub_name = bfd_malloc (len);
3639 if (stub_name == NULL)
3640 return stub_name;
3641
3642 len = sprintf (stub_name, "%08x.%s+%x",
3643 input_section->id & 0xffffffff,
3644 h->elf.root.root.string,
3645 (int) rel->r_addend & 0xffffffff);
3646 }
3647 else
3648 {
3649 len = 8 + 1 + 8 + 1 + 8 + 1 + 8 + 1;
3650 stub_name = bfd_malloc (len);
3651 if (stub_name == NULL)
3652 return stub_name;
3653
3654 len = sprintf (stub_name, "%08x.%x:%x+%x",
3655 input_section->id & 0xffffffff,
3656 sym_sec->id & 0xffffffff,
3657 (int) ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info) & 0xffffffff,
3658 (int) rel->r_addend & 0xffffffff);
3659 }
3660 if (len > 2 && stub_name[len - 2] == '+' && stub_name[len - 1] == '0')
3661 stub_name[len - 2] = 0;
3662 return stub_name;
3663 }
3664
3665 /* Look up an entry in the stub hash. Stub entries are cached because
3666 creating the stub name takes a bit of time. */
3667
3668 static struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *
3669 ppc_get_stub_entry (const asection *input_section,
3670 const asection *sym_sec,
3671 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h,
3672 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
3673 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab)
3674 {
3675 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
3676 struct map_stub *group;
3677
3678 /* If this input section is part of a group of sections sharing one
3679 stub section, then use the id of the first section in the group.
3680 Stub names need to include a section id, as there may well be
3681 more than one stub used to reach say, printf, and we need to
3682 distinguish between them. */
3683 group = htab->sec_info[input_section->id].u.group;
3684 if (group == NULL)
3685 return NULL;
3686
3687 if (h != NULL && h->u.stub_cache != NULL
3688 && h->u.stub_cache->h == h
3689 && h->u.stub_cache->group == group)
3690 {
3691 stub_entry = h->u.stub_cache;
3692 }
3693 else
3694 {
3695 char *stub_name;
3696
3697 stub_name = ppc_stub_name (group->link_sec, sym_sec, h, rel);
3698 if (stub_name == NULL)
3699 return NULL;
3700
3701 stub_entry = ppc_stub_hash_lookup (&htab->stub_hash_table,
3702 stub_name, FALSE, FALSE);
3703 if (h != NULL)
3704 h->u.stub_cache = stub_entry;
3705
3706 free (stub_name);
3707 }
3708
3709 return stub_entry;
3710 }
3711
3712 /* Add a new stub entry to the stub hash. Not all fields of the new
3713 stub entry are initialised. */
3714
3715 static struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *
3716 ppc_add_stub (const char *stub_name,
3717 asection *section,
3718 struct bfd_link_info *info)
3719 {
3720 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
3721 struct map_stub *group;
3722 asection *link_sec;
3723 asection *stub_sec;
3724 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
3725
3726 group = htab->sec_info[section->id].u.group;
3727 link_sec = group->link_sec;
3728 stub_sec = group->stub_sec;
3729 if (stub_sec == NULL)
3730 {
3731 size_t namelen;
3732 bfd_size_type len;
3733 char *s_name;
3734
3735 namelen = strlen (link_sec->name);
3736 len = namelen + sizeof (STUB_SUFFIX);
3737 s_name = bfd_alloc (htab->params->stub_bfd, len);
3738 if (s_name == NULL)
3739 return NULL;
3740
3741 memcpy (s_name, link_sec->name, namelen);
3742 memcpy (s_name + namelen, STUB_SUFFIX, sizeof (STUB_SUFFIX));
3743 stub_sec = (*htab->params->add_stub_section) (s_name, link_sec);
3744 if (stub_sec == NULL)
3745 return NULL;
3746 group->stub_sec = stub_sec;
3747 }
3748
3749 /* Enter this entry into the linker stub hash table. */
3750 stub_entry = ppc_stub_hash_lookup (&htab->stub_hash_table, stub_name,
3751 TRUE, FALSE);
3752 if (stub_entry == NULL)
3753 {
3754 /* xgettext:c-format */
3755 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: cannot create stub entry %s"),
3756 section->owner, stub_name);
3757 return NULL;
3758 }
3759
3760 stub_entry->group = group;
3761 stub_entry->stub_offset = 0;
3762 return stub_entry;
3763 }
3764
3765 /* Create .got and .rela.got sections in ABFD, and .got in dynobj if
3766 not already done. */
3767
3768 static bfd_boolean
3769 create_got_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3770 {
3771 asection *got, *relgot;
3772 flagword flags;
3773 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
3774
3775 if (!is_ppc64_elf (abfd))
3776 return FALSE;
3777 if (htab == NULL)
3778 return FALSE;
3779
3780 if (!htab->elf.sgot
3781 && !_bfd_elf_create_got_section (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
3782 return FALSE;
3783
3784 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
3785 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3786
3787 got = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".got", flags);
3788 if (!got
3789 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (got, 3))
3790 return FALSE;
3791
3792 relgot = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.got",
3793 flags | SEC_READONLY);
3794 if (!relgot
3795 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (relgot, 3))
3796 return FALSE;
3797
3798 ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->got = got;
3799 ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->relgot = relgot;
3800 return TRUE;
3801 }
3802
3803 /* Follow indirect and warning symbol links. */
3804
3805 static inline struct bfd_link_hash_entry *
3806 follow_link (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h)
3807 {
3808 while (h->type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3809 || h->type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3810 h = h->u.i.link;
3811 return h;
3812 }
3813
3814 static inline struct elf_link_hash_entry *
3815 elf_follow_link (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
3816 {
3817 return (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) follow_link (&h->root);
3818 }
3819
3820 static inline struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
3821 ppc_follow_link (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h)
3822 {
3823 return ppc_elf_hash_entry (elf_follow_link (&h->elf));
3824 }
3825
3826 /* Merge PLT info on FROM with that on TO. */
3827
3828 static void
3829 move_plt_plist (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *from,
3830 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *to)
3831 {
3832 if (from->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
3833 {
3834 if (to->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
3835 {
3836 struct plt_entry **entp;
3837 struct plt_entry *ent;
3838
3839 for (entp = &from->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
3840 {
3841 struct plt_entry *dent;
3842
3843 for (dent = to->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
3844 if (dent->addend == ent->addend)
3845 {
3846 dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount;
3847 *entp = ent->next;
3848 break;
3849 }
3850 if (dent == NULL)
3851 entp = &ent->next;
3852 }
3853 *entp = to->elf.plt.plist;
3854 }
3855
3856 to->elf.plt.plist = from->elf.plt.plist;
3857 from->elf.plt.plist = NULL;
3858 }
3859 }
3860
3861 /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry. */
3862
3863 static void
3864 ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
3865 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
3866 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
3867 {
3868 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
3869
3870 edir = ppc_elf_hash_entry (dir);
3871 eind = ppc_elf_hash_entry (ind);
3872
3873 edir->is_func |= eind->is_func;
3874 edir->is_func_descriptor |= eind->is_func_descriptor;
3875 edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask;
3876 if (eind->oh != NULL)
3877 edir->oh = ppc_follow_link (eind->oh);
3878
3879 if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden)
3880 edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic;
3881 edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular;
3882 edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
3883 edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref;
3884 edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt;
3885 edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed;
3886
3887 /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, don't copy
3888 dyn_relocs, plt/got info, or dynindx. We used to copy dyn_relocs
3889 in order to simplify readonly_dynrelocs and save a field in the
3890 symbol hash entry, but that means dyn_relocs can't be used in any
3891 tests about a specific symbol, or affect other symbol flags which
3892 are then tested. */
3893 if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
3894 return;
3895
3896 /* Copy over any dynamic relocs we may have on the indirect sym. */
3897 if (eind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
3898 {
3899 if (edir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
3900 {
3901 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
3902 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
3903
3904 /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
3905 list. Merge any entries against the same section. */
3906 for (pp = &eind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
3907 {
3908 struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
3909
3910 for (q = edir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
3911 if (q->sec == p->sec)
3912 {
3913 q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
3914 q->count += p->count;
3915 *pp = p->next;
3916 break;
3917 }
3918 if (q == NULL)
3919 pp = &p->next;
3920 }
3921 *pp = edir->dyn_relocs;
3922 }
3923
3924 edir->dyn_relocs = eind->dyn_relocs;
3925 eind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
3926 }
3927
3928 /* Copy over got entries that we may have already seen to the
3929 symbol which just became indirect. */
3930 if (eind->elf.got.glist != NULL)
3931 {
3932 if (edir->elf.got.glist != NULL)
3933 {
3934 struct got_entry **entp;
3935 struct got_entry *ent;
3936
3937 for (entp = &eind->elf.got.glist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
3938 {
3939 struct got_entry *dent;
3940
3941 for (dent = edir->elf.got.glist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
3942 if (dent->addend == ent->addend
3943 && dent->owner == ent->owner
3944 && dent->tls_type == ent->tls_type)
3945 {
3946 dent->got.refcount += ent->got.refcount;
3947 *entp = ent->next;
3948 break;
3949 }
3950 if (dent == NULL)
3951 entp = &ent->next;
3952 }
3953 *entp = edir->elf.got.glist;
3954 }
3955
3956 edir->elf.got.glist = eind->elf.got.glist;
3957 eind->elf.got.glist = NULL;
3958 }
3959
3960 /* And plt entries. */
3961 move_plt_plist (eind, edir);
3962
3963 if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1)
3964 {
3965 if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1)
3966 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
3967 edir->elf.dynstr_index);
3968 edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx;
3969 edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index;
3970 eind->elf.dynindx = -1;
3971 eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0;
3972 }
3973 }
3974
3975 /* Find the function descriptor hash entry from the given function code
3976 hash entry FH. Link the entries via their OH fields. */
3977
3978 static struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
3979 lookup_fdh (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh, struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab)
3980 {
3981 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh = fh->oh;
3982
3983 if (fdh == NULL)
3984 {
3985 const char *fd_name = fh->elf.root.root.string + 1;
3986
3987 fdh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, fd_name,
3988 FALSE, FALSE, FALSE));
3989 if (fdh == NULL)
3990 return fdh;
3991
3992 fdh->is_func_descriptor = 1;
3993 fdh->oh = fh;
3994 fh->is_func = 1;
3995 fh->oh = fdh;
3996 }
3997
3998 fdh = ppc_follow_link (fdh);
3999 fdh->is_func_descriptor = 1;
4000 fdh->oh = fh;
4001 return fdh;
4002 }
4003
4004 /* Make a fake function descriptor sym for the undefined code sym FH. */
4005
4006 static struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
4007 make_fdh (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4008 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh)
4009 {
4010 bfd *abfd = fh->elf.root.u.undef.abfd;
4011 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh = NULL;
4012 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
4013 flagword flags = (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
4014 ? BSF_WEAK
4015 : BSF_GLOBAL);
4016
4017 if (!_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol (info, abfd,
4018 fh->elf.root.root.string + 1,
4019 flags, bfd_und_section_ptr, 0,
4020 NULL, FALSE, FALSE, &bh))
4021 return NULL;
4022
4023 fdh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) bh;
4024 fdh->elf.non_elf = 0;
4025 fdh->fake = 1;
4026 fdh->is_func_descriptor = 1;
4027 fdh->oh = fh;
4028 fh->is_func = 1;
4029 fh->oh = fdh;
4030 return fdh;
4031 }
4032
4033 /* Fix function descriptor symbols defined in .opd sections to be
4034 function type. */
4035
4036 static bfd_boolean
4037 ppc64_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *ibfd,
4038 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4039 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
4040 const char **name,
4041 flagword *flags ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4042 asection **sec,
4043 bfd_vma *value)
4044 {
4045 if (*sec != NULL
4046 && strcmp ((*sec)->name, ".opd") == 0)
4047 {
4048 asection *code_sec;
4049
4050 if (!(ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4051 || ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_FUNC))
4052 isym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (ELF_ST_BIND (isym->st_info), STT_FUNC);
4053
4054 /* If the symbol is a function defined in .opd, and the function
4055 code is in a discarded group, let it appear to be undefined. */
4056 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
4057 && (*sec)->reloc_count != 0
4058 && opd_entry_value (*sec, *value, &code_sec, NULL,
4059 FALSE) != (bfd_vma) -1
4060 && discarded_section (code_sec))
4061 {
4062 *sec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
4063 isym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
4064 }
4065 }
4066 else if (*sec != NULL
4067 && strcmp ((*sec)->name, ".toc") == 0
4068 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_OBJECT)
4069 {
4070 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
4071 if (htab != NULL)
4072 htab->params->object_in_toc = 1;
4073 }
4074
4075 if ((STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK & isym->st_other) != 0)
4076 {
4077 if (abiversion (ibfd) == 0)
4078 set_abiversion (ibfd, 2);
4079 else if (abiversion (ibfd) == 1)
4080 {
4081 _bfd_error_handler (_("symbol '%s' has invalid st_other"
4082 " for ABI version 1"), *name);
4083 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4084 return FALSE;
4085 }
4086 }
4087
4088 return TRUE;
4089 }
4090
4091 /* Merge non-visibility st_other attributes: local entry point. */
4092
4093 static void
4094 ppc64_elf_merge_symbol_attribute (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4095 const Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
4096 bfd_boolean definition,
4097 bfd_boolean dynamic)
4098 {
4099 if (definition && (!dynamic || !h->def_regular))
4100 h->other = ((isym->st_other & ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1))
4101 | ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other));
4102 }
4103
4104 /* Hook called on merging a symbol. We use this to clear "fake" since
4105 we now have a real symbol. */
4106
4107 static bfd_boolean
4108 ppc64_elf_merge_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4109 const Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
4110 asection **psec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4111 bfd_boolean newdef ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4112 bfd_boolean olddef ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4113 bfd *oldbfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4114 const asection *oldsec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4115 {
4116 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->fake = 0;
4117 if ((STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK & isym->st_other) != 0)
4118 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->non_zero_localentry = 1;
4119 return TRUE;
4120 }
4121
4122 /* This function makes an old ABI object reference to ".bar" cause the
4123 inclusion of a new ABI object archive that defines "bar".
4124 NAME is a symbol defined in an archive. Return a symbol in the hash
4125 table that might be satisfied by the archive symbols. */
4126
4127 static struct elf_link_hash_entry *
4128 ppc64_elf_archive_symbol_lookup (bfd *abfd,
4129 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4130 const char *name)
4131 {
4132 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4133 char *dot_name;
4134 size_t len;
4135
4136 h = _bfd_elf_archive_symbol_lookup (abfd, info, name);
4137 if (h != NULL
4138 /* Don't return this sym if it is a fake function descriptor
4139 created by add_symbol_adjust. */
4140 && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->fake)
4141 return h;
4142
4143 if (name[0] == '.')
4144 return h;
4145
4146 len = strlen (name);
4147 dot_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 2);
4148 if (dot_name == NULL)
4149 return (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) -1;
4150 dot_name[0] = '.';
4151 memcpy (dot_name + 1, name, len + 1);
4152 h = _bfd_elf_archive_symbol_lookup (abfd, info, dot_name);
4153 bfd_release (abfd, dot_name);
4154 if (h != NULL)
4155 return h;
4156
4157 if (strcmp (name, "__tls_get_addr_opt") == 0)
4158 h = _bfd_elf_archive_symbol_lookup (abfd, info, "__tls_get_addr_desc");
4159 return h;
4160 }
4161
4162 /* This function satisfies all old ABI object references to ".bar" if a
4163 new ABI object defines "bar". Well, at least, undefined dot symbols
4164 are made weak. This stops later archive searches from including an
4165 object if we already have a function descriptor definition. It also
4166 prevents the linker complaining about undefined symbols.
4167 We also check and correct mismatched symbol visibility here. The
4168 most restrictive visibility of the function descriptor and the
4169 function entry symbol is used. */
4170
4171 static bfd_boolean
4172 add_symbol_adjust (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4173 {
4174 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
4175 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
4176
4177 if (eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4178 eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) eh->elf.root.u.i.link;
4179
4180 if (eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
4181 return TRUE;
4182
4183 if (eh->elf.root.root.string[0] != '.')
4184 abort ();
4185
4186 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
4187 if (htab == NULL)
4188 return FALSE;
4189
4190 fdh = lookup_fdh (eh, htab);
4191 if (fdh == NULL
4192 && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
4193 && (eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
4194 || eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
4195 && eh->elf.ref_regular)
4196 {
4197 /* Make an undefined function descriptor sym, in order to
4198 pull in an --as-needed shared lib. Archives are handled
4199 elsewhere. */
4200 fdh = make_fdh (info, eh);
4201 if (fdh == NULL)
4202 return FALSE;
4203 }
4204
4205 if (fdh != NULL)
4206 {
4207 unsigned entry_vis = ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (eh->elf.other) - 1;
4208 unsigned descr_vis = ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (fdh->elf.other) - 1;
4209
4210 /* Make both descriptor and entry symbol have the most
4211 constraining visibility of either symbol. */
4212 if (entry_vis < descr_vis)
4213 fdh->elf.other += entry_vis - descr_vis;
4214 else if (entry_vis > descr_vis)
4215 eh->elf.other += descr_vis - entry_vis;
4216
4217 /* Propagate reference flags from entry symbol to function
4218 descriptor symbol. */
4219 fdh->elf.root.non_ir_ref_regular |= eh->elf.root.non_ir_ref_regular;
4220 fdh->elf.root.non_ir_ref_dynamic |= eh->elf.root.non_ir_ref_dynamic;
4221 fdh->elf.ref_regular |= eh->elf.ref_regular;
4222 fdh->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eh->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
4223
4224 if (!fdh->elf.forced_local
4225 && fdh->elf.dynindx == -1
4226 && fdh->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden
4227 && (bfd_link_dll (info)
4228 || fdh->elf.def_dynamic
4229 || fdh->elf.ref_dynamic)
4230 && (eh->elf.ref_regular
4231 || eh->elf.def_regular))
4232 {
4233 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, &fdh->elf))
4234 return FALSE;
4235 }
4236 }
4237
4238 return TRUE;
4239 }
4240
4241 /* Set up opd section info and abiversion for IBFD, and process list
4242 of dot-symbols we made in link_hash_newfunc. */
4243
4244 static bfd_boolean
4245 ppc64_elf_before_check_relocs (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4246 {
4247 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
4248 struct ppc_link_hash_entry **p, *eh;
4249 asection *opd = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".opd");
4250
4251 if (opd != NULL && opd->size != 0)
4252 {
4253 BFD_ASSERT (ppc64_elf_section_data (opd)->sec_type == sec_normal);
4254 ppc64_elf_section_data (opd)->sec_type = sec_opd;
4255
4256 if (abiversion (ibfd) == 0)
4257 set_abiversion (ibfd, 1);
4258 else if (abiversion (ibfd) >= 2)
4259 {
4260 /* xgettext:c-format */
4261 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB .opd not allowed in ABI version %d"),
4262 ibfd, abiversion (ibfd));
4263 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4264 return FALSE;
4265 }
4266 }
4267
4268 if (is_ppc64_elf (info->output_bfd))
4269 {
4270 /* For input files without an explicit abiversion in e_flags
4271 we should have flagged any with symbol st_other bits set
4272 as ELFv1 and above flagged those with .opd as ELFv2.
4273 Set the output abiversion if not yet set, and for any input
4274 still ambiguous, take its abiversion from the output.
4275 Differences in ABI are reported later. */
4276 if (abiversion (info->output_bfd) == 0)
4277 set_abiversion (info->output_bfd, abiversion (ibfd));
4278 else if (abiversion (ibfd) == 0)
4279 set_abiversion (ibfd, abiversion (info->output_bfd));
4280 }
4281
4282 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
4283 if (htab == NULL)
4284 return TRUE;
4285
4286 if (opd != NULL && opd->size != 0
4287 && (ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) == 0
4288 && (opd->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0
4289 && opd->reloc_count != 0
4290 && !bfd_is_abs_section (opd->output_section)
4291 && info->gc_sections)
4292 {
4293 /* Garbage collection needs some extra help with .opd sections.
4294 We don't want to necessarily keep everything referenced by
4295 relocs in .opd, as that would keep all functions. Instead,
4296 if we reference an .opd symbol (a function descriptor), we
4297 want to keep the function code symbol's section. This is
4298 easy for global symbols, but for local syms we need to keep
4299 information about the associated function section. */
4300 bfd_size_type amt;
4301 asection **opd_sym_map;
4302 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4303 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs, *rel_end, *rel;
4304
4305 amt = OPD_NDX (opd->size) * sizeof (*opd_sym_map);
4306 opd_sym_map = bfd_zalloc (ibfd, amt);
4307 if (opd_sym_map == NULL)
4308 return FALSE;
4309 ppc64_elf_section_data (opd)->u.opd.func_sec = opd_sym_map;
4310 relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, opd, NULL, NULL,
4311 info->keep_memory);
4312 if (relocs == NULL)
4313 return FALSE;
4314 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4315 rel_end = relocs + opd->reloc_count - 1;
4316 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
4317 {
4318 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4319 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4320
4321 if (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR64
4322 && ELF64_R_TYPE ((rel + 1)->r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC
4323 && r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4324 {
4325 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
4326 asection *s;
4327
4328 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache, ibfd, r_symndx);
4329 if (isym == NULL)
4330 {
4331 if (elf_section_data (opd)->relocs != relocs)
4332 free (relocs);
4333 return FALSE;
4334 }
4335
4336 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, isym->st_shndx);
4337 if (s != NULL && s != opd)
4338 opd_sym_map[OPD_NDX (rel->r_offset)] = s;
4339 }
4340 }
4341 if (elf_section_data (opd)->relocs != relocs)
4342 free (relocs);
4343 }
4344
4345 p = &htab->dot_syms;
4346 while ((eh = *p) != NULL)
4347 {
4348 *p = NULL;
4349 if (&eh->elf == htab->elf.hgot)
4350 ;
4351 else if (htab->elf.hgot == NULL
4352 && strcmp (eh->elf.root.root.string, ".TOC.") == 0)
4353 htab->elf.hgot = &eh->elf;
4354 else if (abiversion (ibfd) <= 1)
4355 {
4356 htab->need_func_desc_adj = 1;
4357 if (!add_symbol_adjust (eh, info))
4358 return FALSE;
4359 }
4360 p = &eh->u.next_dot_sym;
4361 }
4362 return TRUE;
4363 }
4364
4365 /* Undo hash table changes when an --as-needed input file is determined
4366 not to be needed. */
4367
4368 static bfd_boolean
4369 ppc64_elf_notice_as_needed (bfd *ibfd,
4370 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4371 enum notice_asneeded_action act)
4372 {
4373 if (act == notice_not_needed)
4374 {
4375 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
4376
4377 if (htab == NULL)
4378 return FALSE;
4379
4380 htab->dot_syms = NULL;
4381 }
4382 return _bfd_elf_notice_as_needed (ibfd, info, act);
4383 }
4384
4385 /* If --just-symbols against a final linked binary, then assume we need
4386 toc adjusting stubs when calling functions defined there. */
4387
4388 static void
4389 ppc64_elf_link_just_syms (asection *sec, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4390 {
4391 if ((sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
4392 && (sec->owner->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) != 0
4393 && is_ppc64_elf (sec->owner))
4394 {
4395 if (abiversion (sec->owner) >= 2
4396 || bfd_get_section_by_name (sec->owner, ".opd") != NULL)
4397 sec->has_toc_reloc = 1;
4398 }
4399 _bfd_elf_link_just_syms (sec, info);
4400 }
4401
4402 static struct plt_entry **
4403 update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
4404 unsigned long r_symndx, bfd_vma r_addend, int tls_type)
4405 {
4406 struct got_entry **local_got_ents = elf_local_got_ents (abfd);
4407 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
4408 unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks;
4409
4410 if (local_got_ents == NULL)
4411 {
4412 bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
4413
4414 size *= (sizeof (*local_got_ents)
4415 + sizeof (*local_plt)
4416 + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks));
4417 local_got_ents = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
4418 if (local_got_ents == NULL)
4419 return NULL;
4420 elf_local_got_ents (abfd) = local_got_ents;
4421 }
4422
4423 if ((tls_type & (NON_GOT | TLS_EXPLICIT)) == 0)
4424 {
4425 struct got_entry *ent;
4426
4427 for (ent = local_got_ents[r_symndx]; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4428 if (ent->addend == r_addend
4429 && ent->owner == abfd
4430 && ent->tls_type == tls_type)
4431 break;
4432 if (ent == NULL)
4433 {
4434 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*ent);
4435 ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
4436 if (ent == NULL)
4437 return FALSE;
4438 ent->next = local_got_ents[r_symndx];
4439 ent->addend = r_addend;
4440 ent->owner = abfd;
4441 ent->tls_type = tls_type;
4442 ent->is_indirect = FALSE;
4443 ent->got.refcount = 0;
4444 local_got_ents[r_symndx] = ent;
4445 }
4446 ent->got.refcount += 1;
4447 }
4448
4449 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_ents + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4450 local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4451 local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff;
4452
4453 return local_plt + r_symndx;
4454 }
4455
4456 static bfd_boolean
4457 update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist, bfd_vma addend)
4458 {
4459 struct plt_entry *ent;
4460
4461 for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4462 if (ent->addend == addend)
4463 break;
4464 if (ent == NULL)
4465 {
4466 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*ent);
4467 ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
4468 if (ent == NULL)
4469 return FALSE;
4470 ent->next = *plist;
4471 ent->addend = addend;
4472 ent->plt.refcount = 0;
4473 *plist = ent;
4474 }
4475 ent->plt.refcount += 1;
4476 return TRUE;
4477 }
4478
4479 static bfd_boolean
4480 is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type)
4481 {
4482 return (r_type == R_PPC64_REL24
4483 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
4484 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14
4485 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN
4486 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN
4487 || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR24
4488 || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14
4489 || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
4490 || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
4491 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL
4492 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC);
4493 }
4494
4495 /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call. */
4496
4497 static bfd_boolean
4498 is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type)
4499 {
4500 return (r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_HA
4501 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_HI
4502 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_LO
4503 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS
4504 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34
4505 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC
4506 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLTSEQ
4507 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLTSEQ_NOTOC);
4508 }
4509
4510 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
4511 calculate needed space in the global offset table, procedure
4512 linkage table, and dynamic reloc sections. */
4513
4514 static bfd_boolean
4515 ppc64_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4516 asection *sec, const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
4517 {
4518 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
4519 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4520 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4521 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
4522 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
4523 asection *sreloc;
4524 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga, *dottga;
4525 bfd_boolean is_opd;
4526
4527 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
4528 return TRUE;
4529
4530 /* Don't do anything special with non-loaded, non-alloced sections.
4531 In particular, any relocs in such sections should not affect GOT
4532 and PLT reference counting (ie. we don't allow them to create GOT
4533 or PLT entries), there's no possibility or desire to optimize TLS
4534 relocs, and there's not much point in propagating relocs to shared
4535 libs that the dynamic linker won't relocate. */
4536 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
4537 return TRUE;
4538
4539 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc64_elf (abfd));
4540
4541 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
4542 if (htab == NULL)
4543 return FALSE;
4544
4545 tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
4546 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4547 dottga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, ".__tls_get_addr",
4548 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4549 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
4550 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
4551 sreloc = NULL;
4552 is_opd = ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->sec_type == sec_opd;
4553 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
4554 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
4555 {
4556 unsigned long r_symndx;
4557 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4558 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
4559 int tls_type;
4560 struct _ppc64_elf_section_data *ppc64_sec;
4561 struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list;
4562
4563 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4564 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4565 h = NULL;
4566 else
4567 {
4568 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4569 h = elf_follow_link (h);
4570
4571 if (h == htab->elf.hgot)
4572 sec->has_toc_reloc = 1;
4573 }
4574
4575 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4576 switch (r_type)
4577 {
4578 case R_PPC64_D34:
4579 case R_PPC64_D34_LO:
4580 case R_PPC64_D34_HI30:
4581 case R_PPC64_D34_HA30:
4582 case R_PPC64_D28:
4583 case R_PPC64_TPREL34:
4584 case R_PPC64_DTPREL34:
4585 case R_PPC64_PCREL34:
4586 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
4587 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD34:
4588 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD34:
4589 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL34:
4590 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL34:
4591 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34:
4592 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC:
4593 case R_PPC64_PCREL28:
4594 htab->powerxx_stubs = 1;
4595 break;
4596 default:
4597 break;
4598 }
4599
4600 switch (r_type)
4601 {
4602 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
4603 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
4604 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
4605 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
4606 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
4607 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
4608 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
4609 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO:
4610 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
4611 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
4612 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
4613 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
4614 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
4615 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO:
4616 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
4617 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
4618 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
4619 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
4620 ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_optrel = 1;
4621 ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->has_optrel = 1;
4622 break;
4623 default:
4624 break;
4625 }
4626
4627 ifunc = NULL;
4628 if (h != NULL)
4629 {
4630 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4631 {
4632 h->needs_plt = 1;
4633 ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
4634 }
4635 }
4636 else
4637 {
4638 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
4639 abfd, r_symndx);
4640 if (isym == NULL)
4641 return FALSE;
4642
4643 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4644 {
4645 ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
4646 rel->r_addend,
4647 NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC);
4648 if (ifunc == NULL)
4649 return FALSE;
4650 }
4651 }
4652
4653 tls_type = 0;
4654 switch (r_type)
4655 {
4656 case R_PPC64_TLSGD:
4657 case R_PPC64_TLSLD:
4658 /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with
4659 its parameter symbol. */
4660 if (h != NULL)
4661 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK;
4662 else
4663 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
4664 rel->r_addend,
4665 NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
4666 return FALSE;
4667 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
4668 break;
4669
4670 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16:
4671 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
4672 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
4673 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
4674 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD34:
4675 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
4676 goto dogottls;
4677
4678 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16:
4679 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
4680 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
4681 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
4682 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD34:
4683 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
4684 goto dogottls;
4685
4686 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS:
4687 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
4688 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
4689 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
4690 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL34:
4691 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
4692 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
4693 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
4694 goto dogottls;
4695
4696 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS:
4697 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
4698 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
4699 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
4700 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL34:
4701 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
4702 dogottls:
4703 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
4704 goto dogot;
4705
4706 case R_PPC64_GOT16:
4707 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO:
4708 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HI:
4709 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
4710 case R_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
4711 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
4712 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
4713 dogot:
4714 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */
4715 sec->has_toc_reloc = 1;
4716 if (r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16
4717 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16
4718 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS
4719 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS
4720 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT16
4721 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT16_DS)
4722 {
4723 htab->do_multi_toc = 1;
4724 ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_small_toc_reloc = 1;
4725 }
4726
4727 if (ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->got == NULL
4728 && !create_got_section (abfd, info))
4729 return FALSE;
4730
4731 if (h != NULL)
4732 {
4733 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
4734 struct got_entry *ent;
4735
4736 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
4737 for (ent = eh->elf.got.glist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4738 if (ent->addend == rel->r_addend
4739 && ent->owner == abfd
4740 && ent->tls_type == tls_type)
4741 break;
4742 if (ent == NULL)
4743 {
4744 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*ent);
4745 ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
4746 if (ent == NULL)
4747 return FALSE;
4748 ent->next = eh->elf.got.glist;
4749 ent->addend = rel->r_addend;
4750 ent->owner = abfd;
4751 ent->tls_type = tls_type;
4752 ent->is_indirect = FALSE;
4753 ent->got.refcount = 0;
4754 eh->elf.got.glist = ent;
4755 }
4756 ent->got.refcount += 1;
4757 eh->tls_mask |= tls_type;
4758 }
4759 else
4760 /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol. */
4761 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
4762 rel->r_addend, tls_type))
4763 return FALSE;
4764
4765 /* We may also need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
4766 an ifunc. */
4767 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info) && abiversion (abfd) != 1)
4768 {
4769 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, rel->r_addend))
4770 return FALSE;
4771 }
4772 break;
4773
4774 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
4775 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HI:
4776 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO:
4777 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
4778 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34:
4779 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC:
4780 case R_PPC64_PLT32:
4781 case R_PPC64_PLT64:
4782 /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry. */
4783 plt_list = ifunc;
4784 if (h != NULL)
4785 {
4786 h->needs_plt = 1;
4787 if (h->root.root.string[0] == '.'
4788 && h->root.root.string[1] != '\0')
4789 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->is_func = 1;
4790 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP;
4791 plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
4792 }
4793 if (plt_list == NULL)
4794 plt_list = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
4795 rel->r_addend,
4796 NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP);
4797 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, plt_list, rel->r_addend))
4798 return FALSE;
4799 break;
4800
4801 /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the
4802 relocation if linking a shared object since they are
4803 section relative. */
4804 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF:
4805 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO:
4806 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HI:
4807 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HA:
4808 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
4809 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
4810 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16:
4811 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO:
4812 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HI:
4813 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA:
4814 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
4815 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
4816 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGH:
4817 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA:
4818 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHER:
4819 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA:
4820 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHEST:
4821 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA:
4822 break;
4823
4824 /* Nor do these. */
4825 case R_PPC64_REL16:
4826 case R_PPC64_REL16_LO:
4827 case R_PPC64_REL16_HI:
4828 case R_PPC64_REL16_HA:
4829 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGH:
4830 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA:
4831 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER:
4832 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA:
4833 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST:
4834 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA:
4835 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER34:
4836 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34:
4837 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST34:
4838 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34:
4839 case R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA:
4840 break;
4841
4842 /* Not supported as a dynamic relocation. */
4843 case R_PPC64_ADDR64_LOCAL:
4844 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4845 {
4846 if (!ppc64_elf_howto_table[R_PPC64_ADDR32])
4847 ppc_howto_init ();
4848 /* xgettext:c-format */
4849 info->callbacks->einfo (_("%H: %s reloc unsupported "
4850 "in shared libraries and PIEs\n"),
4851 abfd, sec, rel->r_offset,
4852 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
4853 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4854 return FALSE;
4855 }
4856 break;
4857
4858 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
4859 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
4860 htab->do_multi_toc = 1;
4861 ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_small_toc_reloc = 1;
4862 /* Fall through. */
4863 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
4864 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
4865 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
4866 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
4867 sec->has_toc_reloc = 1;
4868 if (h != NULL && bfd_link_executable (info))
4869 {
4870 /* We may need a copy reloc. */
4871 h->non_got_ref = 1;
4872 /* Strongly prefer a copy reloc over a dynamic reloc.
4873 glibc ld.so as of 2019-08 will error out if one of
4874 these relocations is emitted. */
4875 h->needs_copy = 1;
4876 goto dodyn;
4877 }
4878 break;
4879
4880 /* Marker reloc. */
4881 case R_PPC64_ENTRY:
4882 break;
4883
4884 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
4885 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
4886 case R_PPC64_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4887 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
4888 return FALSE;
4889 break;
4890
4891 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
4892 used. Record for later use during GC. */
4893 case R_PPC64_GNU_VTENTRY:
4894 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
4895 return FALSE;
4896 break;
4897
4898 case R_PPC64_REL14:
4899 case R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN:
4900 case R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
4901 {
4902 asection *dest = NULL;
4903
4904 /* Heuristic: If jumping outside our section, chances are
4905 we are going to need a stub. */
4906 if (h != NULL)
4907 {
4908 /* If the sym is weak it may be overridden later, so
4909 don't assume we know where a weak sym lives. */
4910 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
4911 dest = h->root.u.def.section;
4912 }
4913 else
4914 {
4915 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
4916
4917 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
4918 abfd, r_symndx);
4919 if (isym == NULL)
4920 return FALSE;
4921
4922 dest = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
4923 }
4924
4925 if (dest != sec)
4926 ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->has_14bit_branch = 1;
4927 }
4928 goto rel24;
4929
4930 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL:
4931 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC:
4932 ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->has_pltcall = 1;
4933 /* Fall through. */
4934
4935 case R_PPC64_REL24:
4936 case R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC:
4937 rel24:
4938 plt_list = ifunc;
4939 if (h != NULL)
4940 {
4941 h->needs_plt = 1;
4942 if (h->root.root.string[0] == '.'
4943 && h->root.root.string[1] != '\0')
4944 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->is_func = 1;
4945
4946 if (h == tga || h == dottga)
4947 {
4948 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
4949 if (rel != relocs
4950 && (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC64_TLSGD
4951 || ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC64_TLSLD))
4952 /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with
4953 a marker reloc. */
4954 ;
4955 else
4956 /* Mark this section as having an old-style call. */
4957 sec->nomark_tls_get_addr = 1;
4958 }
4959 plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
4960 }
4961
4962 /* We may need a .plt entry if the function this reloc
4963 refers to is in a shared lib. */
4964 if (plt_list
4965 && !update_plt_info (abfd, plt_list, rel->r_addend))
4966 return FALSE;
4967 break;
4968
4969 case R_PPC64_ADDR14:
4970 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
4971 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
4972 case R_PPC64_ADDR24:
4973 goto dodyn;
4974
4975 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
4976 tls_type = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
4977 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
4978 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
4979 goto dotlstoc;
4980
4981 case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
4982 if (rel + 1 < rel_end
4983 && rel[1].r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_DTPREL64)
4984 && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset + 8)
4985 tls_type = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
4986 else
4987 tls_type = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
4988 goto dotlstoc;
4989
4990 case R_PPC64_DTPREL64:
4991 tls_type = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
4992 if (rel != relocs
4993 && rel[-1].r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_DTPMOD64)
4994 && rel[-1].r_offset == rel->r_offset - 8)
4995 /* This is the second reloc of a dtpmod, dtprel pair.
4996 Don't mark with TLS_DTPREL. */
4997 goto dodyn;
4998
4999 dotlstoc:
5000 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
5001 if (h != NULL)
5002 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= tls_type & 0xff;
5003 else
5004 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
5005 rel->r_addend, tls_type))
5006 return FALSE;
5007
5008 ppc64_sec = ppc64_elf_section_data (sec);
5009 if (ppc64_sec->sec_type != sec_toc)
5010 {
5011 bfd_size_type amt;
5012
5013 /* One extra to simplify get_tls_mask. */
5014 amt = sec->size * sizeof (unsigned) / 8 + sizeof (unsigned);
5015 ppc64_sec->u.toc.symndx = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5016 if (ppc64_sec->u.toc.symndx == NULL)
5017 return FALSE;
5018 amt = sec->size * sizeof (bfd_vma) / 8;
5019 ppc64_sec->u.toc.add = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5020 if (ppc64_sec->u.toc.add == NULL)
5021 return FALSE;
5022 BFD_ASSERT (ppc64_sec->sec_type == sec_normal);
5023 ppc64_sec->sec_type = sec_toc;
5024 }
5025 BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset % 8 == 0);
5026 ppc64_sec->u.toc.symndx[rel->r_offset / 8] = r_symndx;
5027 ppc64_sec->u.toc.add[rel->r_offset / 8] = rel->r_addend;
5028
5029 /* Mark the second slot of a GD or LD entry.
5030 -1 to indicate GD and -2 to indicate LD. */
5031 if (tls_type == (TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
5032 ppc64_sec->u.toc.symndx[rel->r_offset / 8 + 1] = -1;
5033 else if (tls_type == (TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5034 ppc64_sec->u.toc.symndx[rel->r_offset / 8 + 1] = -2;
5035 goto dodyn;
5036
5037 case R_PPC64_TPREL16:
5038 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
5039 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI:
5040 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
5041 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
5042 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
5043 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:
5044 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
5045 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:
5046 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
5047 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:
5048 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
5049 case R_PPC64_TPREL34:
5050 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
5051 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
5052 goto dodyn;
5053
5054 case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
5055 if (is_opd
5056 && rel + 1 < rel_end
5057 && ELF64_R_TYPE ((rel + 1)->r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC)
5058 {
5059 if (h != NULL)
5060 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->is_func = 1;
5061 }
5062 /* Fall through. */
5063
5064 case R_PPC64_ADDR16:
5065 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
5066 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA:
5067 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI:
5068 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH:
5069 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA:
5070 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER:
5071 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA:
5072 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST:
5073 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA:
5074 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO:
5075 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
5076 case R_PPC64_D34:
5077 case R_PPC64_D34_LO:
5078 case R_PPC64_D34_HI30:
5079 case R_PPC64_D34_HA30:
5080 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER34:
5081 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34:
5082 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST34:
5083 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34:
5084 case R_PPC64_D28:
5085 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info) && abiversion (abfd) != 1
5086 && rel->r_addend == 0)
5087 {
5088 /* We may need a .plt entry if this reloc refers to a
5089 function in a shared lib. */
5090 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, 0))
5091 return FALSE;
5092 h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
5093 }
5094 /* Fall through. */
5095
5096 case R_PPC64_REL30:
5097 case R_PPC64_REL32:
5098 case R_PPC64_REL64:
5099 case R_PPC64_ADDR32:
5100 case R_PPC64_UADDR16:
5101 case R_PPC64_UADDR32:
5102 case R_PPC64_UADDR64:
5103 case R_PPC64_TOC:
5104 if (h != NULL && bfd_link_executable (info))
5105 /* We may need a copy reloc. */
5106 h->non_got_ref = 1;
5107
5108 /* Don't propagate .opd relocs. */
5109 if (NO_OPD_RELOCS && is_opd)
5110 break;
5111
5112 /* If we are creating a shared library, and this is a reloc
5113 against a global symbol, or a non PC relative reloc
5114 against a local symbol, then we need to copy the reloc
5115 into the shared library. However, if we are linking with
5116 -Bsymbolic, we do not need to copy a reloc against a
5117 global symbol which is defined in an object we are
5118 including in the link (i.e., DEF_REGULAR is set). At
5119 this point we have not seen all the input files, so it is
5120 possible that DEF_REGULAR is not set now but will be set
5121 later (it is never cleared). In case of a weak definition,
5122 DEF_REGULAR may be cleared later by a strong definition in
5123 a shared library. We account for that possibility below by
5124 storing information in the dyn_relocs field of the hash
5125 table entry. A similar situation occurs when creating
5126 shared libraries and symbol visibility changes render the
5127 symbol local.
5128
5129 If on the other hand, we are creating an executable, we
5130 may need to keep relocations for symbols satisfied by a
5131 dynamic library if we manage to avoid copy relocs for the
5132 symbol. */
5133 dodyn:
5134 if ((h != NULL
5135 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
5136 || !h->def_regular))
5137 || (h != NULL
5138 && !bfd_link_executable (info)
5139 && !SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h))
5140 || (bfd_link_pic (info)
5141 && must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
5142 || (!bfd_link_pic (info)
5143 && ifunc != NULL))
5144 {
5145 /* We must copy these reloc types into the output file.
5146 Create a reloc section in dynobj and make room for
5147 this reloc. */
5148 if (sreloc == NULL)
5149 {
5150 sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
5151 (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 3, abfd, /*rela?*/ TRUE);
5152
5153 if (sreloc == NULL)
5154 return FALSE;
5155 }
5156
5157 /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
5158 relocations we need for this symbol. */
5159 if (h != NULL)
5160 {
5161 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
5162 struct elf_dyn_relocs **head;
5163
5164 head = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs;
5165 p = *head;
5166 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
5167 {
5168 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
5169 if (p == NULL)
5170 return FALSE;
5171 p->next = *head;
5172 *head = p;
5173 p->sec = sec;
5174 p->count = 0;
5175 p->pc_count = 0;
5176 }
5177 p->count += 1;
5178 if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
5179 p->pc_count += 1;
5180 }
5181 else
5182 {
5183 /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
5184 We really need local syms available to do this
5185 easily. Oh well. */
5186 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
5187 struct ppc_dyn_relocs **head;
5188 bfd_boolean is_ifunc;
5189 asection *s;
5190 void *vpp;
5191 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
5192
5193 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
5194 abfd, r_symndx);
5195 if (isym == NULL)
5196 return FALSE;
5197
5198 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
5199 if (s == NULL)
5200 s = sec;
5201
5202 vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
5203 head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
5204 is_ifunc = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC;
5205 p = *head;
5206 if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
5207 p = p->next;
5208 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
5209 {
5210 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
5211 if (p == NULL)
5212 return FALSE;
5213 p->next = *head;
5214 *head = p;
5215 p->sec = sec;
5216 p->ifunc = is_ifunc;
5217 p->count = 0;
5218 }
5219 p->count += 1;
5220 }
5221 }
5222 break;
5223
5224 default:
5225 break;
5226 }
5227 }
5228
5229 return TRUE;
5230 }
5231
5232 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
5233 object file when linking. */
5234
5235 static bfd_boolean
5236 ppc64_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
5237 {
5238 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
5239 unsigned long iflags, oflags;
5240
5241 if ((ibfd->flags & BFD_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
5242 return TRUE;
5243
5244 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc64_elf (obfd))
5245 return TRUE;
5246
5247 if (!_bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
5248 return FALSE;
5249
5250 iflags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
5251 oflags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
5252
5253 if (iflags & ~EF_PPC64_ABI)
5254 {
5255 _bfd_error_handler
5256 /* xgettext:c-format */
5257 (_("%pB uses unknown e_flags 0x%lx"), ibfd, iflags);
5258 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5259 return FALSE;
5260 }
5261 else if (iflags != oflags && iflags != 0)
5262 {
5263 _bfd_error_handler
5264 /* xgettext:c-format */
5265 (_("%pB: ABI version %ld is not compatible with ABI version %ld output"),
5266 ibfd, iflags, oflags);
5267 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5268 return FALSE;
5269 }
5270
5271 if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info))
5272 return FALSE;
5273
5274 /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
5275 return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
5276 }
5277
5278 static bfd_boolean
5279 ppc64_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *ptr)
5280 {
5281 /* Print normal ELF private data. */
5282 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (abfd, ptr);
5283
5284 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags != 0)
5285 {
5286 FILE *file = ptr;
5287
5288 fprintf (file, _("private flags = 0x%lx:"),
5289 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags);
5290
5291 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC64_ABI) != 0)
5292 fprintf (file, _(" [abiv%ld]"),
5293 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC64_ABI);
5294 fputc ('\n', file);
5295 }
5296
5297 return TRUE;
5298 }
5299
5300 /* OFFSET in OPD_SEC specifies a function descriptor. Return the address
5301 of the code entry point, and its section, which must be in the same
5302 object as OPD_SEC. Returns (bfd_vma) -1 on error. */
5303
5304 static bfd_vma
5305 opd_entry_value (asection *opd_sec,
5306 bfd_vma offset,
5307 asection **code_sec,
5308 bfd_vma *code_off,
5309 bfd_boolean in_code_sec)
5310 {
5311 bfd *opd_bfd = opd_sec->owner;
5312 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs;
5313 Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi, *look;
5314 bfd_vma val;
5315
5316 /* No relocs implies we are linking a --just-symbols object, or looking
5317 at a final linked executable with addr2line or somesuch. */
5318 if (opd_sec->reloc_count == 0)
5319 {
5320 bfd_byte *contents = ppc64_elf_tdata (opd_bfd)->opd.contents;
5321
5322 if (contents == NULL)
5323 {
5324 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (opd_bfd, opd_sec, &contents))
5325 return (bfd_vma) -1;
5326 ppc64_elf_tdata (opd_bfd)->opd.contents = contents;
5327 }
5328
5329 /* PR 17512: file: 64b9dfbb. */
5330 if (offset + 7 >= opd_sec->size || offset + 7 < offset)
5331 return (bfd_vma) -1;
5332
5333 val = bfd_get_64 (opd_bfd, contents + offset);
5334 if (code_sec != NULL)
5335 {
5336 asection *sec, *likely = NULL;
5337
5338 if (in_code_sec)
5339 {
5340 sec = *code_sec;
5341 if (sec->vma <= val
5342 && val < sec->vma + sec->size)
5343 likely = sec;
5344 else
5345 val = -1;
5346 }
5347 else
5348 for (sec = opd_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
5349 if (sec->vma <= val
5350 && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
5351 && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
5352 likely = sec;
5353 if (likely != NULL)
5354 {
5355 *code_sec = likely;
5356 if (code_off != NULL)
5357 *code_off = val - likely->vma;
5358 }
5359 }
5360 return val;
5361 }
5362
5363 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc64_elf (opd_bfd));
5364
5365 relocs = ppc64_elf_tdata (opd_bfd)->opd.relocs;
5366 if (relocs == NULL)
5367 relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (opd_bfd, opd_sec, NULL, NULL, TRUE);
5368 /* PR 17512: file: df8e1fd6. */
5369 if (relocs == NULL)
5370 return (bfd_vma) -1;
5371
5372 /* Go find the opd reloc at the sym address. */
5373 lo = relocs;
5374 hi = lo + opd_sec->reloc_count - 1; /* ignore last reloc */
5375 val = (bfd_vma) -1;
5376 while (lo < hi)
5377 {
5378 look = lo + (hi - lo) / 2;
5379 if (look->r_offset < offset)
5380 lo = look + 1;
5381 else if (look->r_offset > offset)
5382 hi = look;
5383 else
5384 {
5385 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (opd_bfd);
5386
5387 if (ELF64_R_TYPE (look->r_info) == R_PPC64_ADDR64
5388 && ELF64_R_TYPE ((look + 1)->r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC)
5389 {
5390 unsigned long symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (look->r_info);
5391 asection *sec = NULL;
5392
5393 if (symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info
5394 && elf_sym_hashes (opd_bfd) != NULL)
5395 {
5396 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
5397 struct elf_link_hash_entry *rh;
5398
5399 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (opd_bfd);
5400 rh = sym_hashes[symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
5401 if (rh != NULL)
5402 {
5403 rh = elf_follow_link (rh);
5404 if (rh->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
5405 && rh->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5406 break;
5407 if (rh->root.u.def.section->owner == opd_bfd)
5408 {
5409 val = rh->root.u.def.value;
5410 sec = rh->root.u.def.section;
5411 }
5412 }
5413 }
5414
5415 if (sec == NULL)
5416 {
5417 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
5418
5419 if (symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
5420 {
5421 sym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
5422 if (sym == NULL)
5423 {
5424 size_t symcnt = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5425 sym = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (opd_bfd, symtab_hdr,
5426 symcnt, 0,
5427 NULL, NULL, NULL);
5428 if (sym == NULL)
5429 break;
5430 symtab_hdr->contents = (bfd_byte *) sym;
5431 }
5432 sym += symndx;
5433 }
5434 else
5435 {
5436 sym = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (opd_bfd, symtab_hdr,
5437 1, symndx,
5438 NULL, NULL, NULL);
5439 if (sym == NULL)
5440 break;
5441 }
5442 sec = bfd_section_from_elf_index (opd_bfd, sym->st_shndx);
5443 if (sec == NULL)
5444 break;
5445 BFD_ASSERT ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE) == 0);
5446 val = sym->st_value;
5447 }
5448
5449 val += look->r_addend;
5450 if (code_off != NULL)
5451 *code_off = val;
5452 if (code_sec != NULL)
5453 {
5454 if (in_code_sec && *code_sec != sec)
5455 return -1;
5456 else
5457 *code_sec = sec;
5458 }
5459 if (sec->output_section != NULL)
5460 val += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
5461 }
5462 break;
5463 }
5464 }
5465
5466 return val;
5467 }
5468
5469 /* If the ELF symbol SYM might be a function in SEC, return the
5470 function size and set *CODE_OFF to the function's entry point,
5471 otherwise return zero. */
5472
5473 static bfd_size_type
5474 ppc64_elf_maybe_function_sym (const asymbol *sym, asection *sec,
5475 bfd_vma *code_off)
5476 {
5477 bfd_size_type size;
5478
5479 if ((sym->flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT
5480 | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) != 0)
5481 return 0;
5482
5483 size = 0;
5484 if (!(sym->flags & BSF_SYNTHETIC))
5485 size = ((elf_symbol_type *) sym)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
5486
5487 if (strcmp (sym->section->name, ".opd") == 0)
5488 {
5489 struct _opd_sec_data *opd = get_opd_info (sym->section);
5490 bfd_vma symval = sym->value;
5491
5492 if (opd != NULL
5493 && opd->adjust != NULL
5494 && elf_section_data (sym->section)->relocs != NULL)
5495 {
5496 /* opd_entry_value will use cached relocs that have been
5497 adjusted, but with raw symbols. That means both local
5498 and global symbols need adjusting. */
5499 long adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (symval)];
5500 if (adjust == -1)
5501 return 0;
5502 symval += adjust;
5503 }
5504
5505 if (opd_entry_value (sym->section, symval,
5506 &sec, code_off, TRUE) == (bfd_vma) -1)
5507 return 0;
5508 /* An old ABI binary with dot-syms has a size of 24 on the .opd
5509 symbol. This size has nothing to do with the code size of the
5510 function, which is what we're supposed to return, but the
5511 code size isn't available without looking up the dot-sym.
5512 However, doing that would be a waste of time particularly
5513 since elf_find_function will look at the dot-sym anyway.
5514 Now, elf_find_function will keep the largest size of any
5515 function sym found at the code address of interest, so return
5516 1 here to avoid it incorrectly caching a larger function size
5517 for a small function. This does mean we return the wrong
5518 size for a new-ABI function of size 24, but all that does is
5519 disable caching for such functions. */
5520 if (size == 24)
5521 size = 1;
5522 }
5523 else
5524 {
5525 if (sym->section != sec)
5526 return 0;
5527 *code_off = sym->value;
5528 }
5529 if (size == 0)
5530 size = 1;
5531 return size;
5532 }
5533
5534 /* Return true if symbol is a strong function defined in an ELFv2
5535 object with st_other localentry bits of zero, ie. its local entry
5536 point coincides with its global entry point. */
5537
5538 static bfd_boolean
5539 is_elfv2_localentry0 (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5540 {
5541 return (h != NULL
5542 && h->type == STT_FUNC
5543 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5544 && (STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK & h->other) == 0
5545 && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->non_zero_localentry
5546 && is_ppc64_elf (h->root.u.def.section->owner)
5547 && abiversion (h->root.u.def.section->owner) >= 2);
5548 }
5549
5550 /* Return true if symbol is defined in a regular object file. */
5551
5552 static bfd_boolean
5553 is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5554 {
5555 return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5556 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5557 && h->root.u.def.section != NULL
5558 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL);
5559 }
5560
5561 /* If FDH is a function descriptor symbol, return the associated code
5562 entry symbol if it is defined. Return NULL otherwise. */
5563
5564 static struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
5565 defined_code_entry (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh)
5566 {
5567 if (fdh->is_func_descriptor)
5568 {
5569 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh = ppc_follow_link (fdh->oh);
5570 if (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5571 || fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5572 return fh;
5573 }
5574 return NULL;
5575 }
5576
5577 /* If FH is a function code entry symbol, return the associated
5578 function descriptor symbol if it is defined. Return NULL otherwise. */
5579
5580 static struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
5581 defined_func_desc (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh)
5582 {
5583 if (fh->oh != NULL
5584 && fh->oh->is_func_descriptor)
5585 {
5586 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh = ppc_follow_link (fh->oh);
5587 if (fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5588 || fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5589 return fdh;
5590 }
5591 return NULL;
5592 }
5593
5594 /* Given H is a symbol that satisfies is_static_defined, return the
5595 value in the output file. */
5596
5597 static bfd_vma
5598 defined_sym_val (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5599 {
5600 return (h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
5601 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
5602 + h->root.u.def.value);
5603 }
5604
5605 /* Return true if H matches __tls_get_addr or one of its variants. */
5606
5607 static bfd_boolean
5608 is_tls_get_addr (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
5609 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab)
5610 {
5611 return (h == &htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf || h == &htab->tga_desc_fd->elf
5612 || h == &htab->tls_get_addr->elf || h == &htab->tga_desc->elf);
5613 }
5614
5615 static bfd_boolean func_desc_adjust (struct elf_link_hash_entry *, void *);
5616
5617 /* Garbage collect sections, after first dealing with dot-symbols. */
5618
5619 static bfd_boolean
5620 ppc64_elf_gc_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
5621 {
5622 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
5623
5624 if (htab != NULL && htab->need_func_desc_adj)
5625 {
5626 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, func_desc_adjust, info);
5627 htab->need_func_desc_adj = 0;
5628 }
5629 return bfd_elf_gc_sections (abfd, info);
5630 }
5631
5632 /* Mark all our entry sym sections, both opd and code section. */
5633
5634 static void
5635 ppc64_elf_gc_keep (struct bfd_link_info *info)
5636 {
5637 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
5638 struct bfd_sym_chain *sym;
5639
5640 if (htab == NULL)
5641 return;
5642
5643 for (sym = info->gc_sym_list; sym != NULL; sym = sym->next)
5644 {
5645 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh, *fh;
5646 asection *sec;
5647
5648 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, sym->name,
5649 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE));
5650 if (eh == NULL)
5651 continue;
5652 if (eh->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
5653 && eh->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5654 continue;
5655
5656 fh = defined_code_entry (eh);
5657 if (fh != NULL)
5658 {
5659 sec = fh->elf.root.u.def.section;
5660 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5661 }
5662 else if (get_opd_info (eh->elf.root.u.def.section) != NULL
5663 && opd_entry_value (eh->elf.root.u.def.section,
5664 eh->elf.root.u.def.value,
5665 &sec, NULL, FALSE) != (bfd_vma) -1)
5666 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5667
5668 sec = eh->elf.root.u.def.section;
5669 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5670 }
5671 }
5672
5673 /* Mark sections containing dynamically referenced symbols. When
5674 building shared libraries, we must assume that any visible symbol is
5675 referenced. */
5676
5677 static bfd_boolean
5678 ppc64_elf_gc_mark_dynamic_ref (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
5679 {
5680 struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
5681 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
5682 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
5683 struct bfd_elf_dynamic_list *d = info->dynamic_list;
5684
5685 /* Dynamic linking info is on the func descriptor sym. */
5686 fdh = defined_func_desc (eh);
5687 if (fdh != NULL)
5688 eh = fdh;
5689
5690 if ((eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5691 || eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5692 && ((eh->elf.ref_dynamic && !eh->elf.forced_local)
5693 || ((eh->elf.def_regular || ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (&eh->elf))
5694 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (eh->elf.other) != STV_INTERNAL
5695 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (eh->elf.other) != STV_HIDDEN
5696 && (!bfd_link_executable (info)
5697 || info->gc_keep_exported
5698 || info->export_dynamic
5699 || (eh->elf.dynamic
5700 && d != NULL
5701 && (*d->match) (&d->head, NULL,
5702 eh->elf.root.root.string)))
5703 && (eh->elf.versioned >= versioned
5704 || !bfd_hide_sym_by_version (info->version_info,
5705 eh->elf.root.root.string)))))
5706 {
5707 asection *code_sec;
5708 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh;
5709
5710 eh->elf.root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5711
5712 /* Function descriptor syms cause the associated
5713 function code sym section to be marked. */
5714 fh = defined_code_entry (eh);
5715 if (fh != NULL)
5716 {
5717 code_sec = fh->elf.root.u.def.section;
5718 code_sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5719 }
5720 else if (get_opd_info (eh->elf.root.u.def.section) != NULL
5721 && opd_entry_value (eh->elf.root.u.def.section,
5722 eh->elf.root.u.def.value,
5723 &code_sec, NULL, FALSE) != (bfd_vma) -1)
5724 code_sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5725 }
5726
5727 return TRUE;
5728 }
5729
5730 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
5731 relocation. */
5732
5733 static asection *
5734 ppc64_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
5735 struct bfd_link_info *info,
5736 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
5737 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
5738 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
5739 {
5740 asection *rsec;
5741
5742 /* Syms return NULL if we're marking .opd, so we avoid marking all
5743 function sections, as all functions are referenced in .opd. */
5744 rsec = NULL;
5745 if (get_opd_info (sec) != NULL)
5746 return rsec;
5747
5748 if (h != NULL)
5749 {
5750 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
5751 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh, *fh, *fdh;
5752
5753 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
5754 switch (r_type)
5755 {
5756 case R_PPC64_GNU_VTINHERIT:
5757 case R_PPC64_GNU_VTENTRY:
5758 break;
5759
5760 default:
5761 switch (h->root.type)
5762 {
5763 case bfd_link_hash_defined:
5764 case bfd_link_hash_defweak:
5765 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
5766 fdh = defined_func_desc (eh);
5767 if (fdh != NULL)
5768 {
5769 /* -mcall-aixdesc code references the dot-symbol on
5770 a call reloc. Mark the function descriptor too
5771 against garbage collection. */
5772 fdh->elf.mark = 1;
5773 if (fdh->elf.is_weakalias)
5774 weakdef (&fdh->elf)->mark = 1;
5775 eh = fdh;
5776 }
5777
5778 /* Function descriptor syms cause the associated
5779 function code sym section to be marked. */
5780 fh = defined_code_entry (eh);
5781 if (fh != NULL)
5782 {
5783 /* They also mark their opd section. */
5784 eh->elf.root.u.def.section->gc_mark = 1;
5785
5786 rsec = fh->elf.root.u.def.section;
5787 }
5788 else if (get_opd_info (eh->elf.root.u.def.section) != NULL
5789 && opd_entry_value (eh->elf.root.u.def.section,
5790 eh->elf.root.u.def.value,
5791 &rsec, NULL, FALSE) != (bfd_vma) -1)
5792 eh->elf.root.u.def.section->gc_mark = 1;
5793 else
5794 rsec = h->root.u.def.section;
5795 break;
5796
5797 case bfd_link_hash_common:
5798 rsec = h->root.u.c.p->section;
5799 break;
5800
5801 default:
5802 return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
5803 }
5804 }
5805 }
5806 else
5807 {
5808 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
5809
5810 rsec = bfd_section_from_elf_index (sec->owner, sym->st_shndx);
5811 opd = get_opd_info (rsec);
5812 if (opd != NULL && opd->func_sec != NULL)
5813 {
5814 rsec->gc_mark = 1;
5815
5816 rsec = opd->func_sec[OPD_NDX (sym->st_value + rel->r_addend)];
5817 }
5818 }
5819
5820 return rsec;
5821 }
5822
5823 /* The maximum size of .sfpr. */
5824 #define SFPR_MAX (218*4)
5825
5826 struct sfpr_def_parms
5827 {
5828 const char name[12];
5829 unsigned char lo, hi;
5830 bfd_byte *(*write_ent) (bfd *, bfd_byte *, int);
5831 bfd_byte *(*write_tail) (bfd *, bfd_byte *, int);
5832 };
5833
5834 /* Auto-generate _save*, _rest* functions in .sfpr.
5835 If STUB_SEC is non-null, define alias symbols in STUB_SEC
5836 instead. */
5837
5838 static bfd_boolean
5839 sfpr_define (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5840 const struct sfpr_def_parms *parm,
5841 asection *stub_sec)
5842 {
5843 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
5844 unsigned int i;
5845 size_t len = strlen (parm->name);
5846 bfd_boolean writing = FALSE;
5847 char sym[16];
5848
5849 if (htab == NULL)
5850 return FALSE;
5851
5852 memcpy (sym, parm->name, len);
5853 sym[len + 2] = 0;
5854
5855 for (i = parm->lo; i <= parm->hi; i++)
5856 {
5857 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h;
5858
5859 sym[len + 0] = i / 10 + '0';
5860 sym[len + 1] = i % 10 + '0';
5861 h = ppc_elf_hash_entry (elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, sym,
5862 writing, TRUE, TRUE));
5863 if (stub_sec != NULL)
5864 {
5865 if (h != NULL
5866 && h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5867 && h->elf.root.u.def.section == htab->sfpr)
5868 {
5869 struct elf_link_hash_entry *s;
5870 char buf[32];
5871 sprintf (buf, "%08x.%s", stub_sec->id & 0xffffffff, sym);
5872 s = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, buf, TRUE, TRUE, FALSE);
5873 if (s == NULL)
5874 return FALSE;
5875 if (s->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5876 {
5877 s->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5878 s->root.u.def.section = stub_sec;
5879 s->root.u.def.value = (stub_sec->size - htab->sfpr->size
5880 + h->elf.root.u.def.value);
5881 s->ref_regular = 1;
5882 s->def_regular = 1;
5883 s->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5884 s->forced_local = 1;
5885 s->non_elf = 0;
5886 s->root.linker_def = 1;
5887 }
5888 }
5889 continue;
5890 }
5891 if (h != NULL)
5892 {
5893 h->save_res = 1;
5894 if (!h->elf.def_regular)
5895 {
5896 h->elf.root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5897 h->elf.root.u.def.section = htab->sfpr;
5898 h->elf.root.u.def.value = htab->sfpr->size;
5899 h->elf.type = STT_FUNC;
5900 h->elf.def_regular = 1;
5901 h->elf.non_elf = 0;
5902 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &h->elf, TRUE);
5903 writing = TRUE;
5904 if (htab->sfpr->contents == NULL)
5905 {
5906 htab->sfpr->contents
5907 = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, SFPR_MAX);
5908 if (htab->sfpr->contents == NULL)
5909 return FALSE;
5910 }
5911 }
5912 }
5913 if (writing)
5914 {
5915 bfd_byte *p = htab->sfpr->contents + htab->sfpr->size;
5916 if (i != parm->hi)
5917 p = (*parm->write_ent) (htab->elf.dynobj, p, i);
5918 else
5919 p = (*parm->write_tail) (htab->elf.dynobj, p, i);
5920 htab->sfpr->size = p - htab->sfpr->contents;
5921 }
5922 }
5923
5924 return TRUE;
5925 }
5926
5927 static bfd_byte *
5928 savegpr0 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5929 {
5930 bfd_put_32 (abfd, STD_R0_0R1 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
5931 return p + 4;
5932 }
5933
5934 static bfd_byte *
5935 savegpr0_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5936 {
5937 p = savegpr0 (abfd, p, r);
5938 bfd_put_32 (abfd, STD_R0_0R1 + STK_LR, p);
5939 p = p + 4;
5940 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
5941 return p + 4;
5942 }
5943
5944 static bfd_byte *
5945 restgpr0 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5946 {
5947 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R0_0R1 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
5948 return p + 4;
5949 }
5950
5951 static bfd_byte *
5952 restgpr0_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5953 {
5954 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R0_0R1 + STK_LR, p);
5955 p = p + 4;
5956 p = restgpr0 (abfd, p, r);
5957 bfd_put_32 (abfd, MTLR_R0, p);
5958 p = p + 4;
5959 if (r == 29)
5960 {
5961 p = restgpr0 (abfd, p, 30);
5962 p = restgpr0 (abfd, p, 31);
5963 }
5964 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
5965 return p + 4;
5966 }
5967
5968 static bfd_byte *
5969 savegpr1 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5970 {
5971 bfd_put_32 (abfd, STD_R0_0R12 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
5972 return p + 4;
5973 }
5974
5975 static bfd_byte *
5976 savegpr1_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5977 {
5978 p = savegpr1 (abfd, p, r);
5979 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
5980 return p + 4;
5981 }
5982
5983 static bfd_byte *
5984 restgpr1 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5985 {
5986 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R0_0R12 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
5987 return p + 4;
5988 }
5989
5990 static bfd_byte *
5991 restgpr1_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5992 {
5993 p = restgpr1 (abfd, p, r);
5994 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
5995 return p + 4;
5996 }
5997
5998 static bfd_byte *
5999 savefpr (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6000 {
6001 bfd_put_32 (abfd, STFD_FR0_0R1 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
6002 return p + 4;
6003 }
6004
6005 static bfd_byte *
6006 savefpr0_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6007 {
6008 p = savefpr (abfd, p, r);
6009 bfd_put_32 (abfd, STD_R0_0R1 + STK_LR, p);
6010 p = p + 4;
6011 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6012 return p + 4;
6013 }
6014
6015 static bfd_byte *
6016 restfpr (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6017 {
6018 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LFD_FR0_0R1 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
6019 return p + 4;
6020 }
6021
6022 static bfd_byte *
6023 restfpr0_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6024 {
6025 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R0_0R1 + STK_LR, p);
6026 p = p + 4;
6027 p = restfpr (abfd, p, r);
6028 bfd_put_32 (abfd, MTLR_R0, p);
6029 p = p + 4;
6030 if (r == 29)
6031 {
6032 p = restfpr (abfd, p, 30);
6033 p = restfpr (abfd, p, 31);
6034 }
6035 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6036 return p + 4;
6037 }
6038
6039 static bfd_byte *
6040 savefpr1_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6041 {
6042 p = savefpr (abfd, p, r);
6043 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6044 return p + 4;
6045 }
6046
6047 static bfd_byte *
6048 restfpr1_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6049 {
6050 p = restfpr (abfd, p, r);
6051 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6052 return p + 4;
6053 }
6054
6055 static bfd_byte *
6056 savevr (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6057 {
6058 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LI_R12_0 + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 16, p);
6059 p = p + 4;
6060 bfd_put_32 (abfd, STVX_VR0_R12_R0 + (r << 21), p);
6061 return p + 4;
6062 }
6063
6064 static bfd_byte *
6065 savevr_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6066 {
6067 p = savevr (abfd, p, r);
6068 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6069 return p + 4;
6070 }
6071
6072 static bfd_byte *
6073 restvr (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6074 {
6075 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LI_R12_0 + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 16, p);
6076 p = p + 4;
6077 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LVX_VR0_R12_R0 + (r << 21), p);
6078 return p + 4;
6079 }
6080
6081 static bfd_byte *
6082 restvr_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6083 {
6084 p = restvr (abfd, p, r);
6085 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6086 return p + 4;
6087 }
6088
6089 #define STDU_R1_0R1 0xf8210001
6090 #define ADDI_R1_R1 0x38210000
6091
6092 /* Emit prologue of wrapper preserving regs around a call to
6093 __tls_get_addr_opt. */
6094
6095 static bfd_byte *
6096 tls_get_addr_prologue (bfd *obfd, bfd_byte *p, struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab)
6097 {
6098 unsigned int i;
6099
6100 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MFLR_R0, p);
6101 p += 4;
6102 bfd_put_32 (obfd, STD_R0_0R1 + 16, p);
6103 p += 4;
6104
6105 if (htab->opd_abi)
6106 {
6107 for (i = 4; i < 12; i++)
6108 {
6109 bfd_put_32 (obfd,
6110 STD_R0_0R1 | i << 21 | (-(13 - i) * 8 & 0xffff), p);
6111 p += 4;
6112 }
6113 bfd_put_32 (obfd, STDU_R1_0R1 | (-128 & 0xffff), p);
6114 p += 4;
6115 }
6116 else
6117 {
6118 for (i = 4; i < 12; i++)
6119 {
6120 bfd_put_32 (obfd,
6121 STD_R0_0R1 | i << 21 | (-(12 - i) * 8 & 0xffff), p);
6122 p += 4;
6123 }
6124 bfd_put_32 (obfd, STDU_R1_0R1 | (-96 & 0xffff), p);
6125 p += 4;
6126 }
6127 return p;
6128 }
6129
6130 /* Emit epilogue of wrapper preserving regs around a call to
6131 __tls_get_addr_opt. */
6132
6133 static bfd_byte *
6134 tls_get_addr_epilogue (bfd *obfd, bfd_byte *p, struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab)
6135 {
6136 unsigned int i;
6137
6138 if (htab->opd_abi)
6139 {
6140 for (i = 4; i < 12; i++)
6141 {
6142 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R0_0R1 | i << 21 | (128 - (13 - i) * 8), p);
6143 p += 4;
6144 }
6145 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDI_R1_R1 | 128, p);
6146 p += 4;
6147 }
6148 else
6149 {
6150 for (i = 4; i < 12; i++)
6151 {
6152 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R0_0R1 | i << 21 | (96 - (12 - i) * 8), p);
6153 p += 4;
6154 }
6155 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDI_R1_R1 | 96, p);
6156 p += 4;
6157 }
6158 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R0_0R1 | 16, p);
6159 p += 4;
6160 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MTLR_R0, p);
6161 p += 4;
6162 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BLR, p);
6163 p += 4;
6164 return p;
6165 }
6166
6167 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse to transfer dynamic linking
6168 information on function code symbol entries to their corresponding
6169 function descriptor symbol entries. */
6170
6171 static bfd_boolean
6172 func_desc_adjust (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
6173 {
6174 struct bfd_link_info *info;
6175 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
6176 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh;
6177 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
6178 bfd_boolean force_local;
6179
6180 fh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
6181 if (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
6182 return TRUE;
6183
6184 if (!fh->is_func)
6185 return TRUE;
6186
6187 if (fh->elf.root.root.string[0] != '.'
6188 || fh->elf.root.root.string[1] == '\0')
6189 return TRUE;
6190
6191 info = inf;
6192 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
6193 if (htab == NULL)
6194 return FALSE;
6195
6196 /* Find the corresponding function descriptor symbol. */
6197 fdh = lookup_fdh (fh, htab);
6198
6199 /* Resolve undefined references to dot-symbols as the value
6200 in the function descriptor, if we have one in a regular object.
6201 This is to satisfy cases like ".quad .foo". Calls to functions
6202 in dynamic objects are handled elsewhere. */
6203 if ((fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6204 || fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6205 && (fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6206 || fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6207 && get_opd_info (fdh->elf.root.u.def.section) != NULL
6208 && opd_entry_value (fdh->elf.root.u.def.section,
6209 fdh->elf.root.u.def.value,
6210 &fh->elf.root.u.def.section,
6211 &fh->elf.root.u.def.value, FALSE) != (bfd_vma) -1)
6212 {
6213 fh->elf.root.type = fdh->elf.root.type;
6214 fh->elf.forced_local = 1;
6215 fh->elf.def_regular = fdh->elf.def_regular;
6216 fh->elf.def_dynamic = fdh->elf.def_dynamic;
6217 }
6218
6219 if (!fh->elf.dynamic)
6220 {
6221 struct plt_entry *ent;
6222
6223 for (ent = fh->elf.plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
6224 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
6225 break;
6226 if (ent == NULL)
6227 return TRUE;
6228 }
6229
6230 /* Create a descriptor as undefined if necessary. */
6231 if (fdh == NULL
6232 && !bfd_link_executable (info)
6233 && (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6234 || fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
6235 {
6236 fdh = make_fdh (info, fh);
6237 if (fdh == NULL)
6238 return FALSE;
6239 }
6240
6241 /* We can't support overriding of symbols on a fake descriptor. */
6242 if (fdh != NULL
6243 && fdh->fake
6244 && (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6245 || fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
6246 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &fdh->elf, TRUE);
6247
6248 /* Transfer dynamic linking information to the function descriptor. */
6249 if (fdh != NULL)
6250 {
6251 fdh->elf.ref_regular |= fh->elf.ref_regular;
6252 fdh->elf.ref_dynamic |= fh->elf.ref_dynamic;
6253 fdh->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= fh->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
6254 fdh->elf.non_got_ref |= fh->elf.non_got_ref;
6255 fdh->elf.dynamic |= fh->elf.dynamic;
6256 fdh->elf.needs_plt |= (fh->elf.needs_plt
6257 || fh->elf.type == STT_FUNC
6258 || fh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
6259 move_plt_plist (fh, fdh);
6260
6261 if (!fdh->elf.forced_local
6262 && fh->elf.dynindx != -1)
6263 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, &fdh->elf))
6264 return FALSE;
6265 }
6266
6267 /* Now that the info is on the function descriptor, clear the
6268 function code sym info. Any function code syms for which we
6269 don't have a definition in a regular file, we force local.
6270 This prevents a shared library from exporting syms that have
6271 been imported from another library. Function code syms that
6272 are really in the library we must leave global to prevent the
6273 linker dragging in a definition from a static library. */
6274 force_local = (!fh->elf.def_regular
6275 || fdh == NULL
6276 || !fdh->elf.def_regular
6277 || fdh->elf.forced_local);
6278 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &fh->elf, force_local);
6279
6280 return TRUE;
6281 }
6282
6283 static const struct sfpr_def_parms save_res_funcs[] =
6284 {
6285 { "_savegpr0_", 14, 31, savegpr0, savegpr0_tail },
6286 { "_restgpr0_", 14, 29, restgpr0, restgpr0_tail },
6287 { "_restgpr0_", 30, 31, restgpr0, restgpr0_tail },
6288 { "_savegpr1_", 14, 31, savegpr1, savegpr1_tail },
6289 { "_restgpr1_", 14, 31, restgpr1, restgpr1_tail },
6290 { "_savefpr_", 14, 31, savefpr, savefpr0_tail },
6291 { "_restfpr_", 14, 29, restfpr, restfpr0_tail },
6292 { "_restfpr_", 30, 31, restfpr, restfpr0_tail },
6293 { "._savef", 14, 31, savefpr, savefpr1_tail },
6294 { "._restf", 14, 31, restfpr, restfpr1_tail },
6295 { "_savevr_", 20, 31, savevr, savevr_tail },
6296 { "_restvr_", 20, 31, restvr, restvr_tail }
6297 };
6298
6299 /* Called near the start of bfd_elf_size_dynamic_sections. We use
6300 this hook to a) provide some gcc support functions, and b) transfer
6301 dynamic linking information gathered so far on function code symbol
6302 entries, to their corresponding function descriptor symbol entries. */
6303
6304 static bfd_boolean
6305 ppc64_elf_func_desc_adjust (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6306 struct bfd_link_info *info)
6307 {
6308 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
6309
6310 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
6311 if (htab == NULL)
6312 return FALSE;
6313
6314 /* Provide any missing _save* and _rest* functions. */
6315 if (htab->sfpr != NULL)
6316 {
6317 unsigned int i;
6318
6319 htab->sfpr->size = 0;
6320 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (save_res_funcs); i++)
6321 if (!sfpr_define (info, &save_res_funcs[i], NULL))
6322 return FALSE;
6323 if (htab->sfpr->size == 0)
6324 htab->sfpr->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6325 }
6326
6327 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
6328 return TRUE;
6329
6330 if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
6331 {
6332 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, htab->elf.hgot, TRUE);
6333 /* Make .TOC. defined so as to prevent it being made dynamic.
6334 The wrong value here is fixed later in ppc64_elf_set_toc. */
6335 if (!htab->elf.hgot->def_regular
6336 || htab->elf.hgot->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined)
6337 {
6338 htab->elf.hgot->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
6339 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = 0;
6340 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6341 htab->elf.hgot->def_regular = 1;
6342 htab->elf.hgot->root.linker_def = 1;
6343 }
6344 htab->elf.hgot->type = STT_OBJECT;
6345 htab->elf.hgot->other
6346 = (htab->elf.hgot->other & ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1)) | STV_HIDDEN;
6347 }
6348
6349 if (htab->need_func_desc_adj)
6350 {
6351 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, func_desc_adjust, info);
6352 htab->need_func_desc_adj = 0;
6353 }
6354
6355 return TRUE;
6356 }
6357
6358 /* Find dynamic relocs for H that apply to read-only sections. */
6359
6360 static asection *
6361 readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6362 {
6363 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
6364 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
6365
6366 for (p = eh->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
6367 {
6368 asection *s = p->sec->output_section;
6369
6370 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
6371 return p->sec;
6372 }
6373 return NULL;
6374 }
6375
6376 /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak
6377 aliases, that apply to read-only sections. Cannot be used after
6378 size_dynamic_sections. */
6379
6380 static bfd_boolean
6381 alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6382 {
6383 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
6384 do
6385 {
6386 if (readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf))
6387 return TRUE;
6388 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (eh->elf.u.alias);
6389 }
6390 while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h);
6391
6392 return FALSE;
6393 }
6394
6395 /* Return whether EH has pc-relative dynamic relocs. */
6396
6397 static bfd_boolean
6398 pc_dynrelocs (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh)
6399 {
6400 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
6401
6402 for (p = eh->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
6403 if (p->pc_count != 0)
6404 return TRUE;
6405 return FALSE;
6406 }
6407
6408 /* Return true if a global entry stub will be created for H. Valid
6409 for ELFv2 before plt entries have been allocated. */
6410
6411 static bfd_boolean
6412 global_entry_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6413 {
6414 struct plt_entry *pent;
6415
6416 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed
6417 || h->def_regular)
6418 return FALSE;
6419
6420 for (pent = h->plt.plist; pent != NULL; pent = pent->next)
6421 if (pent->plt.refcount > 0
6422 && pent->addend == 0)
6423 return TRUE;
6424
6425 return FALSE;
6426 }
6427
6428 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
6429 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
6430 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
6431 change the definition to something the rest of the link can
6432 understand. */
6433
6434 static bfd_boolean
6435 ppc64_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
6436 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6437 {
6438 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
6439 asection *s, *srel;
6440
6441 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
6442 if (htab == NULL)
6443 return FALSE;
6444
6445 /* Deal with function syms. */
6446 if (h->type == STT_FUNC
6447 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6448 || h->needs_plt)
6449 {
6450 bfd_boolean local = (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->save_res
6451 || SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
6452 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h));
6453 /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a
6454 function symbol is local and not an ifunc. We keep dynamic
6455 relocs for ifuncs when local rather than always emitting a
6456 plt call stub for them and defining the symbol on the call
6457 stub. We can't do that for ELFv1 anyway (a function symbol
6458 is defined on a descriptor, not code) and it can be faster at
6459 run-time due to not needing to bounce through a stub. The
6460 dyn_relocs for ifuncs will be applied even in a static
6461 executable. */
6462 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
6463 && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
6464 && local)
6465 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
6466
6467 /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that
6468 won't need a .plt entry. */
6469 struct plt_entry *ent;
6470 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
6471 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
6472 break;
6473 if (ent == NULL
6474 || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
6475 && local
6476 && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
6477 || (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
6478 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)))
6479 {
6480 h->plt.plist = NULL;
6481 h->needs_plt = 0;
6482 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
6483 }
6484 else if (abiversion (info->output_bfd) >= 2)
6485 {
6486 /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section
6487 doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the
6488 executable on a global entry stub. A dynamic reloc can
6489 be used instead. The reason we prefer a few more dynamic
6490 relocs is that calling via a global entry stub costs a
6491 few more instructions, and pointer_equality_needed causes
6492 extra work in ld.so when resolving these symbols. */
6493 if (global_entry_stub (h))
6494 {
6495 if (!readonly_dynrelocs (h))
6496 {
6497 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
6498 /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol
6499 isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry. */
6500 if (!h->needs_plt)
6501 h->plt.plist = NULL;
6502 }
6503 else if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
6504 /* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the
6505 plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic. */
6506 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
6507 }
6508
6509 /* ELFv2 function symbols can't have copy relocs. */
6510 return TRUE;
6511 }
6512 else if (!h->needs_plt
6513 && !readonly_dynrelocs (h))
6514 {
6515 /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol isn't an
6516 ifunc then we don't need a plt entry. */
6517 h->plt.plist = NULL;
6518 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
6519 return TRUE;
6520 }
6521 }
6522 else
6523 h->plt.plist = NULL;
6524
6525 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
6526 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
6527 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
6528 if (h->is_weakalias)
6529 {
6530 struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
6531 BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
6532 h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
6533 h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
6534 if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
6535 || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
6536 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
6537 return TRUE;
6538 }
6539
6540 /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
6541 only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
6542 For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
6543 be handled correctly by relocate_section. */
6544 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
6545 return TRUE;
6546
6547 /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
6548 GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc. */
6549 if (!h->non_got_ref)
6550 return TRUE;
6551
6552 /* Don't generate a copy reloc for symbols defined in the executable. */
6553 if (!h->def_dynamic || !h->ref_regular || h->def_regular
6554
6555 /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, don't generate them either. */
6556 || info->nocopyreloc
6557
6558 /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
6559 we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc. */
6560 || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
6561 && !h->needs_copy
6562 && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
6563
6564 /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss. The copy in
6565 .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected
6566 definition for the variable. Text relocations are preferable
6567 to an incorrect program. */
6568 || h->protected_def)
6569 return TRUE;
6570
6571 if (h->type == STT_FUNC
6572 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
6573 {
6574 /* .dynbss copies of function symbols only work if we have
6575 ELFv1 dot-symbols. ELFv1 compilers since 2004 default to not
6576 use dot-symbols and set the function symbol size to the text
6577 size of the function rather than the size of the descriptor.
6578 That's wrong for copying a descriptor. */
6579 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->oh == NULL
6580 || !(h->size == 24 || h->size == 16))
6581 return TRUE;
6582
6583 /* We should never get here, but unfortunately there are old
6584 versions of gcc (circa gcc-3.2) that improperly for the
6585 ELFv1 ABI put initialized function pointers, vtable refs and
6586 suchlike in read-only sections. Allow them to proceed, but
6587 warn that this might break at runtime. */
6588 info->callbacks->einfo
6589 (_("%P: copy reloc against `%pT' requires lazy plt linking; "
6590 "avoid setting LD_BIND_NOW=1 or upgrade gcc\n"),
6591 h->root.root.string);
6592 }
6593
6594 /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
6595 is not a function. */
6596
6597 /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
6598 become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
6599 an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
6600 object will contain position independent code, so all references
6601 from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
6602 offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
6603 determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
6604 both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
6605 same memory location for the variable. */
6606 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
6607 {
6608 s = htab->elf.sdynrelro;
6609 srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
6610 }
6611 else
6612 {
6613 s = htab->elf.sdynbss;
6614 srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
6615 }
6616 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
6617 {
6618 /* We must generate a R_PPC64_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic
6619 linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object
6620 and into the runtime process image. */
6621 srel->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
6622 h->needs_copy = 1;
6623 }
6624
6625 /* We no longer want dyn_relocs. */
6626 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
6627 return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
6628 }
6629
6630 /* If given a function descriptor symbol, hide both the function code
6631 sym and the descriptor. */
6632 static void
6633 ppc64_elf_hide_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
6634 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6635 bfd_boolean force_local)
6636 {
6637 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
6638 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, h, force_local);
6639
6640 if (ppc_hash_table (info) == NULL)
6641 return;
6642
6643 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
6644 if (eh->is_func_descriptor)
6645 {
6646 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh = eh->oh;
6647
6648 if (fh == NULL)
6649 {
6650 const char *p, *q;
6651 struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
6652 char save;
6653
6654 /* We aren't supposed to use alloca in BFD because on
6655 systems which do not have alloca the version in libiberty
6656 calls xmalloc, which might cause the program to crash
6657 when it runs out of memory. This function doesn't have a
6658 return status, so there's no way to gracefully return an
6659 error. So cheat. We know that string[-1] can be safely
6660 accessed; It's either a string in an ELF string table,
6661 or allocated in an objalloc structure. */
6662
6663 p = eh->elf.root.root.string - 1;
6664 save = *p;
6665 *(char *) p = '.';
6666 fh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (elf_link_hash_lookup (htab, p, FALSE,
6667 FALSE, FALSE));
6668 *(char *) p = save;
6669
6670 /* Unfortunately, if it so happens that the string we were
6671 looking for was allocated immediately before this string,
6672 then we overwrote the string terminator. That's the only
6673 reason the lookup should fail. */
6674 if (fh == NULL)
6675 {
6676 q = eh->elf.root.root.string + strlen (eh->elf.root.root.string);
6677 while (q >= eh->elf.root.root.string && *q == *p)
6678 --q, --p;
6679 if (q < eh->elf.root.root.string && *p == '.')
6680 fh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (elf_link_hash_lookup (htab, p, FALSE,
6681 FALSE, FALSE));
6682 }
6683 if (fh != NULL)
6684 {
6685 eh->oh = fh;
6686 fh->oh = eh;
6687 }
6688 }
6689 if (fh != NULL)
6690 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &fh->elf, force_local);
6691 }
6692 }
6693
6694 static bfd_boolean
6695 get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp,
6696 Elf_Internal_Sym **symp,
6697 asection **symsecp,
6698 unsigned char **tls_maskp,
6699 Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
6700 unsigned long r_symndx,
6701 bfd *ibfd)
6702 {
6703 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
6704
6705 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
6706 {
6707 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
6708 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6709
6710 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
6711 h = elf_follow_link (h);
6712
6713 if (hp != NULL)
6714 *hp = h;
6715
6716 if (symp != NULL)
6717 *symp = NULL;
6718
6719 if (symsecp != NULL)
6720 {
6721 asection *symsec = NULL;
6722 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6723 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6724 symsec = h->root.u.def.section;
6725 *symsecp = symsec;
6726 }
6727
6728 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
6729 *tls_maskp = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
6730 }
6731 else
6732 {
6733 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
6734 Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp;
6735
6736 if (locsyms == NULL)
6737 {
6738 locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
6739 if (locsyms == NULL)
6740 locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr,
6741 symtab_hdr->sh_info,
6742 0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
6743 if (locsyms == NULL)
6744 return FALSE;
6745 *locsymsp = locsyms;
6746 }
6747 sym = locsyms + r_symndx;
6748
6749 if (hp != NULL)
6750 *hp = NULL;
6751
6752 if (symp != NULL)
6753 *symp = sym;
6754
6755 if (symsecp != NULL)
6756 *symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx);
6757
6758 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
6759 {
6760 struct got_entry **lgot_ents;
6761 unsigned char *tls_mask;
6762
6763 tls_mask = NULL;
6764 lgot_ents = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd);
6765 if (lgot_ents != NULL)
6766 {
6767 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6768 (lgot_ents + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6769 unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
6770 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6771 tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
6772 }
6773 *tls_maskp = tls_mask;
6774 }
6775 }
6776 return TRUE;
6777 }
6778
6779 /* Returns TLS_MASKP for the given REL symbol. Function return is 0 on
6780 error, 2 on a toc GD type suitable for optimization, 3 on a toc LD
6781 type suitable for optimization, and 1 otherwise. */
6782
6783 static int
6784 get_tls_mask (unsigned char **tls_maskp,
6785 unsigned long *toc_symndx,
6786 bfd_vma *toc_addend,
6787 Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
6788 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
6789 bfd *ibfd)
6790 {
6791 unsigned long r_symndx;
6792 int next_r;
6793 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6794 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
6795 asection *sec;
6796 bfd_vma off;
6797
6798 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
6799 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sec, tls_maskp, locsymsp, r_symndx, ibfd))
6800 return 0;
6801
6802 if ((*tls_maskp != NULL
6803 && (**tls_maskp & TLS_TLS) != 0
6804 && **tls_maskp != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
6805 || sec == NULL
6806 || ppc64_elf_section_data (sec) == NULL
6807 || ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->sec_type != sec_toc)
6808 return 1;
6809
6810 /* Look inside a TOC section too. */
6811 if (h != NULL)
6812 {
6813 BFD_ASSERT (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
6814 off = h->root.u.def.value;
6815 }
6816 else
6817 off = sym->st_value;
6818 off += rel->r_addend;
6819 BFD_ASSERT (off % 8 == 0);
6820 r_symndx = ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->u.toc.symndx[off / 8];
6821 next_r = ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->u.toc.symndx[off / 8 + 1];
6822 if (toc_symndx != NULL)
6823 *toc_symndx = r_symndx;
6824 if (toc_addend != NULL)
6825 *toc_addend = ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->u.toc.add[off / 8];
6826 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sec, tls_maskp, locsymsp, r_symndx, ibfd))
6827 return 0;
6828 if ((h == NULL || is_static_defined (h))
6829 && (next_r == -1 || next_r == -2))
6830 return 1 - next_r;
6831 return 1;
6832 }
6833
6834 /* Find (or create) an entry in the tocsave hash table. */
6835
6836 static struct tocsave_entry *
6837 tocsave_find (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
6838 enum insert_option insert,
6839 Elf_Internal_Sym **local_syms,
6840 const Elf_Internal_Rela *irela,
6841 bfd *ibfd)
6842 {
6843 unsigned long r_indx;
6844 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6845 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
6846 struct tocsave_entry ent, *p;
6847 hashval_t hash;
6848 struct tocsave_entry **slot;
6849
6850 r_indx = ELF64_R_SYM (irela->r_info);
6851 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &ent.sec, NULL, local_syms, r_indx, ibfd))
6852 return NULL;
6853 if (ent.sec == NULL || ent.sec->output_section == NULL)
6854 {
6855 _bfd_error_handler
6856 (_("%pB: undefined symbol on R_PPC64_TOCSAVE relocation"), ibfd);
6857 return NULL;
6858 }
6859
6860 if (h != NULL)
6861 ent.offset = h->root.u.def.value;
6862 else
6863 ent.offset = sym->st_value;
6864 ent.offset += irela->r_addend;
6865
6866 hash = tocsave_htab_hash (&ent);
6867 slot = ((struct tocsave_entry **)
6868 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htab->tocsave_htab, &ent, hash, insert));
6869 if (slot == NULL)
6870 return NULL;
6871
6872 if (*slot == NULL)
6873 {
6874 p = (struct tocsave_entry *) bfd_alloc (ibfd, sizeof (*p));
6875 if (p == NULL)
6876 return NULL;
6877 *p = ent;
6878 *slot = p;
6879 }
6880 return *slot;
6881 }
6882
6883 /* Adjust all global syms defined in opd sections. In gcc generated
6884 code for the old ABI, these will already have been done. */
6885
6886 static bfd_boolean
6887 adjust_opd_syms (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6888 {
6889 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
6890 asection *sym_sec;
6891 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
6892
6893 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
6894 return TRUE;
6895
6896 if (h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
6897 && h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6898 return TRUE;
6899
6900 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
6901 if (eh->adjust_done)
6902 return TRUE;
6903
6904 sym_sec = eh->elf.root.u.def.section;
6905 opd = get_opd_info (sym_sec);
6906 if (opd != NULL && opd->adjust != NULL)
6907 {
6908 long adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (eh->elf.root.u.def.value)];
6909 if (adjust == -1)
6910 {
6911 /* This entry has been deleted. */
6912 asection *dsec = ppc64_elf_tdata (sym_sec->owner)->deleted_section;
6913 if (dsec == NULL)
6914 {
6915 for (dsec = sym_sec->owner->sections; dsec; dsec = dsec->next)
6916 if (discarded_section (dsec))
6917 {
6918 ppc64_elf_tdata (sym_sec->owner)->deleted_section = dsec;
6919 break;
6920 }
6921 }
6922 eh->elf.root.u.def.value = 0;
6923 eh->elf.root.u.def.section = dsec;
6924 }
6925 else
6926 eh->elf.root.u.def.value += adjust;
6927 eh->adjust_done = 1;
6928 }
6929 return TRUE;
6930 }
6931
6932 /* Handles decrementing dynamic reloc counts for the reloc specified by
6933 R_INFO in section SEC. If LOCAL_SYMS is NULL, then H and SYM
6934 have already been determined. */
6935
6936 static bfd_boolean
6937 dec_dynrel_count (bfd_vma r_info,
6938 asection *sec,
6939 struct bfd_link_info *info,
6940 Elf_Internal_Sym **local_syms,
6941 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6942 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
6943 {
6944 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
6945 asection *sym_sec = NULL;
6946
6947 /* Can this reloc be dynamic? This switch, and later tests here
6948 should be kept in sync with the code in check_relocs. */
6949 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (r_info);
6950 switch (r_type)
6951 {
6952 default:
6953 return TRUE;
6954
6955 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
6956 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
6957 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
6958 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
6959 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
6960 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
6961 if (h == NULL)
6962 return TRUE;
6963 break;
6964
6965 case R_PPC64_TPREL16:
6966 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
6967 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI:
6968 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
6969 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
6970 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
6971 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:
6972 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
6973 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:
6974 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
6975 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:
6976 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
6977 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
6978 case R_PPC64_TPREL34:
6979 case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
6980 case R_PPC64_DTPREL64:
6981 case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
6982 case R_PPC64_REL30:
6983 case R_PPC64_REL32:
6984 case R_PPC64_REL64:
6985 case R_PPC64_ADDR14:
6986 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
6987 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
6988 case R_PPC64_ADDR16:
6989 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
6990 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA:
6991 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI:
6992 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH:
6993 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA:
6994 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER:
6995 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA:
6996 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST:
6997 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA:
6998 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO:
6999 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
7000 case R_PPC64_ADDR24:
7001 case R_PPC64_ADDR32:
7002 case R_PPC64_UADDR16:
7003 case R_PPC64_UADDR32:
7004 case R_PPC64_UADDR64:
7005 case R_PPC64_TOC:
7006 case R_PPC64_D34:
7007 case R_PPC64_D34_LO:
7008 case R_PPC64_D34_HI30:
7009 case R_PPC64_D34_HA30:
7010 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER34:
7011 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34:
7012 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST34:
7013 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34:
7014 case R_PPC64_D28:
7015 break;
7016 }
7017
7018 if (local_syms != NULL)
7019 {
7020 unsigned long r_symndx;
7021 bfd *ibfd = sec->owner;
7022
7023 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (r_info);
7024 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, local_syms, r_symndx, ibfd))
7025 return FALSE;
7026 }
7027
7028 if ((h != NULL
7029 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
7030 || !h->def_regular))
7031 || (h != NULL
7032 && !bfd_link_executable (info)
7033 && !SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h))
7034 || (bfd_link_pic (info)
7035 && must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
7036 || (!bfd_link_pic (info)
7037 && (h != NULL
7038 ? h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
7039 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)))
7040 ;
7041 else
7042 return TRUE;
7043
7044 if (h != NULL)
7045 {
7046 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
7047 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
7048 pp = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs;
7049
7050 /* elf_gc_sweep may have already removed all dyn relocs associated
7051 with local syms for a given section. Also, symbol flags are
7052 changed by elf_gc_sweep_symbol, confusing the test above. Don't
7053 report a dynreloc miscount. */
7054 if (*pp == NULL && info->gc_sections)
7055 return TRUE;
7056
7057 while ((p = *pp) != NULL)
7058 {
7059 if (p->sec == sec)
7060 {
7061 if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
7062 p->pc_count -= 1;
7063 p->count -= 1;
7064 if (p->count == 0)
7065 *pp = p->next;
7066 return TRUE;
7067 }
7068 pp = &p->next;
7069 }
7070 }
7071 else
7072 {
7073 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
7074 struct ppc_dyn_relocs **pp;
7075 void *vpp;
7076 bfd_boolean is_ifunc;
7077
7078 if (local_syms == NULL)
7079 sym_sec = bfd_section_from_elf_index (sec->owner, sym->st_shndx);
7080 if (sym_sec == NULL)
7081 sym_sec = sec;
7082
7083 vpp = &elf_section_data (sym_sec)->local_dynrel;
7084 pp = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
7085
7086 if (*pp == NULL && info->gc_sections)
7087 return TRUE;
7088
7089 is_ifunc = ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC;
7090 while ((p = *pp) != NULL)
7091 {
7092 if (p->sec == sec && p->ifunc == is_ifunc)
7093 {
7094 p->count -= 1;
7095 if (p->count == 0)
7096 *pp = p->next;
7097 return TRUE;
7098 }
7099 pp = &p->next;
7100 }
7101 }
7102
7103 /* xgettext:c-format */
7104 _bfd_error_handler (_("dynreloc miscount for %pB, section %pA"),
7105 sec->owner, sec);
7106 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7107 return FALSE;
7108 }
7109
7110 /* Remove unused Official Procedure Descriptor entries. Currently we
7111 only remove those associated with functions in discarded link-once
7112 sections, or weakly defined functions that have been overridden. It
7113 would be possible to remove many more entries for statically linked
7114 applications. */
7115
7116 bfd_boolean
7117 ppc64_elf_edit_opd (struct bfd_link_info *info)
7118 {
7119 bfd *ibfd;
7120 bfd_boolean some_edited = FALSE;
7121 asection *need_pad = NULL;
7122 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
7123
7124 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
7125 if (htab == NULL)
7126 return FALSE;
7127
7128 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
7129 {
7130 asection *sec;
7131 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
7132 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7133 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
7134 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
7135 bfd_boolean need_edit, add_aux_fields, broken;
7136 bfd_size_type cnt_16b = 0;
7137
7138 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
7139 continue;
7140
7141 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".opd");
7142 if (sec == NULL || sec->size == 0)
7143 continue;
7144
7145 if (sec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_JUST_SYMS)
7146 continue;
7147
7148 if (sec->output_section == bfd_abs_section_ptr)
7149 continue;
7150
7151 /* Look through the section relocs. */
7152 if ((sec->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0 || sec->reloc_count == 0)
7153 continue;
7154
7155 local_syms = NULL;
7156 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
7157
7158 /* Read the relocations. */
7159 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
7160 info->keep_memory);
7161 if (relstart == NULL)
7162 return FALSE;
7163
7164 /* First run through the relocs to check they are sane, and to
7165 determine whether we need to edit this opd section. */
7166 need_edit = FALSE;
7167 broken = FALSE;
7168 need_pad = sec;
7169 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
7170 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
7171 {
7172 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
7173 unsigned long r_symndx;
7174 asection *sym_sec;
7175 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7176 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7177 bfd_vma offset;
7178
7179 /* .opd contains an array of 16 or 24 byte entries. We're
7180 only interested in the reloc pointing to a function entry
7181 point. */
7182 offset = rel->r_offset;
7183 if (rel + 1 == relend
7184 || rel[1].r_offset != offset + 8)
7185 {
7186 /* If someone messes with .opd alignment then after a
7187 "ld -r" we might have padding in the middle of .opd.
7188 Also, there's nothing to prevent someone putting
7189 something silly in .opd with the assembler. No .opd
7190 optimization for them! */
7191 broken_opd:
7192 _bfd_error_handler
7193 (_("%pB: .opd is not a regular array of opd entries"), ibfd);
7194 broken = TRUE;
7195 break;
7196 }
7197
7198 if ((r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info)) != R_PPC64_ADDR64
7199 || (r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE ((rel + 1)->r_info)) != R_PPC64_TOC)
7200 {
7201 _bfd_error_handler
7202 /* xgettext:c-format */
7203 (_("%pB: unexpected reloc type %u in .opd section"),
7204 ibfd, r_type);
7205 broken = TRUE;
7206 break;
7207 }
7208
7209 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7210 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
7211 r_symndx, ibfd))
7212 goto error_ret;
7213
7214 if (sym_sec == NULL || sym_sec->owner == NULL)
7215 {
7216 const char *sym_name;
7217 if (h != NULL)
7218 sym_name = h->root.root.string;
7219 else
7220 sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (ibfd, symtab_hdr, sym,
7221 sym_sec);
7222
7223 _bfd_error_handler
7224 /* xgettext:c-format */
7225 (_("%pB: undefined sym `%s' in .opd section"),
7226 ibfd, sym_name);
7227 broken = TRUE;
7228 break;
7229 }
7230
7231 /* opd entries are always for functions defined in the
7232 current input bfd. If the symbol isn't defined in the
7233 input bfd, then we won't be using the function in this
7234 bfd; It must be defined in a linkonce section in another
7235 bfd, or is weak. It's also possible that we are
7236 discarding the function due to a linker script /DISCARD/,
7237 which we test for via the output_section. */
7238 if (sym_sec->owner != ibfd
7239 || sym_sec->output_section == bfd_abs_section_ptr)
7240 need_edit = TRUE;
7241
7242 rel += 2;
7243 if (rel + 1 == relend
7244 || (rel + 2 < relend
7245 && ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[2].r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC))
7246 ++rel;
7247
7248 if (rel == relend)
7249 {
7250 if (sec->size == offset + 24)
7251 {
7252 need_pad = NULL;
7253 break;
7254 }
7255 if (sec->size == offset + 16)
7256 {
7257 cnt_16b++;
7258 break;
7259 }
7260 goto broken_opd;
7261 }
7262 else if (rel + 1 < relend
7263 && ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[0].r_info) == R_PPC64_ADDR64
7264 && ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC)
7265 {
7266 if (rel[0].r_offset == offset + 16)
7267 cnt_16b++;
7268 else if (rel[0].r_offset != offset + 24)
7269 goto broken_opd;
7270 }
7271 else
7272 goto broken_opd;
7273 }
7274
7275 add_aux_fields = htab->params->non_overlapping_opd && cnt_16b > 0;
7276
7277 if (!broken && (need_edit || add_aux_fields))
7278 {
7279 Elf_Internal_Rela *write_rel;
7280 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
7281 bfd_byte *rptr, *wptr;
7282 bfd_byte *new_contents;
7283 bfd_size_type amt;
7284
7285 new_contents = NULL;
7286 amt = OPD_NDX (sec->size) * sizeof (long);
7287 opd = &ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->u.opd;
7288 opd->adjust = bfd_zalloc (sec->owner, amt);
7289 if (opd->adjust == NULL)
7290 return FALSE;
7291
7292 /* This seems a waste of time as input .opd sections are all
7293 zeros as generated by gcc, but I suppose there's no reason
7294 this will always be so. We might start putting something in
7295 the third word of .opd entries. */
7296 if ((sec->flags & SEC_IN_MEMORY) == 0)
7297 {
7298 bfd_byte *loc;
7299 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (ibfd, sec, &loc))
7300 {
7301 if (loc != NULL)
7302 free (loc);
7303 error_ret:
7304 if (local_syms != NULL
7305 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
7306 free (local_syms);
7307 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
7308 free (relstart);
7309 return FALSE;
7310 }
7311 sec->contents = loc;
7312 sec->flags |= (SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
7313 }
7314
7315 elf_section_data (sec)->relocs = relstart;
7316
7317 new_contents = sec->contents;
7318 if (add_aux_fields)
7319 {
7320 new_contents = bfd_malloc (sec->size + cnt_16b * 8);
7321 if (new_contents == NULL)
7322 return FALSE;
7323 need_pad = NULL;
7324 }
7325 wptr = new_contents;
7326 rptr = sec->contents;
7327 write_rel = relstart;
7328 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
7329 {
7330 unsigned long r_symndx;
7331 asection *sym_sec;
7332 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7333 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh = NULL;
7334 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7335 long opd_ent_size;
7336 Elf_Internal_Rela *next_rel;
7337 bfd_boolean skip;
7338
7339 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7340 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
7341 r_symndx, ibfd))
7342 goto error_ret;
7343
7344 next_rel = rel + 2;
7345 if (next_rel + 1 == relend
7346 || (next_rel + 2 < relend
7347 && ELF64_R_TYPE (next_rel[2].r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC))
7348 ++next_rel;
7349
7350 /* See if the .opd entry is full 24 byte or
7351 16 byte (with fd_aux entry overlapped with next
7352 fd_func). */
7353 opd_ent_size = 24;
7354 if (next_rel == relend)
7355 {
7356 if (sec->size == rel->r_offset + 16)
7357 opd_ent_size = 16;
7358 }
7359 else if (next_rel->r_offset == rel->r_offset + 16)
7360 opd_ent_size = 16;
7361
7362 if (h != NULL
7363 && h->root.root.string[0] == '.')
7364 {
7365 fdh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->oh;
7366 if (fdh != NULL)
7367 {
7368 fdh = ppc_follow_link (fdh);
7369 if (fdh->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
7370 && fdh->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
7371 fdh = NULL;
7372 }
7373 }
7374
7375 skip = (sym_sec->owner != ibfd
7376 || sym_sec->output_section == bfd_abs_section_ptr);
7377 if (skip)
7378 {
7379 if (fdh != NULL && sym_sec->owner == ibfd)
7380 {
7381 /* Arrange for the function descriptor sym
7382 to be dropped. */
7383 fdh->elf.root.u.def.value = 0;
7384 fdh->elf.root.u.def.section = sym_sec;
7385 }
7386 opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (rel->r_offset)] = -1;
7387
7388 if (NO_OPD_RELOCS || bfd_link_relocatable (info))
7389 rel = next_rel;
7390 else
7391 while (1)
7392 {
7393 if (!dec_dynrel_count (rel->r_info, sec, info,
7394 NULL, h, sym))
7395 goto error_ret;
7396
7397 if (++rel == next_rel)
7398 break;
7399
7400 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7401 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
7402 r_symndx, ibfd))
7403 goto error_ret;
7404 }
7405 }
7406 else
7407 {
7408 /* We'll be keeping this opd entry. */
7409 long adjust;
7410
7411 if (fdh != NULL)
7412 {
7413 /* Redefine the function descriptor symbol to
7414 this location in the opd section. It is
7415 necessary to update the value here rather
7416 than using an array of adjustments as we do
7417 for local symbols, because various places
7418 in the generic ELF code use the value
7419 stored in u.def.value. */
7420 fdh->elf.root.u.def.value = wptr - new_contents;
7421 fdh->adjust_done = 1;
7422 }
7423
7424 /* Local syms are a bit tricky. We could
7425 tweak them as they can be cached, but
7426 we'd need to look through the local syms
7427 for the function descriptor sym which we
7428 don't have at the moment. So keep an
7429 array of adjustments. */
7430 adjust = (wptr - new_contents) - (rptr - sec->contents);
7431 opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (rel->r_offset)] = adjust;
7432
7433 if (wptr != rptr)
7434 memcpy (wptr, rptr, opd_ent_size);
7435 wptr += opd_ent_size;
7436 if (add_aux_fields && opd_ent_size == 16)
7437 {
7438 memset (wptr, '\0', 8);
7439 wptr += 8;
7440 }
7441
7442 /* We need to adjust any reloc offsets to point to the
7443 new opd entries. */
7444 for ( ; rel != next_rel; ++rel)
7445 {
7446 rel->r_offset += adjust;
7447 if (write_rel != rel)
7448 memcpy (write_rel, rel, sizeof (*rel));
7449 ++write_rel;
7450 }
7451 }
7452
7453 rptr += opd_ent_size;
7454 }
7455
7456 sec->size = wptr - new_contents;
7457 sec->reloc_count = write_rel - relstart;
7458 if (add_aux_fields)
7459 {
7460 free (sec->contents);
7461 sec->contents = new_contents;
7462 }
7463
7464 /* Fudge the header size too, as this is used later in
7465 elf_bfd_final_link if we are emitting relocs. */
7466 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (sec);
7467 rel_hdr->sh_size = sec->reloc_count * rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
7468 some_edited = TRUE;
7469 }
7470 else if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
7471 free (relstart);
7472
7473 if (local_syms != NULL
7474 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
7475 {
7476 if (!info->keep_memory)
7477 free (local_syms);
7478 else
7479 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
7480 }
7481 }
7482
7483 if (some_edited)
7484 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), adjust_opd_syms, NULL);
7485
7486 /* If we are doing a final link and the last .opd entry is just 16 byte
7487 long, add a 8 byte padding after it. */
7488 if (need_pad != NULL && !bfd_link_relocatable (info))
7489 {
7490 bfd_byte *p;
7491
7492 if ((need_pad->flags & SEC_IN_MEMORY) == 0)
7493 {
7494 BFD_ASSERT (need_pad->size > 0);
7495
7496 p = bfd_malloc (need_pad->size + 8);
7497 if (p == NULL)
7498 return FALSE;
7499
7500 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (need_pad->owner, need_pad,
7501 p, 0, need_pad->size))
7502 return FALSE;
7503
7504 need_pad->contents = p;
7505 need_pad->flags |= (SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
7506 }
7507 else
7508 {
7509 p = bfd_realloc (need_pad->contents, need_pad->size + 8);
7510 if (p == NULL)
7511 return FALSE;
7512
7513 need_pad->contents = p;
7514 }
7515
7516 memset (need_pad->contents + need_pad->size, 0, 8);
7517 need_pad->size += 8;
7518 }
7519
7520 return TRUE;
7521 }
7522
7523 /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally
7524 defined functions can be converted to direct calls. */
7525
7526 bfd_boolean
7527 ppc64_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info)
7528 {
7529 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
7530 bfd *ibfd;
7531 asection *sec;
7532 bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit;
7533
7534 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
7535 if (htab == NULL)
7536 return FALSE;
7537
7538 /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc. The limit is
7539 reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added
7540 between the call and its destination. */
7541 if (htab->params->group_size < 0)
7542 {
7543 limit = -htab->params->group_size;
7544 if (limit == 1)
7545 limit = 0x1e00000;
7546 }
7547 else
7548 {
7549 limit = htab->params->group_size;
7550 if (limit == 1)
7551 limit = 0x1c00000;
7552 }
7553
7554 low_vma = -1;
7555 high_vma = 0;
7556 for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
7557 if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
7558 {
7559 if (low_vma > sec->vma)
7560 low_vma = sec->vma;
7561 if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size)
7562 high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size;
7563 }
7564
7565 /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can
7566 convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol
7567 is local. */
7568 if (high_vma - low_vma < limit)
7569 {
7570 htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1;
7571 return TRUE;
7572 }
7573
7574 /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct
7575 call won't reach. Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable
7576 the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that
7577 this will be better than creating trampolines. Note that this
7578 will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a
7579 particular symbol, not just those that won't reach. The
7580 difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the
7581 linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a
7582 particular R_PPC64_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct
7583 call, for each of the R_PPC64_PLTSEQ and R_PPC64_PLT16* insns in
7584 the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs
7585 together except their symbol. */
7586
7587 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
7588 {
7589 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7590 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
7591
7592 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
7593 continue;
7594
7595 local_syms = NULL;
7596 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
7597
7598 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
7599 if (ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->has_pltcall
7600 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
7601 {
7602 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
7603
7604 /* Read the relocations. */
7605 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
7606 info->keep_memory);
7607 if (relstart == NULL)
7608 return FALSE;
7609
7610 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
7611 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
7612 {
7613 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
7614 unsigned long r_symndx;
7615 asection *sym_sec;
7616 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7617 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7618 unsigned char *tls_maskp;
7619
7620 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7621 if (r_type != R_PPC64_PLTCALL
7622 && r_type != R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC)
7623 continue;
7624
7625 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7626 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms,
7627 r_symndx, ibfd))
7628 {
7629 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
7630 free (relstart);
7631 if (local_syms != NULL
7632 && symtab_hdr->contents != (bfd_byte *) local_syms)
7633 free (local_syms);
7634 return FALSE;
7635 }
7636
7637 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
7638 {
7639 bfd_vma from, to;
7640 if (h != NULL)
7641 to = h->root.u.def.value;
7642 else
7643 to = sym->st_value;
7644 to += (rel->r_addend
7645 + sym_sec->output_offset
7646 + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
7647 from = (rel->r_offset
7648 + sec->output_offset
7649 + sec->output_section->vma);
7650 if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit
7651 && !(r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC
7652 && (((h ? h->other : sym->st_other)
7653 & STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK)
7654 > 1 << STO_PPC64_LOCAL_BIT)))
7655 *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP;
7656 }
7657 }
7658 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
7659 free (relstart);
7660 }
7661
7662 if (local_syms != NULL
7663 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
7664 {
7665 if (!info->keep_memory)
7666 free (local_syms);
7667 else
7668 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
7669 }
7670 }
7671
7672 return TRUE;
7673 }
7674
7675 /* Set htab->tls_get_addr and call the generic ELF tls_setup function. */
7676
7677 asection *
7678 ppc64_elf_tls_setup (struct bfd_link_info *info)
7679 {
7680 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
7681 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga, *tga_fd, *desc, *desc_fd;
7682
7683 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
7684 if (htab == NULL)
7685 return NULL;
7686
7687 if (abiversion (info->output_bfd) == 1)
7688 htab->opd_abi = 1;
7689
7690 if (htab->params->no_multi_toc)
7691 htab->do_multi_toc = 0;
7692 else if (!htab->do_multi_toc)
7693 htab->params->no_multi_toc = 1;
7694
7695 /* Default to --no-plt-localentry, as this option can cause problems
7696 with symbol interposition. For example, glibc libpthread.so and
7697 libc.so duplicate many pthread symbols, with a fallback
7698 implementation in libc.so. In some cases the fallback does more
7699 work than the pthread implementation. __pthread_condattr_destroy
7700 is one such symbol: the libpthread.so implementation is
7701 localentry:0 while the libc.so implementation is localentry:8.
7702 An app that "cleverly" uses dlopen to only load necessary
7703 libraries at runtime may omit loading libpthread.so when not
7704 running multi-threaded, which then results in the libc.so
7705 fallback symbols being used and ld.so complaining. Now there
7706 are workarounds in ld (see non_zero_localentry) to detect the
7707 pthread situation, but that may not be the only case where
7708 --plt-localentry can cause trouble. */
7709 if (htab->params->plt_localentry0 < 0)
7710 htab->params->plt_localentry0 = 0;
7711 if (htab->params->plt_localentry0
7712 && elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "GLIBC_2.26",
7713 FALSE, FALSE, FALSE) == NULL)
7714 _bfd_error_handler
7715 (_("warning: --plt-localentry is especially dangerous without "
7716 "ld.so support to detect ABI violations"));
7717
7718 tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, ".__tls_get_addr",
7719 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
7720 htab->tls_get_addr = ppc_elf_hash_entry (tga);
7721
7722 /* Move dynamic linking info to the function descriptor sym. */
7723 if (tga != NULL)
7724 func_desc_adjust (tga, info);
7725 tga_fd = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
7726 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
7727 htab->tls_get_addr_fd = ppc_elf_hash_entry (tga_fd);
7728
7729 desc = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, ".__tls_get_addr_desc",
7730 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
7731 htab->tga_desc = ppc_elf_hash_entry (desc);
7732 if (desc != NULL)
7733 func_desc_adjust (desc, info);
7734 desc_fd = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_desc",
7735 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
7736 htab->tga_desc_fd = ppc_elf_hash_entry (desc_fd);
7737
7738 if (htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt)
7739 {
7740 struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *opt_fd;
7741
7742 opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, ".__tls_get_addr_opt",
7743 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
7744 if (opt != NULL)
7745 func_desc_adjust (opt, info);
7746 opt_fd = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt",
7747 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
7748 if (opt_fd != NULL
7749 && (opt_fd->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
7750 || opt_fd->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
7751 {
7752 /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub,
7753 signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll
7754 be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then
7755 make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt. */
7756 if (!(htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7757 && tga_fd != NULL
7758 && (tga_fd->type == STT_FUNC
7759 || tga_fd->needs_plt)
7760 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga_fd)
7761 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga_fd))))
7762 tga_fd = NULL;
7763 if (!(htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7764 && desc_fd != NULL
7765 && (desc_fd->type == STT_FUNC
7766 || desc_fd->needs_plt)
7767 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, desc_fd)
7768 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, desc_fd))))
7769 desc_fd = NULL;
7770
7771 if (tga_fd != NULL || desc_fd != NULL)
7772 {
7773 struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
7774
7775 if (tga_fd != NULL)
7776 for (ent = tga_fd->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
7777 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
7778 break;
7779 if (ent == NULL && desc_fd != NULL)
7780 for (ent = desc_fd->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
7781 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
7782 break;
7783 if (ent != NULL)
7784 {
7785 if (tga_fd != NULL)
7786 {
7787 tga_fd->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
7788 tga_fd->root.u.i.link = &opt_fd->root;
7789 tga_fd->root.u.i.warning = NULL;
7790 ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt_fd, tga_fd);
7791 }
7792 if (desc_fd != NULL)
7793 {
7794 desc_fd->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
7795 desc_fd->root.u.i.link = &opt_fd->root;
7796 desc_fd->root.u.i.warning = NULL;
7797 ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt_fd, desc_fd);
7798 }
7799 opt_fd->mark = 1;
7800 if (opt_fd->dynindx != -1)
7801 {
7802 /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations. */
7803 opt_fd->dynindx = -1;
7804 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
7805 opt_fd->dynstr_index);
7806 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt_fd))
7807 return NULL;
7808 }
7809 if (tga_fd != NULL)
7810 {
7811 htab->tls_get_addr_fd = ppc_elf_hash_entry (opt_fd);
7812 tga = &htab->tls_get_addr->elf;
7813 if (opt != NULL && tga != NULL)
7814 {
7815 tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
7816 tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
7817 tga->root.u.i.warning = NULL;
7818 ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga);
7819 opt->mark = 1;
7820 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, opt,
7821 tga->forced_local);
7822 htab->tls_get_addr = ppc_elf_hash_entry (opt);
7823 }
7824 htab->tls_get_addr_fd->oh = htab->tls_get_addr;
7825 htab->tls_get_addr_fd->is_func_descriptor = 1;
7826 if (htab->tls_get_addr != NULL)
7827 {
7828 htab->tls_get_addr->oh = htab->tls_get_addr_fd;
7829 htab->tls_get_addr->is_func = 1;
7830 }
7831 }
7832 if (desc_fd != NULL)
7833 {
7834 htab->tga_desc_fd = ppc_elf_hash_entry (opt_fd);
7835 if (opt != NULL && desc != NULL)
7836 {
7837 desc->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
7838 desc->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
7839 desc->root.u.i.warning = NULL;
7840 ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, desc);
7841 opt->mark = 1;
7842 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, opt,
7843 desc->forced_local);
7844 htab->tga_desc = ppc_elf_hash_entry (opt);
7845 }
7846 htab->tga_desc_fd->oh = htab->tga_desc;
7847 htab->tga_desc_fd->is_func_descriptor = 1;
7848 if (htab->tga_desc != NULL)
7849 {
7850 htab->tga_desc->oh = htab->tga_desc_fd;
7851 htab->tga_desc->is_func = 1;
7852 }
7853 }
7854 }
7855 }
7856 }
7857 else if (htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt < 0)
7858 htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt = 0;
7859 }
7860
7861 if (htab->tga_desc_fd != NULL
7862 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt
7863 && htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_regsave == -1)
7864 htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_regsave = 0;
7865
7866 return _bfd_elf_tls_setup (info->output_bfd, info);
7867 }
7868
7869 /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching
7870 any of HASH1, HASH2, HASH3, or HASH4. */
7871
7872 static bfd_boolean
7873 branch_reloc_hash_match (const bfd *ibfd,
7874 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
7875 const struct ppc_link_hash_entry *hash1,
7876 const struct ppc_link_hash_entry *hash2,
7877 const struct ppc_link_hash_entry *hash3,
7878 const struct ppc_link_hash_entry *hash4)
7879 {
7880 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
7881 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7882 unsigned int r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7883
7884 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
7885 {
7886 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
7887 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7888
7889 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
7890 h = elf_follow_link (h);
7891 if (h == &hash1->elf || h == &hash2->elf
7892 || h == &hash3->elf || h == &hash4->elf)
7893 return TRUE;
7894 }
7895 return FALSE;
7896 }
7897
7898 /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization
7899 opportunities. The linker has been hacked (see ppc64elf.em) to do
7900 a preliminary section layout so that we know the TLS segment
7901 offsets. We can't optimize earlier because some optimizations need
7902 to know the tp offset, and we need to optimize before allocating
7903 dynamic relocations. */
7904
7905 bfd_boolean
7906 ppc64_elf_tls_optimize (struct bfd_link_info *info)
7907 {
7908 bfd *ibfd;
7909 asection *sec;
7910 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
7911 unsigned char *toc_ref;
7912 int pass;
7913
7914 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
7915 return TRUE;
7916
7917 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
7918 if (htab == NULL)
7919 return FALSE;
7920
7921 /* Make two passes over the relocs. On the first pass, mark toc
7922 entries involved with tls relocs, and check that tls relocs
7923 involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed followed by
7924 such a call. If they are not, we can't do any tls optimization.
7925 On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to notify
7926 relocate_section that optimization can be done, and adjust got
7927 and plt refcounts. */
7928 toc_ref = NULL;
7929 for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass)
7930 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
7931 {
7932 Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = NULL;
7933 asection *toc = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".toc");
7934
7935 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
7936 if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
7937 {
7938 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
7939 bfd_boolean found_tls_get_addr_arg = 0;
7940
7941 /* Read the relocations. */
7942 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
7943 info->keep_memory);
7944 if (relstart == NULL)
7945 {
7946 free (toc_ref);
7947 return FALSE;
7948 }
7949
7950 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
7951 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
7952 {
7953 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
7954 unsigned long r_symndx;
7955 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7956 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7957 asection *sym_sec;
7958 unsigned char *tls_mask;
7959 unsigned int tls_set, tls_clear, tls_type = 0;
7960 bfd_vma value;
7961 bfd_boolean ok_tprel, is_local;
7962 long toc_ref_index = 0;
7963 int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
7964 bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
7965
7966 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7967 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_mask, &locsyms,
7968 r_symndx, ibfd))
7969 {
7970 err_free_rel:
7971 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
7972 free (relstart);
7973 if (toc_ref != NULL)
7974 free (toc_ref);
7975 if (locsyms != NULL
7976 && (elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd).contents
7977 != (unsigned char *) locsyms))
7978 free (locsyms);
7979 return ret;
7980 }
7981
7982 if (h != NULL)
7983 {
7984 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
7985 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
7986 value = h->root.u.def.value;
7987 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
7988 value = 0;
7989 else
7990 {
7991 found_tls_get_addr_arg = 0;
7992 continue;
7993 }
7994 }
7995 else
7996 /* Symbols referenced by TLS relocs must be of type
7997 STT_TLS. So no need for .opd local sym adjust. */
7998 value = sym->st_value;
7999
8000 ok_tprel = FALSE;
8001 is_local = SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h);
8002 if (is_local)
8003 {
8004 if (h != NULL
8005 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
8006 ok_tprel = TRUE;
8007 else if (sym_sec != NULL
8008 && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
8009 {
8010 value += sym_sec->output_offset;
8011 value += sym_sec->output_section->vma;
8012 value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8013 /* Note that even though the prefix insns
8014 allow a 1<<33 offset we use the same test
8015 as for addis;addi. There may be a mix of
8016 pcrel and non-pcrel code and the decision
8017 to optimise is per symbol, not per TLS
8018 sequence. */
8019 ok_tprel = value + 0x80008000ULL < 1ULL << 32;
8020 }
8021 }
8022
8023 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
8024 /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls
8025 without marker relocs, then check that each
8026 __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc
8027 that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg
8028 setup insn. If we don't find matching arg setup
8029 relocs, don't do any tls optimization. */
8030 if (pass == 0
8031 && sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
8032 && h != NULL
8033 && is_tls_get_addr (h, htab)
8034 && !found_tls_get_addr_arg
8035 && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
8036 {
8037 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, "
8038 "TLS optimization disabled\n"),
8039 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
8040 ret = TRUE;
8041 goto err_free_rel;
8042 }
8043
8044 found_tls_get_addr_arg = 0;
8045 switch (r_type)
8046 {
8047 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16:
8048 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
8049 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD34:
8050 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
8051 found_tls_get_addr_arg = 1;
8052 /* Fall through. */
8053
8054 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
8055 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
8056 /* These relocs should never be against a symbol
8057 defined in a shared lib. Leave them alone if
8058 that turns out to be the case. */
8059 if (!is_local)
8060 continue;
8061
8062 /* LD -> LE */
8063 tls_set = 0;
8064 tls_clear = TLS_LD;
8065 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
8066 break;
8067
8068 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16:
8069 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
8070 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD34:
8071 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
8072 found_tls_get_addr_arg = 1;
8073 /* Fall through. */
8074
8075 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
8076 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
8077 if (ok_tprel)
8078 /* GD -> LE */
8079 tls_set = 0;
8080 else
8081 /* GD -> IE */
8082 tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE;
8083 tls_clear = TLS_GD;
8084 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
8085 break;
8086
8087 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL34:
8088 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS:
8089 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
8090 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
8091 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
8092 if (ok_tprel)
8093 {
8094 /* IE -> LE */
8095 tls_set = 0;
8096 tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
8097 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
8098 break;
8099 }
8100 continue;
8101
8102 case R_PPC64_TLSLD:
8103 if (!is_local)
8104 continue;
8105 /* Fall through. */
8106 case R_PPC64_TLSGD:
8107 if (rel + 1 < relend
8108 && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
8109 {
8110 if (pass != 0
8111 && (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)
8112 != R_PPC64_PLTSEQ)
8113 && (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)
8114 != R_PPC64_PLTSEQ_NOTOC))
8115 {
8116 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info);
8117 if (!get_sym_h (&h, NULL, NULL, NULL, &locsyms,
8118 r_symndx, ibfd))
8119 goto err_free_rel;
8120 if (h != NULL)
8121 {
8122 struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
8123
8124 for (ent = h->plt.plist;
8125 ent != NULL;
8126 ent = ent->next)
8127 if (ent->addend == rel[1].r_addend)
8128 break;
8129
8130 if (ent != NULL
8131 && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
8132 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
8133 }
8134 }
8135 continue;
8136 }
8137 found_tls_get_addr_arg = 1;
8138 /* Fall through. */
8139
8140 case R_PPC64_TLS:
8141 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
8142 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
8143 if (sym_sec == NULL || sym_sec != toc)
8144 continue;
8145
8146 /* Mark this toc entry as referenced by a TLS
8147 code sequence. We can do that now in the
8148 case of R_PPC64_TLS, and after checking for
8149 tls_get_addr for the TOC16 relocs. */
8150 if (toc_ref == NULL)
8151 toc_ref
8152 = bfd_zmalloc (toc->output_section->rawsize / 8);
8153 if (toc_ref == NULL)
8154 goto err_free_rel;
8155
8156 if (h != NULL)
8157 value = h->root.u.def.value;
8158 else
8159 value = sym->st_value;
8160 value += rel->r_addend;
8161 if (value % 8 != 0)
8162 continue;
8163 BFD_ASSERT (value < toc->size
8164 && toc->output_offset % 8 == 0);
8165 toc_ref_index = (value + toc->output_offset) / 8;
8166 if (r_type == R_PPC64_TLS
8167 || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSGD
8168 || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSLD)
8169 {
8170 toc_ref[toc_ref_index] = 1;
8171 continue;
8172 }
8173
8174 if (pass != 0 && toc_ref[toc_ref_index] == 0)
8175 continue;
8176
8177 tls_set = 0;
8178 tls_clear = 0;
8179 expecting_tls_get_addr = 2;
8180 break;
8181
8182 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
8183 if (pass == 0
8184 || sec != toc
8185 || toc_ref == NULL
8186 || !toc_ref[(rel->r_offset + toc->output_offset) / 8])
8187 continue;
8188 if (ok_tprel)
8189 {
8190 /* IE -> LE */
8191 tls_set = TLS_EXPLICIT;
8192 tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
8193 break;
8194 }
8195 continue;
8196
8197 case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
8198 if (pass == 0
8199 || sec != toc
8200 || toc_ref == NULL
8201 || !toc_ref[(rel->r_offset + toc->output_offset) / 8])
8202 continue;
8203 if (rel + 1 < relend
8204 && (rel[1].r_info
8205 == ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_DTPREL64))
8206 && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset + 8)
8207 {
8208 if (ok_tprel)
8209 /* GD -> LE */
8210 tls_set = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_GD;
8211 else
8212 /* GD -> IE */
8213 tls_set = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_GD | TLS_GDIE;
8214 tls_clear = TLS_GD;
8215 }
8216 else
8217 {
8218 if (!is_local)
8219 continue;
8220
8221 /* LD -> LE */
8222 tls_set = TLS_EXPLICIT;
8223 tls_clear = TLS_LD;
8224 }
8225 break;
8226
8227 default:
8228 continue;
8229 }
8230
8231 if (pass == 0)
8232 {
8233 if (!expecting_tls_get_addr
8234 || !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
8235 continue;
8236
8237 if (rel + 1 < relend
8238 && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1,
8239 htab->tls_get_addr_fd,
8240 htab->tga_desc_fd,
8241 htab->tls_get_addr,
8242 htab->tga_desc))
8243 {
8244 if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 2)
8245 {
8246 /* Check for toc tls entries. */
8247 unsigned char *toc_tls;
8248 int retval;
8249
8250 retval = get_tls_mask (&toc_tls, NULL, NULL,
8251 &locsyms,
8252 rel, ibfd);
8253 if (retval == 0)
8254 goto err_free_rel;
8255 if (toc_tls != NULL)
8256 {
8257 if ((*toc_tls & TLS_TLS) != 0
8258 && ((*toc_tls & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0))
8259 found_tls_get_addr_arg = 1;
8260 if (retval > 1)
8261 toc_ref[toc_ref_index] = 1;
8262 }
8263 }
8264 continue;
8265 }
8266
8267 /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call. We
8268 could just mark this symbol to exclude it
8269 from tls optimization but it's safer to skip
8270 the entire optimization. */
8271 /* xgettext:c-format */
8272 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, "
8273 "TLS optimization disabled\n"),
8274 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
8275 ret = TRUE;
8276 goto err_free_rel;
8277 }
8278
8279 /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls
8280 without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't
8281 found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a
8282 marker for this symbol, then we either have a
8283 broken object file or an -mlongcall style
8284 indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker.
8285 Disable optimization in this case. */
8286 if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0
8287 && (tls_set & TLS_EXPLICIT) == 0
8288 && !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
8289 && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
8290 != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)))
8291 continue;
8292
8293 if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 1 + !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
8294 {
8295 struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
8296
8297 if (htab->tls_get_addr_fd != NULL)
8298 for (ent = htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf.plt.plist;
8299 ent != NULL;
8300 ent = ent->next)
8301 if (ent->addend == 0)
8302 break;
8303
8304 if (ent == NULL && htab->tga_desc_fd != NULL)
8305 for (ent = htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.plt.plist;
8306 ent != NULL;
8307 ent = ent->next)
8308 if (ent->addend == 0)
8309 break;
8310
8311 if (ent == NULL && htab->tls_get_addr != NULL)
8312 for (ent = htab->tls_get_addr->elf.plt.plist;
8313 ent != NULL;
8314 ent = ent->next)
8315 if (ent->addend == 0)
8316 break;
8317
8318 if (ent == NULL && htab->tga_desc != NULL)
8319 for (ent = htab->tga_desc->elf.plt.plist;
8320 ent != NULL;
8321 ent = ent->next)
8322 if (ent->addend == 0)
8323 break;
8324
8325 if (ent != NULL
8326 && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
8327 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
8328 }
8329
8330 if (tls_clear == 0)
8331 continue;
8332
8333 if ((tls_set & TLS_EXPLICIT) == 0)
8334 {
8335 struct got_entry *ent;
8336
8337 /* Adjust got entry for this reloc. */
8338 if (h != NULL)
8339 ent = h->got.glist;
8340 else
8341 ent = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd)[r_symndx];
8342
8343 for (; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
8344 if (ent->addend == rel->r_addend
8345 && ent->owner == ibfd
8346 && ent->tls_type == tls_type)
8347 break;
8348 if (ent == NULL)
8349 abort ();
8350
8351 if (tls_set == 0)
8352 {
8353 /* We managed to get rid of a got entry. */
8354 if (ent->got.refcount > 0)
8355 ent->got.refcount -= 1;
8356 }
8357 }
8358 else
8359 {
8360 /* If we got rid of a DTPMOD/DTPREL reloc pair then
8361 we'll lose one or two dyn relocs. */
8362 if (!dec_dynrel_count (rel->r_info, sec, info,
8363 NULL, h, sym))
8364 return FALSE;
8365
8366 if (tls_set == (TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_GD))
8367 {
8368 if (!dec_dynrel_count ((rel + 1)->r_info, sec, info,
8369 NULL, h, sym))
8370 return FALSE;
8371 }
8372 }
8373
8374 *tls_mask |= tls_set & 0xff;
8375 *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear;
8376 }
8377
8378 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
8379 free (relstart);
8380 }
8381
8382 if (locsyms != NULL
8383 && (elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd).contents != (unsigned char *) locsyms))
8384 {
8385 if (!info->keep_memory)
8386 free (locsyms);
8387 else
8388 elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd).contents = (unsigned char *) locsyms;
8389 }
8390 }
8391
8392 if (toc_ref != NULL)
8393 free (toc_ref);
8394 htab->do_tls_opt = 1;
8395 return TRUE;
8396 }
8397
8398 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse from ppc64_elf_edit_toc to adjust
8399 the values of any global symbols in a toc section that has been
8400 edited. Globals in toc sections should be a rarity, so this function
8401 sets a flag if any are found in toc sections other than the one just
8402 edited, so that further hash table traversals can be avoided. */
8403
8404 struct adjust_toc_info
8405 {
8406 asection *toc;
8407 unsigned long *skip;
8408 bfd_boolean global_toc_syms;
8409 };
8410
8411 enum toc_skip_enum { ref_from_discarded = 1, can_optimize = 2 };
8412
8413 static bfd_boolean
8414 adjust_toc_syms (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
8415 {
8416 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
8417 struct adjust_toc_info *toc_inf = (struct adjust_toc_info *) inf;
8418 unsigned long i;
8419
8420 if (h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
8421 && h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
8422 return TRUE;
8423
8424 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
8425 if (eh->adjust_done)
8426 return TRUE;
8427
8428 if (eh->elf.root.u.def.section == toc_inf->toc)
8429 {
8430 if (eh->elf.root.u.def.value > toc_inf->toc->rawsize)
8431 i = toc_inf->toc->rawsize >> 3;
8432 else
8433 i = eh->elf.root.u.def.value >> 3;
8434
8435 if ((toc_inf->skip[i] & (ref_from_discarded | can_optimize)) != 0)
8436 {
8437 _bfd_error_handler
8438 (_("%s defined on removed toc entry"), eh->elf.root.root.string);
8439 do
8440 ++i;
8441 while ((toc_inf->skip[i] & (ref_from_discarded | can_optimize)) != 0);
8442 eh->elf.root.u.def.value = (bfd_vma) i << 3;
8443 }
8444
8445 eh->elf.root.u.def.value -= toc_inf->skip[i];
8446 eh->adjust_done = 1;
8447 }
8448 else if (strcmp (eh->elf.root.u.def.section->name, ".toc") == 0)
8449 toc_inf->global_toc_syms = TRUE;
8450
8451 return TRUE;
8452 }
8453
8454 /* Return TRUE iff INSN with a relocation of R_TYPE is one we expect
8455 on a _LO variety toc/got reloc. */
8456
8457 static bfd_boolean
8458 ok_lo_toc_insn (unsigned int insn, enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type)
8459 {
8460 return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 12u << 26 /* addic */
8461 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
8462 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
8463 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
8464 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
8465 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
8466 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
8467 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
8468 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
8469 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
8470 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
8471 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
8472 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
8473 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
8474 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
8475 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq,lfq */
8476 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lxsd,lxssp,lfdp */
8477 /* Exclude lfqu by testing reloc. If relocs are ever
8478 defined for the reduced D field in psq_lu then those
8479 will need testing too. */
8480 && r_type != R_PPC64_TOC16_LO && r_type != R_PPC64_GOT16_LO)
8481 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,lwa */
8482 && (insn & 1) == 0)
8483 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 60u << 26 /* stfq */
8484 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* lxv,stx{v,sd,ssp},stfdp */
8485 /* Exclude stfqu. psq_stu as above for psq_lu. */
8486 && r_type != R_PPC64_TOC16_LO && r_type != R_PPC64_GOT16_LO)
8487 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stq */
8488 && (insn & 1) == 0));
8489 }
8490
8491 /* PCREL_OPT in one instance flags to the linker that a pair of insns:
8492 pld ra,symbol@got@pcrel
8493 load/store rt,off(ra)
8494 or
8495 pla ra,symbol@pcrel
8496 load/store rt,off(ra)
8497 may be translated to
8498 pload/pstore rt,symbol+off@pcrel
8499 nop.
8500 This function returns true if the optimization is possible, placing
8501 the prefix insn in *PINSN1, a NOP in *PINSN2 and the offset in *POFF.
8502
8503 On entry to this function, the linker has already determined that
8504 the pld can be replaced with pla: *PINSN1 is that pla insn,
8505 while *PINSN2 is the second instruction. */
8506
8507 static bfd_boolean
8508 xlate_pcrel_opt (uint64_t *pinsn1, uint64_t *pinsn2, bfd_signed_vma *poff)
8509 {
8510 uint64_t insn1 = *pinsn1;
8511 uint64_t insn2 = *pinsn2;
8512 bfd_signed_vma off;
8513
8514 if ((insn2 & (63ULL << 58)) == 1ULL << 58)
8515 {
8516 /* Check that regs match. */
8517 if (((insn2 >> 16) & 31) != ((insn1 >> 21) & 31))
8518 return FALSE;
8519
8520 /* P8LS or PMLS form, non-pcrel. */
8521 if ((insn2 & (-1ULL << 50) & ~(1ULL << 56)) != (1ULL << 58))
8522 return FALSE;
8523
8524 *pinsn1 = (insn2 & ~(31 << 16) & ~0x3ffff0000ffffULL) | (1ULL << 52);
8525 *pinsn2 = PNOP;
8526 off = ((insn2 >> 16) & 0x3ffff0000ULL) | (insn2 & 0xffff);
8527 *poff = (off ^ 0x200000000ULL) - 0x200000000ULL;
8528 return TRUE;
8529 }
8530
8531 insn2 >>= 32;
8532
8533 /* Check that regs match. */
8534 if (((insn2 >> 16) & 31) != ((insn1 >> 21) & 31))
8535 return FALSE;
8536
8537 switch ((insn2 >> 26) & 63)
8538 {
8539 default:
8540 return FALSE;
8541
8542 case 32: /* lwz */
8543 case 34: /* lbz */
8544 case 36: /* stw */
8545 case 38: /* stb */
8546 case 40: /* lhz */
8547 case 42: /* lha */
8548 case 44: /* sth */
8549 case 48: /* lfs */
8550 case 50: /* lfd */
8551 case 52: /* stfs */
8552 case 54: /* stfd */
8553 /* These are the PMLS cases, where we just need to tack a prefix
8554 on the insn. */
8555 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (2ULL << 56) | (1ULL << 52)
8556 | (insn2 & ((63ULL << 26) | (31ULL << 21))));
8557 off = insn2 & 0xffff;
8558 break;
8559
8560 case 58: /* lwa, ld */
8561 if ((insn2 & 1) != 0)
8562 return FALSE;
8563 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8564 | (insn2 & 2 ? 41ULL << 26 : 57ULL << 26)
8565 | (insn2 & (31ULL << 21)));
8566 off = insn2 & 0xfffc;
8567 break;
8568
8569 case 57: /* lxsd, lxssp */
8570 if ((insn2 & 3) < 2)
8571 return FALSE;
8572 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8573 | ((40ULL | (insn2 & 3)) << 26)
8574 | (insn2 & (31ULL << 21)));
8575 off = insn2 & 0xfffc;
8576 break;
8577
8578 case 61: /* stxsd, stxssp, lxv, stxv */
8579 if ((insn2 & 3) == 0)
8580 return FALSE;
8581 else if ((insn2 & 3) >= 2)
8582 {
8583 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8584 | ((44ULL | (insn2 & 3)) << 26)
8585 | (insn2 & (31ULL << 21)));
8586 off = insn2 & 0xfffc;
8587 }
8588 else
8589 {
8590 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8591 | ((50ULL | (insn2 & 4) | ((insn2 & 8) >> 3)) << 26)
8592 | (insn2 & (31ULL << 21)));
8593 off = insn2 & 0xfff0;
8594 }
8595 break;
8596
8597 case 56: /* lq */
8598 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8599 | (insn2 & ((63ULL << 26) | (31ULL << 21))));
8600 off = insn2 & 0xffff;
8601 break;
8602
8603 case 62: /* std, stq */
8604 if ((insn2 & 1) != 0)
8605 return FALSE;
8606 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8607 | ((insn2 & 2) == 0 ? 61ULL << 26 : 60ULL << 26)
8608 | (insn2 & (31ULL << 21)));
8609 off = insn2 & 0xfffc;
8610 break;
8611 }
8612
8613 *pinsn1 = insn1;
8614 *pinsn2 = (uint64_t) NOP << 32;
8615 *poff = (off ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
8616 return TRUE;
8617 }
8618
8619 /* Examine all relocs referencing .toc sections in order to remove
8620 unused .toc entries. */
8621
8622 bfd_boolean
8623 ppc64_elf_edit_toc (struct bfd_link_info *info)
8624 {
8625 bfd *ibfd;
8626 struct adjust_toc_info toc_inf;
8627 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
8628
8629 htab->do_toc_opt = 1;
8630 toc_inf.global_toc_syms = TRUE;
8631 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
8632 {
8633 asection *toc, *sec;
8634 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
8635 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
8636 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *toc_relocs;
8637 unsigned long *skip, *drop;
8638 unsigned char *used;
8639 unsigned char *keep, last, some_unused;
8640
8641 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
8642 continue;
8643
8644 toc = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".toc");
8645 if (toc == NULL
8646 || toc->size == 0
8647 || toc->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_JUST_SYMS
8648 || discarded_section (toc))
8649 continue;
8650
8651 toc_relocs = NULL;
8652 local_syms = NULL;
8653 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
8654
8655 /* Look at sections dropped from the final link. */
8656 skip = NULL;
8657 relstart = NULL;
8658 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
8659 {
8660 if (sec->reloc_count == 0
8661 || !discarded_section (sec)
8662 || get_opd_info (sec)
8663 || (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
8664 || (sec->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0)
8665 continue;
8666
8667 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL, FALSE);
8668 if (relstart == NULL)
8669 goto error_ret;
8670
8671 /* Run through the relocs to see which toc entries might be
8672 unused. */
8673 for (rel = relstart; rel < relstart + sec->reloc_count; ++rel)
8674 {
8675 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
8676 unsigned long r_symndx;
8677 asection *sym_sec;
8678 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8679 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
8680 bfd_vma val;
8681
8682 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
8683 switch (r_type)
8684 {
8685 default:
8686 continue;
8687
8688 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
8689 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
8690 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
8691 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
8692 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
8693 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
8694 break;
8695 }
8696
8697 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
8698 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
8699 r_symndx, ibfd))
8700 goto error_ret;
8701
8702 if (sym_sec != toc)
8703 continue;
8704
8705 if (h != NULL)
8706 val = h->root.u.def.value;
8707 else
8708 val = sym->st_value;
8709 val += rel->r_addend;
8710
8711 if (val >= toc->size)
8712 continue;
8713
8714 /* Anything in the toc ought to be aligned to 8 bytes.
8715 If not, don't mark as unused. */
8716 if (val & 7)
8717 continue;
8718
8719 if (skip == NULL)
8720 {
8721 skip = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (*skip) * (toc->size + 15) / 8);
8722 if (skip == NULL)
8723 goto error_ret;
8724 }
8725
8726 skip[val >> 3] = ref_from_discarded;
8727 }
8728
8729 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
8730 free (relstart);
8731 }
8732
8733 /* For largetoc loads of address constants, we can convert
8734 . addis rx,2,addr@got@ha
8735 . ld ry,addr@got@l(rx)
8736 to
8737 . addis rx,2,addr@toc@ha
8738 . addi ry,rx,addr@toc@l
8739 when addr is within 2G of the toc pointer. This then means
8740 that the word storing "addr" in the toc is no longer needed. */
8741
8742 if (!ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_small_toc_reloc
8743 && toc->output_section->rawsize < (bfd_vma) 1 << 31
8744 && toc->reloc_count != 0)
8745 {
8746 /* Read toc relocs. */
8747 toc_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, toc, NULL, NULL,
8748 info->keep_memory);
8749 if (toc_relocs == NULL)
8750 goto error_ret;
8751
8752 for (rel = toc_relocs; rel < toc_relocs + toc->reloc_count; ++rel)
8753 {
8754 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
8755 unsigned long r_symndx;
8756 asection *sym_sec;
8757 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8758 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
8759 bfd_vma val, addr;
8760
8761 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
8762 if (r_type != R_PPC64_ADDR64)
8763 continue;
8764
8765 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
8766 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
8767 r_symndx, ibfd))
8768 goto error_ret;
8769
8770 if (sym_sec == NULL
8771 || sym_sec->output_section == NULL
8772 || discarded_section (sym_sec))
8773 continue;
8774
8775 if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
8776 continue;
8777
8778 if (h != NULL)
8779 {
8780 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
8781 continue;
8782 val = h->root.u.def.value;
8783 }
8784 else
8785 {
8786 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
8787 continue;
8788 val = sym->st_value;
8789 }
8790 val += rel->r_addend;
8791 val += sym_sec->output_section->vma + sym_sec->output_offset;
8792
8793 /* We don't yet know the exact toc pointer value, but we
8794 know it will be somewhere in the toc section. Don't
8795 optimize if the difference from any possible toc
8796 pointer is outside [ff..f80008000, 7fff7fff]. */
8797 addr = toc->output_section->vma + TOC_BASE_OFF;
8798 if (val - addr + (bfd_vma) 0x80008000 >= (bfd_vma) 1 << 32)
8799 continue;
8800
8801 addr = toc->output_section->vma + toc->output_section->rawsize;
8802 if (val - addr + (bfd_vma) 0x80008000 >= (bfd_vma) 1 << 32)
8803 continue;
8804
8805 if (skip == NULL)
8806 {
8807 skip = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (*skip) * (toc->size + 15) / 8);
8808 if (skip == NULL)
8809 goto error_ret;
8810 }
8811
8812 skip[rel->r_offset >> 3]
8813 |= can_optimize | ((rel - toc_relocs) << 2);
8814 }
8815 }
8816
8817 if (skip == NULL)
8818 continue;
8819
8820 used = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (*used) * (toc->size + 7) / 8);
8821 if (used == NULL)
8822 {
8823 error_ret:
8824 if (local_syms != NULL
8825 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
8826 free (local_syms);
8827 if (sec != NULL
8828 && relstart != NULL
8829 && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
8830 free (relstart);
8831 if (toc_relocs != NULL
8832 && elf_section_data (toc)->relocs != toc_relocs)
8833 free (toc_relocs);
8834 if (skip != NULL)
8835 free (skip);
8836 return FALSE;
8837 }
8838
8839 /* Now check all kept sections that might reference the toc.
8840 Check the toc itself last. */
8841 for (sec = (ibfd->sections == toc && toc->next ? toc->next
8842 : ibfd->sections);
8843 sec != NULL;
8844 sec = (sec == toc ? NULL
8845 : sec->next == NULL ? toc
8846 : sec->next == toc && toc->next ? toc->next
8847 : sec->next))
8848 {
8849 int repeat;
8850
8851 if (sec->reloc_count == 0
8852 || discarded_section (sec)
8853 || get_opd_info (sec)
8854 || (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
8855 || (sec->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0)
8856 continue;
8857
8858 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
8859 info->keep_memory);
8860 if (relstart == NULL)
8861 {
8862 free (used);
8863 goto error_ret;
8864 }
8865
8866 /* Mark toc entries referenced as used. */
8867 do
8868 {
8869 repeat = 0;
8870 for (rel = relstart; rel < relstart + sec->reloc_count; ++rel)
8871 {
8872 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
8873 unsigned long r_symndx;
8874 asection *sym_sec;
8875 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8876 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
8877 bfd_vma val;
8878
8879 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
8880 switch (r_type)
8881 {
8882 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
8883 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
8884 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
8885 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
8886 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
8887 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
8888 /* In case we're taking addresses of toc entries. */
8889 case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
8890 break;
8891
8892 default:
8893 continue;
8894 }
8895
8896 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
8897 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
8898 r_symndx, ibfd))
8899 {
8900 free (used);
8901 goto error_ret;
8902 }
8903
8904 if (sym_sec != toc)
8905 continue;
8906
8907 if (h != NULL)
8908 val = h->root.u.def.value;
8909 else
8910 val = sym->st_value;
8911 val += rel->r_addend;
8912
8913 if (val >= toc->size)
8914 continue;
8915
8916 if ((skip[val >> 3] & can_optimize) != 0)
8917 {
8918 bfd_vma off;
8919 unsigned char opc;
8920
8921 switch (r_type)
8922 {
8923 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
8924 break;
8925
8926 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
8927 off = rel->r_offset;
8928 off += (bfd_big_endian (ibfd) ? -2 : 3);
8929 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, &opc,
8930 off, 1))
8931 {
8932 free (used);
8933 goto error_ret;
8934 }
8935 if ((opc & (0x3f << 2)) == (58u << 2))
8936 break;
8937 /* Fall through. */
8938
8939 default:
8940 /* Wrong sort of reloc, or not a ld. We may
8941 as well clear ref_from_discarded too. */
8942 skip[val >> 3] = 0;
8943 }
8944 }
8945
8946 if (sec != toc)
8947 used[val >> 3] = 1;
8948 /* For the toc section, we only mark as used if this
8949 entry itself isn't unused. */
8950 else if ((used[rel->r_offset >> 3]
8951 || !(skip[rel->r_offset >> 3] & ref_from_discarded))
8952 && !used[val >> 3])
8953 {
8954 /* Do all the relocs again, to catch reference
8955 chains. */
8956 repeat = 1;
8957 used[val >> 3] = 1;
8958 }
8959 }
8960 }
8961 while (repeat);
8962
8963 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
8964 free (relstart);
8965 }
8966
8967 /* Merge the used and skip arrays. Assume that TOC
8968 doublewords not appearing as either used or unused belong
8969 to an entry more than one doubleword in size. */
8970 for (drop = skip, keep = used, last = 0, some_unused = 0;
8971 drop < skip + (toc->size + 7) / 8;
8972 ++drop, ++keep)
8973 {
8974 if (*keep)
8975 {
8976 *drop &= ~ref_from_discarded;
8977 if ((*drop & can_optimize) != 0)
8978 some_unused = 1;
8979 last = 0;
8980 }
8981 else if ((*drop & ref_from_discarded) != 0)
8982 {
8983 some_unused = 1;
8984 last = ref_from_discarded;
8985 }
8986 else
8987 *drop = last;
8988 }
8989
8990 free (used);
8991
8992 if (some_unused)
8993 {
8994 bfd_byte *contents, *src;
8995 unsigned long off;
8996 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
8997 bfd_boolean local_toc_syms = FALSE;
8998
8999 /* Shuffle the toc contents, and at the same time convert the
9000 skip array from booleans into offsets. */
9001 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (ibfd, toc, &contents))
9002 goto error_ret;
9003
9004 elf_section_data (toc)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
9005
9006 for (src = contents, off = 0, drop = skip;
9007 src < contents + toc->size;
9008 src += 8, ++drop)
9009 {
9010 if ((*drop & (can_optimize | ref_from_discarded)) != 0)
9011 off += 8;
9012 else if (off != 0)
9013 {
9014 *drop = off;
9015 memcpy (src - off, src, 8);
9016 }
9017 }
9018 *drop = off;
9019 toc->rawsize = toc->size;
9020 toc->size = src - contents - off;
9021
9022 /* Adjust addends for relocs against the toc section sym,
9023 and optimize any accesses we can. */
9024 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
9025 {
9026 if (sec->reloc_count == 0
9027 || discarded_section (sec))
9028 continue;
9029
9030 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
9031 info->keep_memory);
9032 if (relstart == NULL)
9033 goto error_ret;
9034
9035 for (rel = relstart; rel < relstart + sec->reloc_count; ++rel)
9036 {
9037 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
9038 unsigned long r_symndx;
9039 asection *sym_sec;
9040 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9041 bfd_vma val;
9042
9043 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
9044 switch (r_type)
9045 {
9046 default:
9047 continue;
9048
9049 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
9050 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
9051 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
9052 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
9053 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
9054 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
9055 case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
9056 break;
9057 }
9058
9059 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
9060 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
9061 r_symndx, ibfd))
9062 goto error_ret;
9063
9064 if (sym_sec != toc)
9065 continue;
9066
9067 if (h != NULL)
9068 val = h->root.u.def.value;
9069 else
9070 {
9071 val = sym->st_value;
9072 if (val != 0)
9073 local_toc_syms = TRUE;
9074 }
9075
9076 val += rel->r_addend;
9077
9078 if (val > toc->rawsize)
9079 val = toc->rawsize;
9080 else if ((skip[val >> 3] & ref_from_discarded) != 0)
9081 continue;
9082 else if ((skip[val >> 3] & can_optimize) != 0)
9083 {
9084 Elf_Internal_Rela *tocrel
9085 = toc_relocs + (skip[val >> 3] >> 2);
9086 unsigned long tsym = ELF64_R_SYM (tocrel->r_info);
9087
9088 switch (r_type)
9089 {
9090 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
9091 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (tsym, R_PPC64_TOC16_HA);
9092 break;
9093
9094 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
9095 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (tsym, R_PPC64_LO_DS_OPT);
9096 break;
9097
9098 default:
9099 if (!ppc64_elf_howto_table[R_PPC64_ADDR32])
9100 ppc_howto_init ();
9101 info->callbacks->einfo
9102 /* xgettext:c-format */
9103 (_("%H: %s references "
9104 "optimized away TOC entry\n"),
9105 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset,
9106 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
9107 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
9108 goto error_ret;
9109 }
9110 rel->r_addend = tocrel->r_addend;
9111 elf_section_data (sec)->relocs = relstart;
9112 continue;
9113 }
9114
9115 if (h != NULL || sym->st_value != 0)
9116 continue;
9117
9118 rel->r_addend -= skip[val >> 3];
9119 elf_section_data (sec)->relocs = relstart;
9120 }
9121
9122 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
9123 free (relstart);
9124 }
9125
9126 /* We shouldn't have local or global symbols defined in the TOC,
9127 but handle them anyway. */
9128 if (local_syms != NULL)
9129 for (sym = local_syms;
9130 sym < local_syms + symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9131 ++sym)
9132 if (sym->st_value != 0
9133 && bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx) == toc)
9134 {
9135 unsigned long i;
9136
9137 if (sym->st_value > toc->rawsize)
9138 i = toc->rawsize >> 3;
9139 else
9140 i = sym->st_value >> 3;
9141
9142 if ((skip[i] & (ref_from_discarded | can_optimize)) != 0)
9143 {
9144 if (local_toc_syms)
9145 _bfd_error_handler
9146 (_("%s defined on removed toc entry"),
9147 bfd_elf_sym_name (ibfd, symtab_hdr, sym, NULL));
9148 do
9149 ++i;
9150 while ((skip[i] & (ref_from_discarded | can_optimize)));
9151 sym->st_value = (bfd_vma) i << 3;
9152 }
9153
9154 sym->st_value -= skip[i];
9155 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9156 }
9157
9158 /* Adjust any global syms defined in this toc input section. */
9159 if (toc_inf.global_toc_syms)
9160 {
9161 toc_inf.toc = toc;
9162 toc_inf.skip = skip;
9163 toc_inf.global_toc_syms = FALSE;
9164 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), adjust_toc_syms,
9165 &toc_inf);
9166 }
9167
9168 if (toc->reloc_count != 0)
9169 {
9170 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
9171 Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
9172 bfd_size_type sz;
9173
9174 /* Remove unused toc relocs, and adjust those we keep. */
9175 if (toc_relocs == NULL)
9176 toc_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, toc, NULL, NULL,
9177 info->keep_memory);
9178 if (toc_relocs == NULL)
9179 goto error_ret;
9180
9181 wrel = toc_relocs;
9182 for (rel = toc_relocs; rel < toc_relocs + toc->reloc_count; ++rel)
9183 if ((skip[rel->r_offset >> 3]
9184 & (ref_from_discarded | can_optimize)) == 0)
9185 {
9186 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset - skip[rel->r_offset >> 3];
9187 wrel->r_info = rel->r_info;
9188 wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend;
9189 ++wrel;
9190 }
9191 else if (!dec_dynrel_count (rel->r_info, toc, info,
9192 &local_syms, NULL, NULL))
9193 goto error_ret;
9194
9195 elf_section_data (toc)->relocs = toc_relocs;
9196 toc->reloc_count = wrel - toc_relocs;
9197 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (toc);
9198 sz = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
9199 rel_hdr->sh_size = toc->reloc_count * sz;
9200 }
9201 }
9202 else if (toc_relocs != NULL
9203 && elf_section_data (toc)->relocs != toc_relocs)
9204 free (toc_relocs);
9205
9206 if (local_syms != NULL
9207 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9208 {
9209 if (!info->keep_memory)
9210 free (local_syms);
9211 else
9212 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9213 }
9214 free (skip);
9215 }
9216
9217 /* Look for cases where we can change an indirect GOT access to
9218 a GOT relative or PC relative access, possibly reducing the
9219 number of GOT entries. */
9220 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9221 {
9222 asection *sec;
9223 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9224 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
9225 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel;
9226 bfd_vma got;
9227
9228 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
9229 continue;
9230
9231 if (!ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_optrel)
9232 continue;
9233
9234 sec = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
9235 got = 0;
9236 if (sec != NULL)
9237 got = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + 0x8000;
9238
9239 local_syms = NULL;
9240 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
9241
9242 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
9243 {
9244 if (sec->reloc_count == 0
9245 || !ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->has_optrel
9246 || discarded_section (sec))
9247 continue;
9248
9249 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
9250 info->keep_memory);
9251 if (relstart == NULL)
9252 {
9253 got_error_ret:
9254 if (local_syms != NULL
9255 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9256 free (local_syms);
9257 if (sec != NULL
9258 && relstart != NULL
9259 && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
9260 free (relstart);
9261 return FALSE;
9262 }
9263
9264 for (rel = relstart; rel < relstart + sec->reloc_count; ++rel)
9265 {
9266 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
9267 unsigned long r_symndx;
9268 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
9269 asection *sym_sec;
9270 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9271 struct got_entry *ent;
9272 bfd_vma val, pc;
9273 unsigned char buf[8];
9274 unsigned int insn;
9275 enum {no_check, check_lo, check_ha} insn_check;
9276
9277 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
9278 switch (r_type)
9279 {
9280 default:
9281 insn_check = no_check;
9282 break;
9283
9284 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
9285 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
9286 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
9287 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
9288 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
9289 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
9290 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
9291 insn_check = check_ha;
9292 break;
9293
9294 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO:
9295 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
9296 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
9297 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
9298 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
9299 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
9300 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO:
9301 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
9302 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
9303 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
9304 insn_check = check_lo;
9305 break;
9306 }
9307
9308 if (insn_check != no_check)
9309 {
9310 bfd_vma off = rel->r_offset & ~3;
9311
9312 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf, off, 4))
9313 goto got_error_ret;
9314
9315 insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
9316 if (insn_check == check_lo
9317 ? !ok_lo_toc_insn (insn, r_type)
9318 : ((insn & ((0x3fu << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
9319 != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)) /* addis rt,2,imm */))
9320 {
9321 char str[12];
9322
9323 ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->unexpected_toc_insn = 1;
9324 sprintf (str, "%#08x", insn);
9325 info->callbacks->einfo
9326 /* xgettext:c-format */
9327 (_("%H: got/toc optimization is not supported for"
9328 " %s instruction\n"),
9329 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset & ~3, str);
9330 continue;
9331 }
9332 }
9333
9334 switch (r_type)
9335 {
9336 /* Note that we don't delete GOT entries for
9337 R_PPC64_GOT16_DS since we'd need a lot more
9338 analysis. For starters, the preliminary layout is
9339 before the GOT, PLT, dynamic sections and stubs are
9340 laid out. Then we'd need to allow for changes in
9341 distance between sections caused by alignment. */
9342 default:
9343 continue;
9344
9345 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
9346 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
9347 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
9348 break;
9349 }
9350
9351 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
9352 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
9353 r_symndx, ibfd))
9354 goto got_error_ret;
9355
9356 if (sym_sec == NULL
9357 || sym_sec->output_section == NULL
9358 || discarded_section (sym_sec))
9359 continue;
9360
9361 if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
9362 continue;
9363
9364 if (h != NULL)
9365 val = h->root.u.def.value;
9366 else
9367 val = sym->st_value;
9368 val += rel->r_addend;
9369 val += sym_sec->output_section->vma + sym_sec->output_offset;
9370
9371 /* Fudge factor to allow for the fact that the preliminary layout
9372 isn't exact. Reduce limits by this factor. */
9373 #define LIMIT_ADJUST(LIMIT) ((LIMIT) - (LIMIT) / 16)
9374
9375 switch (r_type)
9376 {
9377 default:
9378 continue;
9379
9380 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
9381 if (val - got + LIMIT_ADJUST (0x80008000ULL)
9382 >= LIMIT_ADJUST (0x100000000ULL))
9383 continue;
9384
9385 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf,
9386 rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
9387 goto got_error_ret;
9388 insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
9389 if (((insn & ((0x3fu << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
9390 != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)) /* addis rt,2,imm */))
9391 continue;
9392 break;
9393
9394 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
9395 if (val - got + LIMIT_ADJUST (0x80008000ULL)
9396 >= LIMIT_ADJUST (0x100000000ULL))
9397 continue;
9398 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf,
9399 rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
9400 goto got_error_ret;
9401 insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
9402 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26 | 0x3)) != 58u << 26 /* ld */)
9403 continue;
9404 break;
9405
9406 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
9407 pc = rel->r_offset;
9408 pc += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
9409 if (val - pc + LIMIT_ADJUST (1ULL << 33)
9410 >= LIMIT_ADJUST (1ULL << 34))
9411 continue;
9412 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf,
9413 rel->r_offset & ~3, 8))
9414 goto got_error_ret;
9415 insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
9416 if ((insn & (-1u << 18)) != ((1u << 26) | (1u << 20)))
9417 continue;
9418 insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf + 4);
9419 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) != 57u << 26)
9420 continue;
9421 break;
9422 }
9423 #undef LIMIT_ADJUST
9424
9425 if (h != NULL)
9426 ent = h->got.glist;
9427 else
9428 {
9429 struct got_entry **local_got_ents = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd);
9430 ent = local_got_ents[r_symndx];
9431 }
9432 for (; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9433 if (ent->addend == rel->r_addend
9434 && ent->owner == ibfd
9435 && ent->tls_type == 0)
9436 break;
9437 BFD_ASSERT (ent && ent->got.refcount > 0);
9438 ent->got.refcount -= 1;
9439 }
9440
9441 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
9442 free (relstart);
9443 }
9444
9445 if (local_syms != NULL
9446 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9447 {
9448 if (!info->keep_memory)
9449 free (local_syms);
9450 else
9451 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9452 }
9453 }
9454
9455 return TRUE;
9456 }
9457
9458 /* Return true iff input section I references the TOC using
9459 instructions limited to +/-32k offsets. */
9460
9461 bfd_boolean
9462 ppc64_elf_has_small_toc_reloc (asection *i)
9463 {
9464 return (is_ppc64_elf (i->owner)
9465 && ppc64_elf_tdata (i->owner)->has_small_toc_reloc);
9466 }
9467
9468 /* Allocate space for one GOT entry. */
9469
9470 static void
9471 allocate_got (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9472 struct bfd_link_info *info,
9473 struct got_entry *gent)
9474 {
9475 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
9476 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
9477 int entsize = (gent->tls_type & eh->tls_mask & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)
9478 ? 16 : 8);
9479 int rentsize = (gent->tls_type & eh->tls_mask & TLS_GD
9480 ? 2 : 1) * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
9481 asection *got = ppc64_elf_tdata (gent->owner)->got;
9482
9483 gent->got.offset = got->size;
9484 got->size += entsize;
9485
9486 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9487 {
9488 htab->elf.irelplt->size += rentsize;
9489 htab->got_reli_size += rentsize;
9490 }
9491 else if (((bfd_link_pic (info)
9492 && !(gent->tls_type != 0
9493 && bfd_link_executable (info)
9494 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)))
9495 || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9496 && h->dynindx != -1
9497 && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)))
9498 && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
9499 {
9500 asection *relgot = ppc64_elf_tdata (gent->owner)->relgot;
9501 relgot->size += rentsize;
9502 }
9503 }
9504
9505 /* This function merges got entries in the same toc group. */
9506
9507 static void
9508 merge_got_entries (struct got_entry **pent)
9509 {
9510 struct got_entry *ent, *ent2;
9511
9512 for (ent = *pent; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9513 if (!ent->is_indirect)
9514 for (ent2 = ent->next; ent2 != NULL; ent2 = ent2->next)
9515 if (!ent2->is_indirect
9516 && ent2->addend == ent->addend
9517 && ent2->tls_type == ent->tls_type
9518 && elf_gp (ent2->owner) == elf_gp (ent->owner))
9519 {
9520 ent2->is_indirect = TRUE;
9521 ent2->got.ent = ent;
9522 }
9523 }
9524
9525 /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense. */
9526
9527 static bfd_boolean
9528 ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info,
9529 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
9530 {
9531 struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
9532
9533 if (htab->dynamic_sections_created
9534 && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0
9535 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
9536 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
9537 && h->dynindx == -1
9538 && !h->forced_local
9539 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
9540 return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h);
9541 return TRUE;
9542 }
9543
9544 /* Allocate space in .plt, .got and associated reloc sections for
9545 dynamic relocs. */
9546
9547 static bfd_boolean
9548 allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9549 {
9550 struct bfd_link_info *info;
9551 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
9552 asection *s;
9553 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
9554 struct got_entry **pgent, *gent;
9555
9556 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
9557 return TRUE;
9558
9559 info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
9560 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
9561 if (htab == NULL)
9562 return FALSE;
9563
9564 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
9565 /* Run through the TLS GD got entries first if we're changing them
9566 to TPREL. */
9567 if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE))
9568 for (gent = h->got.glist; gent != NULL; gent = gent->next)
9569 if (gent->got.refcount > 0
9570 && (gent->tls_type & TLS_GD) != 0)
9571 {
9572 /* This was a GD entry that has been converted to TPREL. If
9573 there happens to be a TPREL entry we can use that one. */
9574 struct got_entry *ent;
9575 for (ent = h->got.glist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9576 if (ent->got.refcount > 0
9577 && (ent->tls_type & TLS_TPREL) != 0
9578 && ent->addend == gent->addend
9579 && ent->owner == gent->owner)
9580 {
9581 gent->got.refcount = 0;
9582 break;
9583 }
9584
9585 /* If not, then we'll be using our own TPREL entry. */
9586 if (gent->got.refcount != 0)
9587 gent->tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
9588 }
9589
9590 /* Remove any list entry that won't generate a word in the GOT before
9591 we call merge_got_entries. Otherwise we risk merging to empty
9592 entries. */
9593 pgent = &h->got.glist;
9594 while ((gent = *pgent) != NULL)
9595 if (gent->got.refcount > 0)
9596 {
9597 if ((gent->tls_type & TLS_LD) != 0
9598 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
9599 {
9600 ppc64_tlsld_got (gent->owner)->got.refcount += 1;
9601 *pgent = gent->next;
9602 }
9603 else
9604 pgent = &gent->next;
9605 }
9606 else
9607 *pgent = gent->next;
9608
9609 if (!htab->do_multi_toc)
9610 merge_got_entries (&h->got.glist);
9611
9612 for (gent = h->got.glist; gent != NULL; gent = gent->next)
9613 if (!gent->is_indirect)
9614 {
9615 /* Ensure we catch all the cases where this symbol should
9616 be made dynamic. */
9617 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
9618 return FALSE;
9619
9620 if (!is_ppc64_elf (gent->owner))
9621 abort ();
9622
9623 allocate_got (h, info, gent);
9624 }
9625
9626 /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for
9627 IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables. */
9628 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9629 && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9630 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
9631
9632 /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local. */
9633 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
9634 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
9635 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
9636
9637 /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
9638 visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so. */
9639 else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
9640 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
9641
9642 if (eh->dyn_relocs != NULL)
9643 {
9644 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p, **pp;
9645
9646 /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
9647 dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to
9648 be defined in regular objects. For the normal shared case,
9649 discard space for relocs that have become local due to symbol
9650 visibility changes. */
9651 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9652 {
9653 /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call
9654 insn, or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that
9655 can be generated via assembly. We want calls to
9656 protected symbols to resolve directly to the function
9657 rather than going via the plt. If people want function
9658 pointer comparisons to work as expected then they should
9659 avoid writing weird assembly. */
9660 if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
9661 {
9662 for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
9663 {
9664 p->count -= p->pc_count;
9665 p->pc_count = 0;
9666 if (p->count == 0)
9667 *pp = p->next;
9668 else
9669 pp = &p->next;
9670 }
9671 }
9672
9673 if (eh->dyn_relocs != NULL)
9674 {
9675 /* Ensure we catch all the cases where this symbol
9676 should be made dynamic. */
9677 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
9678 return FALSE;
9679 }
9680 }
9681
9682 /* For a fixed position executable, discard space for
9683 relocs against symbols which are not dynamic. */
9684 else if (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9685 {
9686 if (h->dynamic_adjusted
9687 && !h->def_regular
9688 && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h))
9689 {
9690 /* Ensure we catch all the cases where this symbol
9691 should be made dynamic. */
9692 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
9693 return FALSE;
9694
9695 /* But if that didn't work out, discard dynamic relocs. */
9696 if (h->dynindx == -1)
9697 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
9698 }
9699 else
9700 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
9701 }
9702
9703 /* Finally, allocate space. */
9704 for (p = eh->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
9705 {
9706 asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
9707 if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9708 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
9709 sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
9710 }
9711 }
9712
9713 /* We might need a PLT entry when the symbol
9714 a) is dynamic, or
9715 b) is an ifunc, or
9716 c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or
9717 d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically. */
9718 if ((htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1)
9719 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
9720 || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted)
9721 || (h->needs_plt
9722 && h->def_regular
9723 && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9724 && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
9725 && (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
9726 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP))
9727 {
9728 struct plt_entry *pent;
9729 bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
9730 for (pent = h->plt.plist; pent != NULL; pent = pent->next)
9731 if (pent->plt.refcount > 0)
9732 {
9733 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9734 || h->dynindx == -1)
9735 {
9736 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9737 {
9738 s = htab->elf.iplt;
9739 pent->plt.offset = s->size;
9740 s->size += PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
9741 s = htab->elf.irelplt;
9742 }
9743 else
9744 {
9745 s = htab->pltlocal;
9746 pent->plt.offset = s->size;
9747 s->size += LOCAL_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
9748 s = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
9749 }
9750 }
9751 else
9752 {
9753 /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room for the special
9754 first entry. */
9755 s = htab->elf.splt;
9756 if (s->size == 0)
9757 s->size += PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
9758
9759 pent->plt.offset = s->size;
9760
9761 /* Make room for this entry. */
9762 s->size += PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
9763
9764 /* Make room for the .glink code. */
9765 s = htab->glink;
9766 if (s->size == 0)
9767 s->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE (htab);
9768 if (htab->opd_abi)
9769 {
9770 /* We need bigger stubs past index 32767. */
9771 if (s->size >= GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE (htab) + 32768*2*4)
9772 s->size += 4;
9773 s->size += 2*4;
9774 }
9775 else
9776 s->size += 4;
9777
9778 /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section. */
9779 s = htab->elf.srelplt;
9780 }
9781 if (s != NULL)
9782 s->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
9783 doneone = TRUE;
9784 }
9785 else
9786 pent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
9787 if (!doneone)
9788 {
9789 h->plt.plist = NULL;
9790 h->needs_plt = 0;
9791 }
9792 }
9793 else
9794 {
9795 h->plt.plist = NULL;
9796 h->needs_plt = 0;
9797 }
9798
9799 return TRUE;
9800 }
9801
9802 #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff)
9803 #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff)
9804 #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000)
9805 #define D34(v) \
9806 ((((v) & 0x3ffff0000ULL) << 16) | (v & 0xffff))
9807 #define HA34(v) ((v + (1ULL << 33)) >> 34)
9808
9809 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse from ppc64_elf_size_dynamic_sections
9810 to set up space for global entry stubs. These are put in glink,
9811 after the branch table. */
9812
9813 static bfd_boolean
9814 size_global_entry_stubs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9815 {
9816 struct bfd_link_info *info;
9817 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
9818 struct plt_entry *pent;
9819 asection *s, *plt;
9820
9821 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
9822 return TRUE;
9823
9824 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
9825 return TRUE;
9826
9827 if (h->def_regular)
9828 return TRUE;
9829
9830 info = inf;
9831 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
9832 if (htab == NULL)
9833 return FALSE;
9834
9835 s = htab->global_entry;
9836 plt = htab->elf.splt;
9837 for (pent = h->plt.plist; pent != NULL; pent = pent->next)
9838 if (pent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1
9839 && pent->addend == 0)
9840 {
9841 /* For ELFv2, if this symbol is not defined in a regular file
9842 and we are not generating a shared library or pie, then we
9843 need to define the symbol in the executable on a call stub.
9844 This is to avoid text relocations. */
9845 bfd_vma off, stub_align, stub_off, stub_size;
9846 unsigned int align_power;
9847
9848 stub_size = 16;
9849 stub_off = s->size;
9850 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align >= 0)
9851 align_power = htab->params->plt_stub_align;
9852 else
9853 align_power = -htab->params->plt_stub_align;
9854 /* Setting section alignment is delayed until we know it is
9855 non-empty. Otherwise the .text output section will be
9856 aligned at least to plt_stub_align even when no global
9857 entry stubs are needed. */
9858 if (s->alignment_power < align_power)
9859 s->alignment_power = align_power;
9860 stub_align = (bfd_vma) 1 << align_power;
9861 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align >= 0
9862 || ((((stub_off + stub_size - 1) & -stub_align)
9863 - (stub_off & -stub_align))
9864 > ((stub_size - 1) & -stub_align)))
9865 stub_off = (stub_off + stub_align - 1) & -stub_align;
9866 off = pent->plt.offset + plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
9867 off -= stub_off + s->output_offset + s->output_section->vma;
9868 /* Note that for --plt-stub-align negative we have a possible
9869 dependency between stub offset and size. Break that
9870 dependency by assuming the max stub size when calculating
9871 the stub offset. */
9872 if (PPC_HA (off) == 0)
9873 stub_size -= 4;
9874 h->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
9875 h->root.u.def.section = s;
9876 h->root.u.def.value = stub_off;
9877 s->size = stub_off + stub_size;
9878 break;
9879 }
9880 return TRUE;
9881 }
9882
9883 /* Set DF_TEXTREL if we find any dynamic relocs that apply to
9884 read-only sections. */
9885
9886 static bfd_boolean
9887 maybe_set_textrel (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9888 {
9889 asection *sec;
9890
9891 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
9892 return TRUE;
9893
9894 sec = readonly_dynrelocs (h);
9895 if (sec != NULL)
9896 {
9897 struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
9898
9899 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
9900 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%pB: dynamic relocation against `%pT'"
9901 " in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
9902 sec->owner, h->root.root.string, sec);
9903
9904 /* Not an error, just cut short the traversal. */
9905 return FALSE;
9906 }
9907 return TRUE;
9908 }
9909
9910 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
9911
9912 static bfd_boolean
9913 ppc64_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
9914 struct bfd_link_info *info)
9915 {
9916 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
9917 bfd *dynobj;
9918 asection *s;
9919 bfd_boolean relocs;
9920 bfd *ibfd;
9921 struct got_entry *first_tlsld;
9922
9923 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
9924 if (htab == NULL)
9925 return FALSE;
9926
9927 dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
9928 if (dynobj == NULL)
9929 abort ();
9930
9931 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
9932 {
9933 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
9934 if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
9935 {
9936 s = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".interp");
9937 if (s == NULL)
9938 abort ();
9939 s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
9940 s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
9941 }
9942 }
9943
9944 /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
9945 relocs. */
9946 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9947 {
9948 struct got_entry **lgot_ents;
9949 struct got_entry **end_lgot_ents;
9950 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
9951 struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
9952 unsigned char *lgot_masks;
9953 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
9954 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9955
9956 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
9957 continue;
9958
9959 for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
9960 {
9961 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
9962
9963 for (p = elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel; p != NULL; p = p->next)
9964 {
9965 if (!bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec)
9966 && bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec->output_section))
9967 {
9968 /* Input section has been discarded, either because
9969 it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
9970 linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
9971 the relocs too. */
9972 }
9973 else if (p->count != 0)
9974 {
9975 asection *srel = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
9976 if (p->ifunc)
9977 srel = htab->elf.irelplt;
9978 srel->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
9979 if ((p->sec->output_section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
9980 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
9981 }
9982 }
9983 }
9984
9985 lgot_ents = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd);
9986 if (!lgot_ents)
9987 continue;
9988
9989 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
9990 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9991 end_lgot_ents = lgot_ents + locsymcount;
9992 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_lgot_ents;
9993 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
9994 lgot_masks = (unsigned char *) end_local_plt;
9995 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
9996 for (; lgot_ents < end_lgot_ents; ++lgot_ents, ++lgot_masks)
9997 {
9998 struct got_entry **pent, *ent;
9999
10000 pent = lgot_ents;
10001 while ((ent = *pent) != NULL)
10002 if (ent->got.refcount > 0)
10003 {
10004 if ((ent->tls_type & *lgot_masks & TLS_LD) != 0)
10005 {
10006 ppc64_tlsld_got (ibfd)->got.refcount += 1;
10007 *pent = ent->next;
10008 }
10009 else
10010 {
10011 unsigned int ent_size = 8;
10012 unsigned int rel_size = sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
10013
10014 ent->got.offset = s->size;
10015 if ((ent->tls_type & *lgot_masks & TLS_GD) != 0)
10016 {
10017 ent_size *= 2;
10018 rel_size *= 2;
10019 }
10020 s->size += ent_size;
10021 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
10022 {
10023 htab->elf.irelplt->size += rel_size;
10024 htab->got_reli_size += rel_size;
10025 }
10026 else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
10027 && !(ent->tls_type != 0
10028 && bfd_link_executable (info)))
10029 {
10030 asection *srel = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
10031 srel->size += rel_size;
10032 }
10033 pent = &ent->next;
10034 }
10035 }
10036 else
10037 *pent = ent->next;
10038 }
10039
10040 /* Allocate space for plt calls to local syms. */
10041 lgot_masks = (unsigned char *) end_local_plt;
10042 for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks)
10043 {
10044 struct plt_entry *ent;
10045
10046 for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
10047 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
10048 {
10049 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
10050 {
10051 s = htab->elf.iplt;
10052 ent->plt.offset = s->size;
10053 s->size += PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
10054 htab->elf.irelplt->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
10055 }
10056 else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
10057 || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)
10058 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
10059 else
10060 {
10061 s = htab->pltlocal;
10062 ent->plt.offset = s->size;
10063 s->size += LOCAL_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
10064 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
10065 htab->relpltlocal->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
10066 }
10067 }
10068 else
10069 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
10070 }
10071 }
10072
10073 /* Allocate global sym .plt and .got entries, and space for global
10074 sym dynamic relocs. */
10075 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, allocate_dynrelocs, info);
10076
10077 if (!htab->opd_abi && !bfd_link_pic (info))
10078 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, size_global_entry_stubs, info);
10079
10080 first_tlsld = NULL;
10081 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
10082 {
10083 struct got_entry *ent;
10084
10085 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
10086 continue;
10087
10088 ent = ppc64_tlsld_got (ibfd);
10089 if (ent->got.refcount > 0)
10090 {
10091 if (!htab->do_multi_toc && first_tlsld != NULL)
10092 {
10093 ent->is_indirect = TRUE;
10094 ent->got.ent = first_tlsld;
10095 }
10096 else
10097 {
10098 if (first_tlsld == NULL)
10099 first_tlsld = ent;
10100 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
10101 ent->got.offset = s->size;
10102 ent->owner = ibfd;
10103 s->size += 16;
10104 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
10105 {
10106 asection *srel = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
10107 srel->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
10108 }
10109 }
10110 }
10111 else
10112 ent->got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
10113 }
10114
10115 /* We now have determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
10116 Allocate memory for them. */
10117 relocs = FALSE;
10118 for (s = dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
10119 {
10120 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
10121 continue;
10122
10123 if (s == htab->brlt || s == htab->relbrlt)
10124 /* These haven't been allocated yet; don't strip. */
10125 continue;
10126 else if (s == htab->elf.sgot
10127 || s == htab->elf.splt
10128 || s == htab->elf.iplt
10129 || s == htab->pltlocal
10130 || s == htab->glink
10131 || s == htab->global_entry
10132 || s == htab->elf.sdynbss
10133 || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
10134 {
10135 /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
10136 comment below. */
10137 }
10138 else if (s == htab->glink_eh_frame)
10139 {
10140 if (!bfd_is_abs_section (s->output_section))
10141 /* Not sized yet. */
10142 continue;
10143 }
10144 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".rela"))
10145 {
10146 if (s->size != 0)
10147 {
10148 if (s != htab->elf.srelplt)
10149 relocs = TRUE;
10150
10151 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
10152 to copy relocs into the output file. */
10153 s->reloc_count = 0;
10154 }
10155 }
10156 else
10157 {
10158 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
10159 continue;
10160 }
10161
10162 if (s->size == 0)
10163 {
10164 /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
10165 output file. This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
10166 .rela.plt. We must create both sections in
10167 create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
10168 before the linker maps input sections to output
10169 sections. The linker does that before
10170 adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
10171 function which decides whether anything needs to go
10172 into these sections. */
10173 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
10174 continue;
10175 }
10176
10177 if (bfd_is_abs_section (s->output_section))
10178 _bfd_error_handler (_("warning: discarding dynamic section %s"),
10179 s->name);
10180
10181 if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
10182 continue;
10183
10184 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. We use bfd_zalloc
10185 here in case unused entries are not reclaimed before the
10186 section's contents are written out. This should not happen,
10187 but this way if it does we get a R_PPC64_NONE reloc in .rela
10188 sections instead of garbage.
10189 We also rely on the section contents being zero when writing
10190 the GOT and .dynrelro. */
10191 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (dynobj, s->size);
10192 if (s->contents == NULL)
10193 return FALSE;
10194 }
10195
10196 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
10197 {
10198 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
10199 continue;
10200
10201 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
10202 if (s != NULL && s != htab->elf.sgot)
10203 {
10204 if (s->size == 0)
10205 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
10206 else
10207 {
10208 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (ibfd, s->size);
10209 if (s->contents == NULL)
10210 return FALSE;
10211 }
10212 }
10213 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
10214 if (s != NULL)
10215 {
10216 if (s->size == 0)
10217 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
10218 else
10219 {
10220 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (ibfd, s->size);
10221 if (s->contents == NULL)
10222 return FALSE;
10223 relocs = TRUE;
10224 s->reloc_count = 0;
10225 }
10226 }
10227 }
10228
10229 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
10230 {
10231 bfd_boolean tls_opt;
10232
10233 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
10234 values later, in ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
10235 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
10236 the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
10237 dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */
10238 #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
10239 _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
10240
10241 if (bfd_link_executable (info))
10242 {
10243 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_DEBUG, 0))
10244 return FALSE;
10245 }
10246
10247 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL && htab->elf.splt->size != 0)
10248 {
10249 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTGOT, 0)
10250 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTRELSZ, 0)
10251 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTREL, DT_RELA)
10252 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_JMPREL, 0)
10253 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC64_GLINK, 0))
10254 return FALSE;
10255 }
10256
10257 if (NO_OPD_RELOCS && abiversion (output_bfd) <= 1)
10258 {
10259 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC64_OPD, 0)
10260 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC64_OPDSZ, 0))
10261 return FALSE;
10262 }
10263
10264 tls_opt = (htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt
10265 && ((htab->tls_get_addr_fd != NULL
10266 && htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
10267 || (htab->tga_desc_fd != NULL
10268 && htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.plt.plist != NULL)));
10269 if (tls_opt || !htab->opd_abi)
10270 {
10271 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC64_OPT, tls_opt ? PPC64_OPT_TLS : 0))
10272 return FALSE;
10273 }
10274
10275 if (relocs)
10276 {
10277 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELA, 0)
10278 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELASZ, 0)
10279 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELAENT, sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela)))
10280 return FALSE;
10281
10282 /* If any dynamic relocs apply to a read-only section,
10283 then we need a DT_TEXTREL entry. */
10284 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) == 0)
10285 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, maybe_set_textrel, info);
10286
10287 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
10288 {
10289 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_TEXTREL, 0))
10290 return FALSE;
10291 }
10292 }
10293 }
10294 #undef add_dynamic_entry
10295
10296 return TRUE;
10297 }
10298
10299 /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section. */
10300
10301 static bfd_boolean
10302 ppc64_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
10303 {
10304 if (h->plt.plist != NULL
10305 && !h->def_regular
10306 && !h->pointer_equality_needed)
10307 return FALSE;
10308
10309 return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
10310 }
10311
10312 /* Determine the type of stub needed, if any, for a call. */
10313
10314 static inline enum ppc_stub_type
10315 ppc_type_of_stub (asection *input_sec,
10316 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
10317 struct ppc_link_hash_entry **hash,
10318 struct plt_entry **plt_ent,
10319 bfd_vma destination,
10320 unsigned long local_off)
10321 {
10322 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h = *hash;
10323 bfd_vma location;
10324 bfd_vma branch_offset;
10325 bfd_vma max_branch_offset;
10326 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
10327
10328 if (h != NULL)
10329 {
10330 struct plt_entry *ent;
10331 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh = h;
10332 if (h->oh != NULL
10333 && h->oh->is_func_descriptor)
10334 {
10335 fdh = ppc_follow_link (h->oh);
10336 *hash = fdh;
10337 }
10338
10339 for (ent = fdh->elf.plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
10340 if (ent->addend == rel->r_addend
10341 && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
10342 {
10343 *plt_ent = ent;
10344 return ppc_stub_plt_call;
10345 }
10346
10347 /* Here, we know we don't have a plt entry. If we don't have a
10348 either a defined function descriptor or a defined entry symbol
10349 in a regular object file, then it is pointless trying to make
10350 any other type of stub. */
10351 if (!is_static_defined (&fdh->elf)
10352 && !is_static_defined (&h->elf))
10353 return ppc_stub_none;
10354 }
10355 else if (elf_local_got_ents (input_sec->owner) != NULL)
10356 {
10357 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_sec->owner);
10358 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
10359 elf_local_got_ents (input_sec->owner) + symtab_hdr->sh_info;
10360 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
10361
10362 if (local_plt[r_symndx] != NULL)
10363 {
10364 struct plt_entry *ent;
10365
10366 for (ent = local_plt[r_symndx]; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
10367 if (ent->addend == rel->r_addend
10368 && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
10369 {
10370 *plt_ent = ent;
10371 return ppc_stub_plt_call;
10372 }
10373 }
10374 }
10375
10376 /* Determine where the call point is. */
10377 location = (input_sec->output_offset
10378 + input_sec->output_section->vma
10379 + rel->r_offset);
10380
10381 branch_offset = destination - location;
10382 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
10383
10384 /* Determine if a long branch stub is needed. */
10385 max_branch_offset = 1 << 25;
10386 if (r_type == R_PPC64_REL14
10387 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN
10388 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
10389 max_branch_offset = 1 << 15;
10390
10391 if (branch_offset + max_branch_offset >= 2 * max_branch_offset - local_off)
10392 /* We need a stub. Figure out whether a long_branch or plt_branch
10393 is needed later. */
10394 return ppc_stub_long_branch;
10395
10396 return ppc_stub_none;
10397 }
10398
10399 /* Gets the address of a label (1:) in r11 and builds an offset in r12,
10400 then adds it to r11 (LOAD false) or loads r12 from r11+r12 (LOAD true).
10401 . mflr %r12
10402 . bcl 20,31,1f
10403 .1: mflr %r11
10404 . mtlr %r12
10405 . lis %r12,xxx-1b@highest
10406 . ori %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@higher
10407 . sldi %r12,%r12,32
10408 . oris %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@high
10409 . ori %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@l
10410 . add/ldx %r12,%r11,%r12 */
10411
10412 static bfd_byte *
10413 build_offset (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, bfd_vma off, bfd_boolean load)
10414 {
10415 bfd_put_32 (abfd, MFLR_R12, p);
10416 p += 4;
10417 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BCL_20_31, p);
10418 p += 4;
10419 bfd_put_32 (abfd, MFLR_R11, p);
10420 p += 4;
10421 bfd_put_32 (abfd, MTLR_R12, p);
10422 p += 4;
10423 if (off + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
10424 {
10425 if (load)
10426 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R12_0R11 + PPC_LO (off), p);
10427 else
10428 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADDI_R12_R11 + PPC_LO (off), p);
10429 p += 4;
10430 }
10431 else if (off + 0x80008000ULL < 0x100000000ULL)
10432 {
10433 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADDIS_R12_R11 + PPC_HA (off), p);
10434 p += 4;
10435 if (load)
10436 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R12_0R12 + PPC_LO (off), p);
10437 else
10438 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADDI_R12_R12 + PPC_LO (off), p);
10439 p += 4;
10440 }
10441 else
10442 {
10443 if (off + 0x800000000000ULL < 0x1000000000000ULL)
10444 {
10445 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LI_R12_0 + ((off >> 32) & 0xffff), p);
10446 p += 4;
10447 }
10448 else
10449 {
10450 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LIS_R12 + ((off >> 48) & 0xffff), p);
10451 p += 4;
10452 if (((off >> 32) & 0xffff) != 0)
10453 {
10454 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ORI_R12_R12_0 + ((off >> 32) & 0xffff), p);
10455 p += 4;
10456 }
10457 }
10458 if (((off >> 32) & 0xffffffffULL) != 0)
10459 {
10460 bfd_put_32 (abfd, SLDI_R12_R12_32, p);
10461 p += 4;
10462 }
10463 if (PPC_HI (off) != 0)
10464 {
10465 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ORIS_R12_R12_0 + PPC_HI (off), p);
10466 p += 4;
10467 }
10468 if (PPC_LO (off) != 0)
10469 {
10470 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ORI_R12_R12_0 + PPC_LO (off), p);
10471 p += 4;
10472 }
10473 if (load)
10474 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LDX_R12_R11_R12, p);
10475 else
10476 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADD_R12_R11_R12, p);
10477 p += 4;
10478 }
10479 return p;
10480 }
10481
10482 static unsigned int
10483 size_offset (bfd_vma off)
10484 {
10485 unsigned int size;
10486 if (off + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
10487 size = 4;
10488 else if (off + 0x80008000ULL < 0x100000000ULL)
10489 size = 8;
10490 else
10491 {
10492 if (off + 0x800000000000ULL < 0x1000000000000ULL)
10493 size = 4;
10494 else
10495 {
10496 size = 4;
10497 if (((off >> 32) & 0xffff) != 0)
10498 size += 4;
10499 }
10500 if (((off >> 32) & 0xffffffffULL) != 0)
10501 size += 4;
10502 if (PPC_HI (off) != 0)
10503 size += 4;
10504 if (PPC_LO (off) != 0)
10505 size += 4;
10506 size += 4;
10507 }
10508 return size + 16;
10509 }
10510
10511 static unsigned int
10512 num_relocs_for_offset (bfd_vma off)
10513 {
10514 unsigned int num_rel;
10515 if (off + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
10516 num_rel = 1;
10517 else if (off + 0x80008000ULL < 0x100000000ULL)
10518 num_rel = 2;
10519 else
10520 {
10521 num_rel = 1;
10522 if (off + 0x800000000000ULL >= 0x1000000000000ULL
10523 && ((off >> 32) & 0xffff) != 0)
10524 num_rel += 1;
10525 if (PPC_HI (off) != 0)
10526 num_rel += 1;
10527 if (PPC_LO (off) != 0)
10528 num_rel += 1;
10529 }
10530 return num_rel;
10531 }
10532
10533 static Elf_Internal_Rela *
10534 emit_relocs_for_offset (struct bfd_link_info *info, Elf_Internal_Rela *r,
10535 bfd_vma roff, bfd_vma targ, bfd_vma off)
10536 {
10537 bfd_vma relative_targ = targ - (roff - 8);
10538 if (bfd_big_endian (info->output_bfd))
10539 roff += 2;
10540 r->r_offset = roff;
10541 r->r_addend = relative_targ + roff;
10542 if (off + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
10543 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16);
10544 else if (off + 0x80008000ULL < 0x100000000ULL)
10545 {
10546 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HA);
10547 ++r;
10548 roff += 4;
10549 r->r_offset = roff;
10550 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_LO);
10551 r->r_addend = relative_targ + roff;
10552 }
10553 else
10554 {
10555 if (off + 0x800000000000ULL < 0x1000000000000ULL)
10556 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER);
10557 else
10558 {
10559 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST);
10560 if (((off >> 32) & 0xffff) != 0)
10561 {
10562 ++r;
10563 roff += 4;
10564 r->r_offset = roff;
10565 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER);
10566 r->r_addend = relative_targ + roff;
10567 }
10568 }
10569 if (((off >> 32) & 0xffffffffULL) != 0)
10570 roff += 4;
10571 if (PPC_HI (off) != 0)
10572 {
10573 ++r;
10574 roff += 4;
10575 r->r_offset = roff;
10576 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGH);
10577 r->r_addend = relative_targ + roff;
10578 }
10579 if (PPC_LO (off) != 0)
10580 {
10581 ++r;
10582 roff += 4;
10583 r->r_offset = roff;
10584 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_LO);
10585 r->r_addend = relative_targ + roff;
10586 }
10587 }
10588 return r;
10589 }
10590
10591 static bfd_byte *
10592 build_powerxx_offset (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, bfd_vma off, int odd,
10593 bfd_boolean load)
10594 {
10595 uint64_t insn;
10596 if (off - odd + (1ULL << 33) < 1ULL << 34)
10597 {
10598 off -= odd;
10599 if (odd)
10600 {
10601 bfd_put_32 (abfd, NOP, p);
10602 p += 4;
10603 }
10604 if (load)
10605 insn = PLD_R12_PC;
10606 else
10607 insn = PADDI_R12_PC;
10608 insn |= D34 (off);
10609 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn >> 32, p);
10610 p += 4;
10611 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, p);
10612 }
10613 /* The minimum value for paddi is -0x200000000. The minimum value
10614 for li is -0x8000, which when shifted by 34 and added gives a
10615 minimum value of -0x2000200000000. The maximum value is
10616 0x1ffffffff+0x7fff<<34 which is 0x2000200000000-1. */
10617 else if (off - (8 - odd) + (0x20002ULL << 32) < 0x40004ULL << 32)
10618 {
10619 off -= 8 - odd;
10620 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LI_R11_0 | (HA34 (off) & 0xffff), p);
10621 p += 4;
10622 if (!odd)
10623 {
10624 bfd_put_32 (abfd, SLDI_R11_R11_34, p);
10625 p += 4;
10626 }
10627 insn = PADDI_R12_PC | D34 (off);
10628 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn >> 32, p);
10629 p += 4;
10630 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, p);
10631 p += 4;
10632 if (odd)
10633 {
10634 bfd_put_32 (abfd, SLDI_R11_R11_34, p);
10635 p += 4;
10636 }
10637 if (load)
10638 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LDX_R12_R11_R12, p);
10639 else
10640 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADD_R12_R11_R12, p);
10641 }
10642 else
10643 {
10644 off -= odd + 8;
10645 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LIS_R11 | ((HA34 (off) >> 16) & 0x3fff), p);
10646 p += 4;
10647 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ORI_R11_R11_0 | (HA34 (off) & 0xffff), p);
10648 p += 4;
10649 if (odd)
10650 {
10651 bfd_put_32 (abfd, SLDI_R11_R11_34, p);
10652 p += 4;
10653 }
10654 insn = PADDI_R12_PC | D34 (off);
10655 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn >> 32, p);
10656 p += 4;
10657 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, p);
10658 p += 4;
10659 if (!odd)
10660 {
10661 bfd_put_32 (abfd, SLDI_R11_R11_34, p);
10662 p += 4;
10663 }
10664 if (load)
10665 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LDX_R12_R11_R12, p);
10666 else
10667 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADD_R12_R11_R12, p);
10668 }
10669 p += 4;
10670 return p;
10671 }
10672
10673 static unsigned int
10674 size_powerxx_offset (bfd_vma off, int odd)
10675 {
10676 if (off - odd + (1ULL << 33) < 1ULL << 34)
10677 return odd + 8;
10678 else if (off - (8 - odd) + (0x20002ULL << 32) < 0x40004ULL << 32)
10679 return 20;
10680 else
10681 return 24;
10682 }
10683
10684 static unsigned int
10685 num_relocs_for_powerxx_offset (bfd_vma off, int odd)
10686 {
10687 if (off - odd + (1ULL << 33) < 1ULL << 34)
10688 return 1;
10689 else if (off - (8 - odd) + (0x20002ULL << 32) < 0x40004ULL << 32)
10690 return 2;
10691 else
10692 return 3;
10693 }
10694
10695 static Elf_Internal_Rela *
10696 emit_relocs_for_powerxx_offset (struct bfd_link_info *info,
10697 Elf_Internal_Rela *r, bfd_vma roff,
10698 bfd_vma targ, bfd_vma off, int odd)
10699 {
10700 if (off - odd + (1ULL << 33) < 1ULL << 34)
10701 roff += odd;
10702 else if (off - (8 - odd) + (0x20002ULL << 32) < 0x40004ULL << 32)
10703 {
10704 int d_offset = bfd_big_endian (info->output_bfd) ? 2 : 0;
10705 r->r_offset = roff + d_offset;
10706 r->r_addend = targ + 8 - odd - d_offset;
10707 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34);
10708 ++r;
10709 roff += 8 - odd;
10710 }
10711 else
10712 {
10713 int d_offset = bfd_big_endian (info->output_bfd) ? 2 : 0;
10714 r->r_offset = roff + d_offset;
10715 r->r_addend = targ + 8 + odd - d_offset;
10716 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34);
10717 ++r;
10718 roff += 4;
10719 r->r_offset = roff + d_offset;
10720 r->r_addend = targ + 4 + odd - d_offset;
10721 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34);
10722 ++r;
10723 roff += 4 + odd;
10724 }
10725 r->r_offset = roff;
10726 r->r_addend = targ;
10727 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_PCREL34);
10728 return r;
10729 }
10730
10731 /* Emit .eh_frame opcode to advance pc by DELTA. */
10732
10733 static bfd_byte *
10734 eh_advance (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *eh, unsigned int delta)
10735 {
10736 delta /= 4;
10737 if (delta < 64)
10738 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + delta;
10739 else if (delta < 256)
10740 {
10741 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1;
10742 *eh++ = delta;
10743 }
10744 else if (delta < 65536)
10745 {
10746 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2;
10747 bfd_put_16 (abfd, delta, eh);
10748 eh += 2;
10749 }
10750 else
10751 {
10752 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
10753 bfd_put_32 (abfd, delta, eh);
10754 eh += 4;
10755 }
10756 return eh;
10757 }
10758
10759 /* Size of required .eh_frame opcode to advance pc by DELTA. */
10760
10761 static unsigned int
10762 eh_advance_size (unsigned int delta)
10763 {
10764 if (delta < 64 * 4)
10765 /* DW_CFA_advance_loc+[1..63]. */
10766 return 1;
10767 if (delta < 256 * 4)
10768 /* DW_CFA_advance_loc1, byte. */
10769 return 2;
10770 if (delta < 65536 * 4)
10771 /* DW_CFA_advance_loc2, 2 bytes. */
10772 return 3;
10773 /* DW_CFA_advance_loc4, 4 bytes. */
10774 return 5;
10775 }
10776
10777 /* With power7 weakly ordered memory model, it is possible for ld.so
10778 to update a plt entry in one thread and have another thread see a
10779 stale zero toc entry. To avoid this we need some sort of acquire
10780 barrier in the call stub. One solution is to make the load of the
10781 toc word seem to appear to depend on the load of the function entry
10782 word. Another solution is to test for r2 being zero, and branch to
10783 the appropriate glink entry if so.
10784
10785 . fake dep barrier compare
10786 . ld 12,xxx(2) ld 12,xxx(2)
10787 . mtctr 12 mtctr 12
10788 . xor 11,12,12 ld 2,xxx+8(2)
10789 . add 2,2,11 cmpldi 2,0
10790 . ld 2,xxx+8(2) bnectr+
10791 . bctr b <glink_entry>
10792
10793 The solution involving the compare turns out to be faster, so
10794 that's what we use unless the branch won't reach. */
10795
10796 #define ALWAYS_USE_FAKE_DEP 0
10797 #define ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE 0
10798
10799 static inline unsigned int
10800 plt_stub_size (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
10801 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
10802 bfd_vma off)
10803 {
10804 unsigned size;
10805
10806 if (stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
10807 {
10808 if (htab->powerxx_stubs)
10809 {
10810 bfd_vma start = (stub_entry->stub_offset
10811 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
10812 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
10813 if (stub_entry->stub_type > ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
10814 start += 4;
10815 size = 8 + size_powerxx_offset (off, start & 4);
10816 }
10817 else
10818 size = 8 + size_offset (off - 8);
10819 if (stub_entry->stub_type > ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
10820 size += 4;
10821 return size;
10822 }
10823
10824 size = 12;
10825 if (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
10826 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
10827 size += 4;
10828 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
10829 size += 4;
10830 if (htab->opd_abi)
10831 {
10832 size += 4;
10833 if (htab->params->plt_static_chain)
10834 size += 4;
10835 if (htab->params->plt_thread_safe
10836 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
10837 && stub_entry->h != NULL
10838 && stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx != -1)
10839 size += 8;
10840 if (PPC_HA (off + 8 + 8 * htab->params->plt_static_chain) != PPC_HA (off))
10841 size += 4;
10842 }
10843 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
10844 && is_tls_get_addr (&stub_entry->h->elf, htab)
10845 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt)
10846 {
10847 if (htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_regsave)
10848 {
10849 size += 7 * 4;
10850 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
10851 size += 6 * 4;
10852 }
10853 else
10854 {
10855 size += 30 * 4;
10856 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
10857 size += 4;
10858 }
10859 }
10860 return size;
10861 }
10862
10863 /* Depending on the sign of plt_stub_align:
10864 If positive, return the padding to align to a 2**plt_stub_align
10865 boundary.
10866 If negative, if this stub would cross fewer 2**plt_stub_align
10867 boundaries if we align, then return the padding needed to do so. */
10868
10869 static inline unsigned int
10870 plt_stub_pad (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
10871 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
10872 bfd_vma plt_off)
10873 {
10874 int stub_align;
10875 unsigned stub_size;
10876 bfd_vma stub_off = stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size;
10877
10878 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align >= 0)
10879 {
10880 stub_align = 1 << htab->params->plt_stub_align;
10881 if ((stub_off & (stub_align - 1)) != 0)
10882 return stub_align - (stub_off & (stub_align - 1));
10883 return 0;
10884 }
10885
10886 stub_align = 1 << -htab->params->plt_stub_align;
10887 stub_size = plt_stub_size (htab, stub_entry, plt_off);
10888 if (((stub_off + stub_size - 1) & -stub_align) - (stub_off & -stub_align)
10889 > ((stub_size - 1) & -stub_align))
10890 return stub_align - (stub_off & (stub_align - 1));
10891 return 0;
10892 }
10893
10894 /* Build a .plt call stub. */
10895
10896 static inline bfd_byte *
10897 build_plt_stub (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
10898 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
10899 bfd_byte *p, bfd_vma offset, Elf_Internal_Rela *r)
10900 {
10901 bfd *obfd = htab->params->stub_bfd;
10902 bfd_boolean plt_load_toc = htab->opd_abi;
10903 bfd_boolean plt_static_chain = htab->params->plt_static_chain;
10904 bfd_boolean plt_thread_safe = (htab->params->plt_thread_safe
10905 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
10906 && stub_entry->h != NULL
10907 && stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx != -1);
10908 bfd_boolean use_fake_dep = plt_thread_safe;
10909 bfd_vma cmp_branch_off = 0;
10910
10911 if (!ALWAYS_USE_FAKE_DEP
10912 && plt_load_toc
10913 && plt_thread_safe
10914 && !(is_tls_get_addr (&stub_entry->h->elf, htab)
10915 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt))
10916 {
10917 bfd_vma pltoff = stub_entry->plt_ent->plt.offset & ~1;
10918 bfd_vma pltindex = ((pltoff - PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE (htab))
10919 / PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab));
10920 bfd_vma glinkoff = GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE (htab) + pltindex * 8;
10921 bfd_vma to, from;
10922
10923 if (pltindex > 32768)
10924 glinkoff += (pltindex - 32768) * 4;
10925 to = (glinkoff
10926 + htab->glink->output_offset
10927 + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
10928 from = (p - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents
10929 + 4 * (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
10930 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
10931 + 4 * (PPC_HA (offset) != 0)
10932 + 4 * (PPC_HA (offset + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain)
10933 != PPC_HA (offset))
10934 + 4 * (plt_static_chain != 0)
10935 + 20
10936 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
10937 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
10938 cmp_branch_off = to - from;
10939 use_fake_dep = cmp_branch_off + (1 << 25) >= (1 << 26);
10940 }
10941
10942 if (PPC_HA (offset) != 0)
10943 {
10944 if (r != NULL)
10945 {
10946 if (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
10947 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
10948 r[0].r_offset += 4;
10949 r[0].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_HA);
10950 r[1].r_offset = r[0].r_offset + 4;
10951 r[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS);
10952 r[1].r_addend = r[0].r_addend;
10953 if (plt_load_toc)
10954 {
10955 if (PPC_HA (offset + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain) != PPC_HA (offset))
10956 {
10957 r[2].r_offset = r[1].r_offset + 4;
10958 r[2].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_LO);
10959 r[2].r_addend = r[0].r_addend;
10960 }
10961 else
10962 {
10963 r[2].r_offset = r[1].r_offset + 8 + 8 * use_fake_dep;
10964 r[2].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS);
10965 r[2].r_addend = r[0].r_addend + 8;
10966 if (plt_static_chain)
10967 {
10968 r[3].r_offset = r[2].r_offset + 4;
10969 r[3].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS);
10970 r[3].r_addend = r[0].r_addend + 16;
10971 }
10972 }
10973 }
10974 }
10975 if (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
10976 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
10977 bfd_put_32 (obfd, STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p), p += 4;
10978 if (plt_load_toc)
10979 {
10980 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDIS_R11_R2 | PPC_HA (offset), p), p += 4;
10981 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R12_0R11 | PPC_LO (offset), p), p += 4;
10982 }
10983 else
10984 {
10985 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDIS_R12_R2 | PPC_HA (offset), p), p += 4;
10986 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R12_0R12 | PPC_LO (offset), p), p += 4;
10987 }
10988 if (plt_load_toc
10989 && PPC_HA (offset + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain) != PPC_HA (offset))
10990 {
10991 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDI_R11_R11 | PPC_LO (offset), p), p += 4;
10992 offset = 0;
10993 }
10994 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MTCTR_R12, p), p += 4;
10995 if (plt_load_toc)
10996 {
10997 if (use_fake_dep)
10998 {
10999 bfd_put_32 (obfd, XOR_R2_R12_R12, p), p += 4;
11000 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADD_R11_R11_R2, p), p += 4;
11001 }
11002 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R2_0R11 | PPC_LO (offset + 8), p), p += 4;
11003 if (plt_static_chain)
11004 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R11_0R11 | PPC_LO (offset + 16), p), p += 4;
11005 }
11006 }
11007 else
11008 {
11009 if (r != NULL)
11010 {
11011 if (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
11012 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
11013 r[0].r_offset += 4;
11014 r[0].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_DS);
11015 if (plt_load_toc)
11016 {
11017 if (PPC_HA (offset + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain) != PPC_HA (offset))
11018 {
11019 r[1].r_offset = r[0].r_offset + 4;
11020 r[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16);
11021 r[1].r_addend = r[0].r_addend;
11022 }
11023 else
11024 {
11025 r[1].r_offset = r[0].r_offset + 8 + 8 * use_fake_dep;
11026 r[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_DS);
11027 r[1].r_addend = r[0].r_addend + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain;
11028 if (plt_static_chain)
11029 {
11030 r[2].r_offset = r[1].r_offset + 4;
11031 r[2].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_DS);
11032 r[2].r_addend = r[0].r_addend + 8;
11033 }
11034 }
11035 }
11036 }
11037 if (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
11038 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
11039 bfd_put_32 (obfd, STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p), p += 4;
11040 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R12_0R2 | PPC_LO (offset), p), p += 4;
11041 if (plt_load_toc
11042 && PPC_HA (offset + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain) != PPC_HA (offset))
11043 {
11044 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDI_R2_R2 | PPC_LO (offset), p), p += 4;
11045 offset = 0;
11046 }
11047 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MTCTR_R12, p), p += 4;
11048 if (plt_load_toc)
11049 {
11050 if (use_fake_dep)
11051 {
11052 bfd_put_32 (obfd, XOR_R11_R12_R12, p), p += 4;
11053 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADD_R2_R2_R11, p), p += 4;
11054 }
11055 if (plt_static_chain)
11056 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R11_0R2 | PPC_LO (offset + 16), p), p += 4;
11057 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R2_0R2 | PPC_LO (offset + 8), p), p += 4;
11058 }
11059 }
11060 if (plt_load_toc && plt_thread_safe && !use_fake_dep)
11061 {
11062 bfd_put_32 (obfd, CMPLDI_R2_0, p), p += 4;
11063 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BNECTR_P4, p), p += 4;
11064 bfd_put_32 (obfd, B_DOT | (cmp_branch_off & 0x3fffffc), p), p += 4;
11065 }
11066 else
11067 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BCTR, p), p += 4;
11068 return p;
11069 }
11070
11071 /* Build a special .plt call stub for __tls_get_addr. */
11072
11073 #define LD_R0_0R3 0xe8030000
11074 #define LD_R12_0R3 0xe9830000
11075 #define MR_R0_R3 0x7c601b78
11076 #define CMPDI_R0_0 0x2c200000
11077 #define ADD_R3_R12_R13 0x7c6c6a14
11078 #define BEQLR 0x4d820020
11079 #define MR_R3_R0 0x7c030378
11080 #define BCTRL 0x4e800421
11081
11082 static inline bfd_byte *
11083 build_tls_get_addr_stub (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
11084 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
11085 bfd_byte *p, bfd_vma offset, Elf_Internal_Rela *r)
11086 {
11087 bfd *obfd = htab->params->stub_bfd;
11088 bfd_byte *loc = p;
11089 unsigned int i;
11090
11091 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R0_0R3 + 0, p), p += 4;
11092 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R12_0R3 + 8, p), p += 4;
11093 bfd_put_32 (obfd, CMPDI_R0_0, p), p += 4;
11094 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MR_R0_R3, p), p += 4;
11095 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADD_R3_R12_R13, p), p += 4;
11096 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BEQLR, p), p += 4;
11097 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MR_R3_R0, p), p += 4;
11098 if (htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_regsave)
11099 {
11100 if (r != NULL)
11101 r[0].r_offset += 7 * 4;
11102 if (stub_entry->stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
11103 return build_plt_stub (htab, stub_entry, p, offset, r);
11104
11105 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MFLR_R0, p);
11106 p += 4;
11107 bfd_put_32 (obfd, STD_R0_0R1 + STK_LINKER (htab), p);
11108 p += 4;
11109
11110 if (r != NULL)
11111 r[0].r_offset += 2 * 4;
11112 p = build_plt_stub (htab, stub_entry, p, offset, r);
11113 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BCTRL, p - 4);
11114
11115 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p);
11116 p += 4;
11117 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R0_0R1 + STK_LINKER (htab), p);
11118 p += 4;
11119 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MTLR_R0, p);
11120 p += 4;
11121 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BLR, p);
11122 p += 4;
11123 }
11124 else
11125 {
11126 p = tls_get_addr_prologue (obfd, p, htab);
11127
11128 if (r != NULL)
11129 r[0].r_offset += 18 * 4;
11130
11131 p = build_plt_stub (htab, stub_entry, p, offset, r);
11132 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BCTRL, p - 4);
11133
11134 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
11135 {
11136 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p);
11137 p += 4;
11138 }
11139
11140 p = tls_get_addr_epilogue (obfd, p, htab);
11141 }
11142
11143 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
11144 && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0)
11145 {
11146 bfd_byte *base, *eh;
11147
11148 base = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents + stub_entry->group->eh_base + 17;
11149 eh = base + stub_entry->group->eh_size;
11150 if (htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_regsave)
11151 {
11152 unsigned int lr_used, delta;
11153 lr_used = stub_entry->stub_offset + (p - 20 - loc);
11154 delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
11155 stub_entry->group->lr_restore = lr_used + 16;
11156 eh = eh_advance (htab->elf.dynobj, eh, delta);
11157 *eh++ = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
11158 *eh++ = 65;
11159 *eh++ = -(STK_LINKER (htab) / 8) & 0x7f;
11160 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4;
11161 }
11162 else
11163 {
11164 unsigned int cfa_updt, delta;
11165 /* After the bctrl, lr has been modified so we need to emit
11166 .eh_frame info saying the return address is on the stack. In
11167 fact we must put the EH info at or before the call rather
11168 than after it, because the EH info for a call needs to be
11169 specified by that point.
11170 See libgcc/unwind-dw2.c execute_cfa_program.
11171 Any stack pointer update must be described immediately after
11172 the instruction making the change, and since the stdu occurs
11173 after saving regs we put all the reg saves and the cfa
11174 change there. */
11175 cfa_updt = stub_entry->stub_offset + 18 * 4;
11176 delta = cfa_updt - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
11177 stub_entry->group->lr_restore
11178 = stub_entry->stub_offset + (p - loc) - 4;
11179 eh = eh_advance (htab->elf.dynobj, eh, delta);
11180 *eh++ = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
11181 if (htab->opd_abi)
11182 {
11183 *eh++ = 128;
11184 *eh++ = 1;
11185 }
11186 else
11187 *eh++ = 96;
11188 *eh++ = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
11189 *eh++ = 65;
11190 *eh++ = (-16 / 8) & 0x7f;
11191 for (i = 4; i < 12; i++)
11192 {
11193 *eh++ = DW_CFA_offset + i;
11194 *eh++ = (htab->opd_abi ? 13 : 12) - i;
11195 }
11196 *eh++ = (DW_CFA_advance_loc
11197 + (stub_entry->group->lr_restore - 8 - cfa_updt) / 4);
11198 *eh++ = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
11199 *eh++ = 0;
11200 for (i = 4; i < 12; i++)
11201 *eh++ = DW_CFA_restore + i;
11202 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 2;
11203 }
11204 *eh++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
11205 *eh++ = 65;
11206 stub_entry->group->eh_size = eh - base;
11207 }
11208 return p;
11209 }
11210
11211 static Elf_Internal_Rela *
11212 get_relocs (asection *sec, int count)
11213 {
11214 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs;
11215 struct bfd_elf_section_data *elfsec_data;
11216
11217 elfsec_data = elf_section_data (sec);
11218 relocs = elfsec_data->relocs;
11219 if (relocs == NULL)
11220 {
11221 bfd_size_type relsize;
11222 relsize = sec->reloc_count * sizeof (*relocs);
11223 relocs = bfd_alloc (sec->owner, relsize);
11224 if (relocs == NULL)
11225 return NULL;
11226 elfsec_data->relocs = relocs;
11227 elfsec_data->rela.hdr = bfd_zalloc (sec->owner,
11228 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
11229 if (elfsec_data->rela.hdr == NULL)
11230 return NULL;
11231 elfsec_data->rela.hdr->sh_size = (sec->reloc_count
11232 * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
11233 elfsec_data->rela.hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
11234 sec->reloc_count = 0;
11235 }
11236 relocs += sec->reloc_count;
11237 sec->reloc_count += count;
11238 return relocs;
11239 }
11240
11241 /* Convert the relocs R[0] thru R[-NUM_REL+1], which are all no-symbol
11242 forms, to the equivalent relocs against the global symbol given by
11243 STUB_ENTRY->H. */
11244
11245 static bfd_boolean
11246 use_global_in_relocs (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
11247 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
11248 Elf_Internal_Rela *r, unsigned int num_rel)
11249 {
11250 struct elf_link_hash_entry **hashes;
11251 unsigned long symndx;
11252 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h;
11253 bfd_vma symval;
11254
11255 /* Relocs are always against symbols in their own object file. Fake
11256 up global sym hashes for the stub bfd (which has no symbols). */
11257 hashes = elf_sym_hashes (htab->params->stub_bfd);
11258 if (hashes == NULL)
11259 {
11260 bfd_size_type hsize;
11261
11262 /* When called the first time, stub_globals will contain the
11263 total number of symbols seen during stub sizing. After
11264 allocating, stub_globals is used as an index to fill the
11265 hashes array. */
11266 hsize = (htab->stub_globals + 1) * sizeof (*hashes);
11267 hashes = bfd_zalloc (htab->params->stub_bfd, hsize);
11268 if (hashes == NULL)
11269 return FALSE;
11270 elf_sym_hashes (htab->params->stub_bfd) = hashes;
11271 htab->stub_globals = 1;
11272 }
11273 symndx = htab->stub_globals++;
11274 h = stub_entry->h;
11275 hashes[symndx] = &h->elf;
11276 if (h->oh != NULL && h->oh->is_func)
11277 h = ppc_follow_link (h->oh);
11278 BFD_ASSERT (h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
11279 || h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
11280 symval = defined_sym_val (&h->elf);
11281 while (num_rel-- != 0)
11282 {
11283 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (symndx, ELF64_R_TYPE (r->r_info));
11284 if (h->elf.root.u.def.section != stub_entry->target_section)
11285 {
11286 /* H is an opd symbol. The addend must be zero, and the
11287 branch reloc is the only one we can convert. */
11288 r->r_addend = 0;
11289 break;
11290 }
11291 else
11292 r->r_addend -= symval;
11293 --r;
11294 }
11295 return TRUE;
11296 }
11297
11298 static bfd_vma
11299 get_r2off (struct bfd_link_info *info,
11300 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry)
11301 {
11302 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
11303 bfd_vma r2off = htab->sec_info[stub_entry->target_section->id].toc_off;
11304
11305 if (r2off == 0)
11306 {
11307 /* Support linking -R objects. Get the toc pointer from the
11308 opd entry. */
11309 char buf[8];
11310 if (!htab->opd_abi)
11311 return r2off;
11312 asection *opd = stub_entry->h->elf.root.u.def.section;
11313 bfd_vma opd_off = stub_entry->h->elf.root.u.def.value;
11314
11315 if (strcmp (opd->name, ".opd") != 0
11316 || opd->reloc_count != 0)
11317 {
11318 info->callbacks->einfo
11319 (_("%P: cannot find opd entry toc for `%pT'\n"),
11320 stub_entry->h->elf.root.root.string);
11321 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
11322 return (bfd_vma) -1;
11323 }
11324 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (opd->owner, opd, buf, opd_off + 8, 8))
11325 return (bfd_vma) -1;
11326 r2off = bfd_get_64 (opd->owner, buf);
11327 r2off -= elf_gp (info->output_bfd);
11328 }
11329 r2off -= htab->sec_info[stub_entry->group->link_sec->id].toc_off;
11330 return r2off;
11331 }
11332
11333 static bfd_boolean
11334 ppc_build_one_stub (struct bfd_hash_entry *gen_entry, void *in_arg)
11335 {
11336 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
11337 struct ppc_branch_hash_entry *br_entry;
11338 struct bfd_link_info *info;
11339 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
11340 bfd_byte *loc;
11341 bfd_byte *p, *relp;
11342 bfd_vma targ, off;
11343 Elf_Internal_Rela *r;
11344 asection *plt;
11345 int num_rel;
11346 int odd;
11347
11348 /* Massage our args to the form they really have. */
11349 stub_entry = (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *) gen_entry;
11350 info = in_arg;
11351
11352 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
11353 if (htab == NULL)
11354 return FALSE;
11355
11356 BFD_ASSERT (stub_entry->stub_offset >= stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size);
11357 loc = stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents + stub_entry->stub_offset;
11358
11359 htab->stub_count[stub_entry->stub_type - 1] += 1;
11360 switch (stub_entry->stub_type)
11361 {
11362 case ppc_stub_long_branch:
11363 case ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off:
11364 /* Branches are relative. This is where we are going to. */
11365 targ = (stub_entry->target_value
11366 + stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
11367 + stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
11368 targ += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (stub_entry->other);
11369
11370 /* And this is where we are coming from. */
11371 off = (stub_entry->stub_offset
11372 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
11373 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
11374 off = targ - off;
11375
11376 p = loc;
11377 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off)
11378 {
11379 bfd_vma r2off = get_r2off (info, stub_entry);
11380
11381 if (r2off == (bfd_vma) -1)
11382 {
11383 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
11384 return FALSE;
11385 }
11386 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p);
11387 p += 4;
11388 if (PPC_HA (r2off) != 0)
11389 {
11390 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11391 ADDIS_R2_R2 | PPC_HA (r2off), p);
11392 p += 4;
11393 }
11394 if (PPC_LO (r2off) != 0)
11395 {
11396 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11397 ADDI_R2_R2 | PPC_LO (r2off), p);
11398 p += 4;
11399 }
11400 off -= p - loc;
11401 }
11402 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, B_DOT | (off & 0x3fffffc), p);
11403 p += 4;
11404
11405 if (off + (1 << 25) >= (bfd_vma) (1 << 26))
11406 {
11407 _bfd_error_handler
11408 (_("long branch stub `%s' offset overflow"),
11409 stub_entry->root.string);
11410 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
11411 return FALSE;
11412 }
11413
11414 if (info->emitrelocations)
11415 {
11416 r = get_relocs (stub_entry->group->stub_sec, 1);
11417 if (r == NULL)
11418 return FALSE;
11419 r->r_offset = p - 4 - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents;
11420 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL24);
11421 r->r_addend = targ;
11422 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
11423 && !use_global_in_relocs (htab, stub_entry, r, 1))
11424 return FALSE;
11425 }
11426 break;
11427
11428 case ppc_stub_plt_branch:
11429 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off:
11430 br_entry = ppc_branch_hash_lookup (&htab->branch_hash_table,
11431 stub_entry->root.string + 9,
11432 FALSE, FALSE);
11433 if (br_entry == NULL)
11434 {
11435 _bfd_error_handler (_("can't find branch stub `%s'"),
11436 stub_entry->root.string);
11437 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
11438 return FALSE;
11439 }
11440
11441 targ = (stub_entry->target_value
11442 + stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
11443 + stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
11444 if (stub_entry->stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off)
11445 targ += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (stub_entry->other);
11446
11447 bfd_put_64 (htab->brlt->owner, targ,
11448 htab->brlt->contents + br_entry->offset);
11449
11450 if (br_entry->iter == htab->stub_iteration)
11451 {
11452 br_entry->iter = 0;
11453
11454 if (htab->relbrlt != NULL)
11455 {
11456 /* Create a reloc for the branch lookup table entry. */
11457 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
11458 bfd_byte *rl;
11459
11460 rela.r_offset = (br_entry->offset
11461 + htab->brlt->output_offset
11462 + htab->brlt->output_section->vma);
11463 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
11464 rela.r_addend = targ;
11465
11466 rl = htab->relbrlt->contents;
11467 rl += (htab->relbrlt->reloc_count++
11468 * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
11469 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (htab->relbrlt->owner, &rela, rl);
11470 }
11471 else if (info->emitrelocations)
11472 {
11473 r = get_relocs (htab->brlt, 1);
11474 if (r == NULL)
11475 return FALSE;
11476 /* brlt, being SEC_LINKER_CREATED does not go through the
11477 normal reloc processing. Symbols and offsets are not
11478 translated from input file to output file form, so
11479 set up the offset per the output file. */
11480 r->r_offset = (br_entry->offset
11481 + htab->brlt->output_offset
11482 + htab->brlt->output_section->vma);
11483 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
11484 r->r_addend = targ;
11485 }
11486 }
11487
11488 targ = (br_entry->offset
11489 + htab->brlt->output_offset
11490 + htab->brlt->output_section->vma);
11491
11492 off = (elf_gp (info->output_bfd)
11493 + htab->sec_info[stub_entry->group->link_sec->id].toc_off);
11494 off = targ - off;
11495
11496 if (off + 0x80008000 > 0xffffffff || (off & 7) != 0)
11497 {
11498 info->callbacks->einfo
11499 (_("%P: linkage table error against `%pT'\n"),
11500 stub_entry->root.string);
11501 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
11502 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
11503 return FALSE;
11504 }
11505
11506 if (info->emitrelocations)
11507 {
11508 r = get_relocs (stub_entry->group->stub_sec, 1 + (PPC_HA (off) != 0));
11509 if (r == NULL)
11510 return FALSE;
11511 r[0].r_offset = loc - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents;
11512 if (bfd_big_endian (info->output_bfd))
11513 r[0].r_offset += 2;
11514 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off)
11515 r[0].r_offset += 4;
11516 r[0].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_DS);
11517 r[0].r_addend = targ;
11518 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
11519 {
11520 r[0].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_HA);
11521 r[1].r_offset = r[0].r_offset + 4;
11522 r[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS);
11523 r[1].r_addend = r[0].r_addend;
11524 }
11525 }
11526
11527 p = loc;
11528 if (stub_entry->stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off)
11529 {
11530 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
11531 {
11532 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11533 ADDIS_R12_R2 | PPC_HA (off), p);
11534 p += 4;
11535 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11536 LD_R12_0R12 | PPC_LO (off), p);
11537 }
11538 else
11539 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11540 LD_R12_0R2 | PPC_LO (off), p);
11541 }
11542 else
11543 {
11544 bfd_vma r2off = get_r2off (info, stub_entry);
11545
11546 if (r2off == (bfd_vma) -1)
11547 {
11548 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
11549 return FALSE;
11550 }
11551
11552 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p);
11553 p += 4;
11554 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
11555 {
11556 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11557 ADDIS_R12_R2 | PPC_HA (off), p);
11558 p += 4;
11559 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11560 LD_R12_0R12 | PPC_LO (off), p);
11561 }
11562 else
11563 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, LD_R12_0R2 | PPC_LO (off), p);
11564
11565 if (PPC_HA (r2off) != 0)
11566 {
11567 p += 4;
11568 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11569 ADDIS_R2_R2 | PPC_HA (r2off), p);
11570 }
11571 if (PPC_LO (r2off) != 0)
11572 {
11573 p += 4;
11574 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11575 ADDI_R2_R2 | PPC_LO (r2off), p);
11576 }
11577 }
11578 p += 4;
11579 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, MTCTR_R12, p);
11580 p += 4;
11581 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, BCTR, p);
11582 p += 4;
11583 break;
11584
11585 case ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc:
11586 case ppc_stub_long_branch_both:
11587 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc:
11588 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_both:
11589 case ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc:
11590 case ppc_stub_plt_call_both:
11591 p = loc;
11592 off = (stub_entry->stub_offset
11593 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
11594 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
11595 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both
11596 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both
11597 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
11598 {
11599 off += 4;
11600 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p);
11601 p += 4;
11602 }
11603 if (stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
11604 {
11605 targ = stub_entry->plt_ent->plt.offset & ~1;
11606 if (targ >= (bfd_vma) -2)
11607 abort ();
11608
11609 plt = htab->elf.splt;
11610 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
11611 || stub_entry->h == NULL
11612 || stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx == -1)
11613 {
11614 if (stub_entry->symtype == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
11615 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
11616 else
11617 plt = htab->pltlocal;
11618 }
11619 targ += plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
11620 }
11621 else
11622 targ = (stub_entry->target_value
11623 + stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
11624 + stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
11625 odd = off & 4;
11626 off = targ - off;
11627
11628 relp = p;
11629 num_rel = 0;
11630 if (htab->powerxx_stubs)
11631 {
11632 bfd_boolean load = stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc;
11633 p = build_powerxx_offset (htab->params->stub_bfd, p, off, odd, load);
11634 }
11635 else
11636 {
11637 /* The notoc stubs calculate their target (either a PLT entry or
11638 the global entry point of a function) relative to the PC
11639 returned by the "bcl" two instructions past the start of the
11640 sequence emitted by build_offset. The offset is therefore 8
11641 less than calculated from the start of the sequence. */
11642 off -= 8;
11643 p = build_offset (htab->params->stub_bfd, p, off,
11644 stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc);
11645 }
11646
11647 if (stub_entry->stub_type <= ppc_stub_long_branch_both)
11648 {
11649 bfd_vma from;
11650 num_rel = 1;
11651 from = (stub_entry->stub_offset
11652 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
11653 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma
11654 + (p - loc));
11655 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11656 B_DOT | ((targ - from) & 0x3fffffc), p);
11657 }
11658 else
11659 {
11660 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, MTCTR_R12, p);
11661 p += 4;
11662 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, BCTR, p);
11663 }
11664 p += 4;
11665
11666 if (info->emitrelocations)
11667 {
11668 bfd_vma roff = relp - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents;
11669 if (htab->powerxx_stubs)
11670 num_rel += num_relocs_for_powerxx_offset (off, odd);
11671 else
11672 {
11673 num_rel += num_relocs_for_offset (off);
11674 roff += 16;
11675 }
11676 r = get_relocs (stub_entry->group->stub_sec, num_rel);
11677 if (r == NULL)
11678 return FALSE;
11679 if (htab->powerxx_stubs)
11680 r = emit_relocs_for_powerxx_offset (info, r, roff, targ, off, odd);
11681 else
11682 r = emit_relocs_for_offset (info, r, roff, targ, off);
11683 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc
11684 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both)
11685 {
11686 ++r;
11687 roff = p - 4 - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents;
11688 r->r_offset = roff;
11689 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL24);
11690 r->r_addend = targ;
11691 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
11692 && !use_global_in_relocs (htab, stub_entry, r, num_rel))
11693 return FALSE;
11694 }
11695 }
11696
11697 if (!htab->powerxx_stubs
11698 && htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
11699 && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0)
11700 {
11701 bfd_byte *base, *eh;
11702 unsigned int lr_used, delta;
11703
11704 base = (htab->glink_eh_frame->contents
11705 + stub_entry->group->eh_base + 17);
11706 eh = base + stub_entry->group->eh_size;
11707 lr_used = stub_entry->stub_offset + 8;
11708 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both
11709 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both
11710 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
11711 lr_used += 4;
11712 delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
11713 stub_entry->group->lr_restore = lr_used + 8;
11714 eh = eh_advance (htab->elf.dynobj, eh, delta);
11715 *eh++ = DW_CFA_register;
11716 *eh++ = 65;
11717 *eh++ = 12;
11718 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 2;
11719 *eh++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
11720 *eh++ = 65;
11721 stub_entry->group->eh_size = eh - base;
11722 }
11723 break;
11724
11725 case ppc_stub_plt_call:
11726 case ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save:
11727 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
11728 && stub_entry->h->is_func_descriptor
11729 && stub_entry->h->oh != NULL)
11730 {
11731 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh = ppc_follow_link (stub_entry->h->oh);
11732
11733 /* If the old-ABI "dot-symbol" is undefined make it weak so
11734 we don't get a link error from RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL. */
11735 if (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
11736 && (stub_entry->h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
11737 || stub_entry->h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
11738 fh->elf.root.type = bfd_link_hash_undefweak;
11739 }
11740
11741 /* Now build the stub. */
11742 targ = stub_entry->plt_ent->plt.offset & ~1;
11743 if (targ >= (bfd_vma) -2)
11744 abort ();
11745
11746 plt = htab->elf.splt;
11747 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
11748 || stub_entry->h == NULL
11749 || stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx == -1)
11750 {
11751 if (stub_entry->symtype == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
11752 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
11753 else
11754 plt = htab->pltlocal;
11755 }
11756 targ += plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
11757
11758 off = (elf_gp (info->output_bfd)
11759 + htab->sec_info[stub_entry->group->link_sec->id].toc_off);
11760 off = targ - off;
11761
11762 if (off + 0x80008000 > 0xffffffff || (off & 7) != 0)
11763 {
11764 info->callbacks->einfo
11765 /* xgettext:c-format */
11766 (_("%P: linkage table error against `%pT'\n"),
11767 stub_entry->h != NULL
11768 ? stub_entry->h->elf.root.root.string
11769 : "<local sym>");
11770 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
11771 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
11772 return FALSE;
11773 }
11774
11775 r = NULL;
11776 if (info->emitrelocations)
11777 {
11778 r = get_relocs (stub_entry->group->stub_sec,
11779 ((PPC_HA (off) != 0)
11780 + (htab->opd_abi
11781 ? 2 + (htab->params->plt_static_chain
11782 && PPC_HA (off + 16) == PPC_HA (off))
11783 : 1)));
11784 if (r == NULL)
11785 return FALSE;
11786 r[0].r_offset = loc - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents;
11787 if (bfd_big_endian (info->output_bfd))
11788 r[0].r_offset += 2;
11789 r[0].r_addend = targ;
11790 }
11791 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
11792 && is_tls_get_addr (&stub_entry->h->elf, htab)
11793 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt)
11794 p = build_tls_get_addr_stub (htab, stub_entry, loc, off, r);
11795 else
11796 p = build_plt_stub (htab, stub_entry, loc, off, r);
11797 break;
11798
11799 case ppc_stub_save_res:
11800 return TRUE;
11801
11802 default:
11803 BFD_FAIL ();
11804 return FALSE;
11805 }
11806
11807 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size = stub_entry->stub_offset + (p - loc);
11808
11809 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
11810 {
11811 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
11812 size_t len1, len2;
11813 char *name;
11814 const char *const stub_str[] = { "long_branch",
11815 "long_branch",
11816 "long_branch",
11817 "long_branch",
11818 "plt_branch",
11819 "plt_branch",
11820 "plt_branch",
11821 "plt_branch",
11822 "plt_call",
11823 "plt_call",
11824 "plt_call",
11825 "plt_call" };
11826
11827 len1 = strlen (stub_str[stub_entry->stub_type - 1]);
11828 len2 = strlen (stub_entry->root.string);
11829 name = bfd_malloc (len1 + len2 + 2);
11830 if (name == NULL)
11831 return FALSE;
11832 memcpy (name, stub_entry->root.string, 9);
11833 memcpy (name + 9, stub_str[stub_entry->stub_type - 1], len1);
11834 memcpy (name + len1 + 9, stub_entry->root.string + 8, len2 - 8 + 1);
11835 h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
11836 if (h == NULL)
11837 return FALSE;
11838 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
11839 {
11840 h->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
11841 h->root.u.def.section = stub_entry->group->stub_sec;
11842 h->root.u.def.value = stub_entry->stub_offset;
11843 h->ref_regular = 1;
11844 h->def_regular = 1;
11845 h->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
11846 h->forced_local = 1;
11847 h->non_elf = 0;
11848 h->root.linker_def = 1;
11849 }
11850 }
11851
11852 return TRUE;
11853 }
11854
11855 /* As above, but don't actually build the stub. Just bump offset so
11856 we know stub section sizes, and select plt_branch stubs where
11857 long_branch stubs won't do. */
11858
11859 static bfd_boolean
11860 ppc_size_one_stub (struct bfd_hash_entry *gen_entry, void *in_arg)
11861 {
11862 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
11863 struct bfd_link_info *info;
11864 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
11865 asection *plt;
11866 bfd_vma targ, off, r2off;
11867 unsigned int size, extra, lr_used, delta, odd;
11868
11869 /* Massage our args to the form they really have. */
11870 stub_entry = (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *) gen_entry;
11871 info = in_arg;
11872
11873 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
11874 if (htab == NULL)
11875 return FALSE;
11876
11877 /* Make a note of the offset within the stubs for this entry. */
11878 stub_entry->stub_offset = stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size;
11879
11880 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
11881 && stub_entry->h->save_res
11882 && stub_entry->h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
11883 && stub_entry->h->elf.root.u.def.section == htab->sfpr)
11884 {
11885 /* Don't make stubs to out-of-line register save/restore
11886 functions. Instead, emit copies of the functions. */
11887 stub_entry->group->needs_save_res = 1;
11888 stub_entry->stub_type = ppc_stub_save_res;
11889 return TRUE;
11890 }
11891
11892 switch (stub_entry->stub_type)
11893 {
11894 case ppc_stub_plt_branch:
11895 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off:
11896 /* Reset the stub type from the plt branch variant in case we now
11897 can reach with a shorter stub. */
11898 stub_entry->stub_type += ppc_stub_long_branch - ppc_stub_plt_branch;
11899 /* Fall through. */
11900 case ppc_stub_long_branch:
11901 case ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off:
11902 targ = (stub_entry->target_value
11903 + stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
11904 + stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
11905 targ += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (stub_entry->other);
11906 off = (stub_entry->stub_offset
11907 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
11908 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
11909
11910 size = 4;
11911 r2off = 0;
11912 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off)
11913 {
11914 r2off = get_r2off (info, stub_entry);
11915 if (r2off == (bfd_vma) -1)
11916 {
11917 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
11918 return FALSE;
11919 }
11920 size = 8;
11921 if (PPC_HA (r2off) != 0)
11922 size += 4;
11923 if (PPC_LO (r2off) != 0)
11924 size += 4;
11925 off += size - 4;
11926 }
11927 off = targ - off;
11928
11929 /* If the branch offset is too big, use a ppc_stub_plt_branch.
11930 Do the same for -R objects without function descriptors. */
11931 if ((stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off
11932 && r2off == 0
11933 && htab->sec_info[stub_entry->target_section->id].toc_off == 0)
11934 || off + (1 << 25) >= (bfd_vma) (1 << 26))
11935 {
11936 struct ppc_branch_hash_entry *br_entry;
11937
11938 br_entry = ppc_branch_hash_lookup (&htab->branch_hash_table,
11939 stub_entry->root.string + 9,
11940 TRUE, FALSE);
11941 if (br_entry == NULL)
11942 {
11943 _bfd_error_handler (_("can't build branch stub `%s'"),
11944 stub_entry->root.string);
11945 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
11946 return FALSE;
11947 }
11948
11949 if (br_entry->iter != htab->stub_iteration)
11950 {
11951 br_entry->iter = htab->stub_iteration;
11952 br_entry->offset = htab->brlt->size;
11953 htab->brlt->size += 8;
11954
11955 if (htab->relbrlt != NULL)
11956 htab->relbrlt->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
11957 else if (info->emitrelocations)
11958 {
11959 htab->brlt->reloc_count += 1;
11960 htab->brlt->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
11961 }
11962 }
11963
11964 targ = (br_entry->offset
11965 + htab->brlt->output_offset
11966 + htab->brlt->output_section->vma);
11967 off = (elf_gp (info->output_bfd)
11968 + htab->sec_info[stub_entry->group->link_sec->id].toc_off);
11969 off = targ - off;
11970
11971 if (info->emitrelocations)
11972 {
11973 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count
11974 += 1 + (PPC_HA (off) != 0);
11975 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
11976 }
11977
11978 stub_entry->stub_type += ppc_stub_plt_branch - ppc_stub_long_branch;
11979 if (stub_entry->stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off)
11980 {
11981 size = 12;
11982 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
11983 size = 16;
11984 }
11985 else
11986 {
11987 size = 16;
11988 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
11989 size += 4;
11990
11991 if (PPC_HA (r2off) != 0)
11992 size += 4;
11993 if (PPC_LO (r2off) != 0)
11994 size += 4;
11995 }
11996 }
11997 else if (info->emitrelocations)
11998 {
11999 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count += 1;
12000 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
12001 }
12002 break;
12003
12004 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc:
12005 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_both:
12006 stub_entry->stub_type += ppc_stub_long_branch - ppc_stub_plt_branch;
12007 /* Fall through. */
12008 case ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc:
12009 case ppc_stub_long_branch_both:
12010 off = (stub_entry->stub_offset
12011 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
12012 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
12013 size = 0;
12014 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both)
12015 size = 4;
12016 off += size;
12017 targ = (stub_entry->target_value
12018 + stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
12019 + stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
12020 odd = off & 4;
12021 off = targ - off;
12022
12023 if (info->emitrelocations)
12024 {
12025 unsigned int num_rel;
12026 if (htab->powerxx_stubs)
12027 num_rel = num_relocs_for_powerxx_offset (off, odd);
12028 else
12029 num_rel = num_relocs_for_offset (off - 8);
12030 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count += num_rel;
12031 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
12032 }
12033
12034 if (htab->powerxx_stubs)
12035 extra = size_powerxx_offset (off, odd);
12036 else
12037 extra = size_offset (off - 8);
12038 /* Include branch insn plus those in the offset sequence. */
12039 size += 4 + extra;
12040 /* The branch insn is at the end, or "extra" bytes along. So
12041 its offset will be "extra" bytes less that that already
12042 calculated. */
12043 off -= extra;
12044
12045 if (!htab->powerxx_stubs)
12046 {
12047 /* After the bcl, lr has been modified so we need to emit
12048 .eh_frame info saying the return address is in r12. */
12049 lr_used = stub_entry->stub_offset + 8;
12050 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both)
12051 lr_used += 4;
12052 /* The eh_frame info will consist of a DW_CFA_advance_loc or
12053 variant, DW_CFA_register, 65, 12, DW_CFA_advance_loc+2,
12054 DW_CFA_restore_extended 65. */
12055 delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
12056 stub_entry->group->eh_size += eh_advance_size (delta) + 6;
12057 stub_entry->group->lr_restore = lr_used + 8;
12058 }
12059
12060 /* If the branch can't reach, use a plt_branch. */
12061 if (off + (1 << 25) >= (bfd_vma) (1 << 26))
12062 {
12063 stub_entry->stub_type += (ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc
12064 - ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc);
12065 size += 4;
12066 }
12067 else if (info->emitrelocations)
12068 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count +=1;
12069 break;
12070
12071 case ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc:
12072 case ppc_stub_plt_call_both:
12073 off = (stub_entry->stub_offset
12074 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
12075 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
12076 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
12077 off += 4;
12078 targ = stub_entry->plt_ent->plt.offset & ~1;
12079 if (targ >= (bfd_vma) -2)
12080 abort ();
12081
12082 plt = htab->elf.splt;
12083 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
12084 || stub_entry->h == NULL
12085 || stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx == -1)
12086 {
12087 if (stub_entry->symtype == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
12088 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
12089 else
12090 plt = htab->pltlocal;
12091 }
12092 targ += plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
12093 odd = off & 4;
12094 off = targ - off;
12095
12096 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align != 0)
12097 {
12098 unsigned pad = plt_stub_pad (htab, stub_entry, off);
12099
12100 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size += pad;
12101 stub_entry->stub_offset = stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size;
12102 off -= pad;
12103 }
12104
12105 if (info->emitrelocations)
12106 {
12107 unsigned int num_rel;
12108 if (htab->powerxx_stubs)
12109 num_rel = num_relocs_for_powerxx_offset (off, odd);
12110 else
12111 num_rel = num_relocs_for_offset (off - 8);
12112 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count += num_rel;
12113 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
12114 }
12115
12116 size = plt_stub_size (htab, stub_entry, off);
12117
12118 if (!htab->powerxx_stubs)
12119 {
12120 /* After the bcl, lr has been modified so we need to emit
12121 .eh_frame info saying the return address is in r12. */
12122 lr_used = stub_entry->stub_offset + 8;
12123 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
12124 lr_used += 4;
12125 /* The eh_frame info will consist of a DW_CFA_advance_loc or
12126 variant, DW_CFA_register, 65, 12, DW_CFA_advance_loc+2,
12127 DW_CFA_restore_extended 65. */
12128 delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
12129 stub_entry->group->eh_size += eh_advance_size (delta) + 6;
12130 stub_entry->group->lr_restore = lr_used + 8;
12131 }
12132 break;
12133
12134 case ppc_stub_plt_call:
12135 case ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save:
12136 targ = stub_entry->plt_ent->plt.offset & ~(bfd_vma) 1;
12137 if (targ >= (bfd_vma) -2)
12138 abort ();
12139 plt = htab->elf.splt;
12140 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
12141 || stub_entry->h == NULL
12142 || stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx == -1)
12143 {
12144 if (stub_entry->symtype == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
12145 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
12146 else
12147 plt = htab->pltlocal;
12148 }
12149 targ += plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
12150
12151 off = (elf_gp (info->output_bfd)
12152 + htab->sec_info[stub_entry->group->link_sec->id].toc_off);
12153 off = targ - off;
12154
12155 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align != 0)
12156 {
12157 unsigned pad = plt_stub_pad (htab, stub_entry, off);
12158
12159 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size += pad;
12160 stub_entry->stub_offset = stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size;
12161 }
12162
12163 if (info->emitrelocations)
12164 {
12165 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count
12166 += ((PPC_HA (off) != 0)
12167 + (htab->opd_abi
12168 ? 2 + (htab->params->plt_static_chain
12169 && PPC_HA (off + 16) == PPC_HA (off))
12170 : 1));
12171 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
12172 }
12173
12174 size = plt_stub_size (htab, stub_entry, off);
12175
12176 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
12177 && is_tls_get_addr (&stub_entry->h->elf, htab)
12178 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt
12179 && stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
12180 {
12181 if (htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_regsave)
12182 {
12183 lr_used = stub_entry->stub_offset + size - 20;
12184 /* The eh_frame info will consist of a DW_CFA_advance_loc
12185 or variant, DW_CFA_offset_externed_sf, 65, -stackoff,
12186 DW_CFA_advance_loc+4, DW_CFA_restore_extended, 65. */
12187 delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
12188 stub_entry->group->eh_size += eh_advance_size (delta) + 6;
12189 }
12190 else
12191 {
12192 /* Adjustments to r1 need to be described. */
12193 unsigned int cfa_updt = stub_entry->stub_offset + 18 * 4;
12194 delta = cfa_updt - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
12195 stub_entry->group->eh_size += eh_advance_size (delta);
12196 stub_entry->group->eh_size += htab->opd_abi ? 36 : 35;
12197 }
12198 stub_entry->group->lr_restore = size - 4;
12199 }
12200 break;
12201
12202 default:
12203 BFD_FAIL ();
12204 return FALSE;
12205 }
12206
12207 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size += size;
12208 return TRUE;
12209 }
12210
12211 /* Set up various things so that we can make a list of input sections
12212 for each output section included in the link. Returns -1 on error,
12213 0 when no stubs will be needed, and 1 on success. */
12214
12215 int
12216 ppc64_elf_setup_section_lists (struct bfd_link_info *info)
12217 {
12218 unsigned int id;
12219 bfd_size_type amt;
12220 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12221
12222 if (htab == NULL)
12223 return -1;
12224
12225 htab->sec_info_arr_size = _bfd_section_id;
12226 amt = sizeof (*htab->sec_info) * (htab->sec_info_arr_size);
12227 htab->sec_info = bfd_zmalloc (amt);
12228 if (htab->sec_info == NULL)
12229 return -1;
12230
12231 /* Set toc_off for com, und, abs and ind sections. */
12232 for (id = 0; id < 3; id++)
12233 htab->sec_info[id].toc_off = TOC_BASE_OFF;
12234
12235 return 1;
12236 }
12237
12238 /* Set up for first pass at multitoc partitioning. */
12239
12240 void
12241 ppc64_elf_start_multitoc_partition (struct bfd_link_info *info)
12242 {
12243 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12244
12245 htab->toc_curr = ppc64_elf_set_toc (info, info->output_bfd);
12246 htab->toc_bfd = NULL;
12247 htab->toc_first_sec = NULL;
12248 }
12249
12250 /* The linker repeatedly calls this function for each TOC input section
12251 and linker generated GOT section. Group input bfds such that the toc
12252 within a group is less than 64k in size. */
12253
12254 bfd_boolean
12255 ppc64_elf_next_toc_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *isec)
12256 {
12257 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12258 bfd_vma addr, off, limit;
12259
12260 if (htab == NULL)
12261 return FALSE;
12262
12263 if (!htab->second_toc_pass)
12264 {
12265 /* Keep track of the first .toc or .got section for this input bfd. */
12266 bfd_boolean new_bfd = htab->toc_bfd != isec->owner;
12267
12268 if (new_bfd)
12269 {
12270 htab->toc_bfd = isec->owner;
12271 htab->toc_first_sec = isec;
12272 }
12273
12274 addr = isec->output_offset + isec->output_section->vma;
12275 off = addr - htab->toc_curr;
12276 limit = 0x80008000;
12277 if (ppc64_elf_tdata (isec->owner)->has_small_toc_reloc)
12278 limit = 0x10000;
12279 if (off + isec->size > limit)
12280 {
12281 addr = (htab->toc_first_sec->output_offset
12282 + htab->toc_first_sec->output_section->vma);
12283 htab->toc_curr = addr;
12284 htab->toc_curr &= -TOC_BASE_ALIGN;
12285 }
12286
12287 /* toc_curr is the base address of this toc group. Set elf_gp
12288 for the input section to be the offset relative to the
12289 output toc base plus 0x8000. Making the input elf_gp an
12290 offset allows us to move the toc as a whole without
12291 recalculating input elf_gp. */
12292 off = htab->toc_curr - elf_gp (info->output_bfd);
12293 off += TOC_BASE_OFF;
12294
12295 /* Die if someone uses a linker script that doesn't keep input
12296 file .toc and .got together. */
12297 if (new_bfd
12298 && elf_gp (isec->owner) != 0
12299 && elf_gp (isec->owner) != off)
12300 return FALSE;
12301
12302 elf_gp (isec->owner) = off;
12303 return TRUE;
12304 }
12305
12306 /* During the second pass toc_first_sec points to the start of
12307 a toc group, and toc_curr is used to track the old elf_gp.
12308 We use toc_bfd to ensure we only look at each bfd once. */
12309 if (htab->toc_bfd == isec->owner)
12310 return TRUE;
12311 htab->toc_bfd = isec->owner;
12312
12313 if (htab->toc_first_sec == NULL
12314 || htab->toc_curr != elf_gp (isec->owner))
12315 {
12316 htab->toc_curr = elf_gp (isec->owner);
12317 htab->toc_first_sec = isec;
12318 }
12319 addr = (htab->toc_first_sec->output_offset
12320 + htab->toc_first_sec->output_section->vma);
12321 off = addr - elf_gp (info->output_bfd) + TOC_BASE_OFF;
12322 elf_gp (isec->owner) = off;
12323
12324 return TRUE;
12325 }
12326
12327 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse to merge GOT entries for global
12328 symbol H. */
12329
12330 static bfd_boolean
12331 merge_global_got (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
12332 {
12333 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
12334 return TRUE;
12335
12336 merge_got_entries (&h->got.glist);
12337
12338 return TRUE;
12339 }
12340
12341 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse to allocate GOT entries for global
12342 symbol H. */
12343
12344 static bfd_boolean
12345 reallocate_got (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
12346 {
12347 struct got_entry *gent;
12348
12349 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
12350 return TRUE;
12351
12352 for (gent = h->got.glist; gent != NULL; gent = gent->next)
12353 if (!gent->is_indirect)
12354 allocate_got (h, (struct bfd_link_info *) inf, gent);
12355 return TRUE;
12356 }
12357
12358 /* Called on the first multitoc pass after the last call to
12359 ppc64_elf_next_toc_section. This function removes duplicate GOT
12360 entries. */
12361
12362 bfd_boolean
12363 ppc64_elf_layout_multitoc (struct bfd_link_info *info)
12364 {
12365 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12366 struct bfd *ibfd, *ibfd2;
12367 bfd_boolean done_something;
12368
12369 htab->multi_toc_needed = htab->toc_curr != elf_gp (info->output_bfd);
12370
12371 if (!htab->do_multi_toc)
12372 return FALSE;
12373
12374 /* Merge global sym got entries within a toc group. */
12375 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, merge_global_got, info);
12376
12377 /* And tlsld_got. */
12378 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
12379 {
12380 struct got_entry *ent, *ent2;
12381
12382 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
12383 continue;
12384
12385 ent = ppc64_tlsld_got (ibfd);
12386 if (!ent->is_indirect
12387 && ent->got.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
12388 {
12389 for (ibfd2 = ibfd->link.next; ibfd2 != NULL; ibfd2 = ibfd2->link.next)
12390 {
12391 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd2))
12392 continue;
12393
12394 ent2 = ppc64_tlsld_got (ibfd2);
12395 if (!ent2->is_indirect
12396 && ent2->got.offset != (bfd_vma) -1
12397 && elf_gp (ibfd2) == elf_gp (ibfd))
12398 {
12399 ent2->is_indirect = TRUE;
12400 ent2->got.ent = ent;
12401 }
12402 }
12403 }
12404 }
12405
12406 /* Zap sizes of got sections. */
12407 htab->elf.irelplt->rawsize = htab->elf.irelplt->size;
12408 htab->elf.irelplt->size -= htab->got_reli_size;
12409 htab->got_reli_size = 0;
12410
12411 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
12412 {
12413 asection *got, *relgot;
12414
12415 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
12416 continue;
12417
12418 got = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
12419 if (got != NULL)
12420 {
12421 got->rawsize = got->size;
12422 got->size = 0;
12423 relgot = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
12424 relgot->rawsize = relgot->size;
12425 relgot->size = 0;
12426 }
12427 }
12428
12429 /* Now reallocate the got, local syms first. We don't need to
12430 allocate section contents again since we never increase size. */
12431 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
12432 {
12433 struct got_entry **lgot_ents;
12434 struct got_entry **end_lgot_ents;
12435 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
12436 struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
12437 unsigned char *lgot_masks;
12438 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
12439 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
12440 asection *s;
12441
12442 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
12443 continue;
12444
12445 lgot_ents = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd);
12446 if (!lgot_ents)
12447 continue;
12448
12449 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
12450 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
12451 end_lgot_ents = lgot_ents + locsymcount;
12452 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_lgot_ents;
12453 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
12454 lgot_masks = (unsigned char *) end_local_plt;
12455 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
12456 for (; lgot_ents < end_lgot_ents; ++lgot_ents, ++lgot_masks)
12457 {
12458 struct got_entry *ent;
12459
12460 for (ent = *lgot_ents; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
12461 {
12462 unsigned int ent_size = 8;
12463 unsigned int rel_size = sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
12464
12465 ent->got.offset = s->size;
12466 if ((ent->tls_type & *lgot_masks & TLS_GD) != 0)
12467 {
12468 ent_size *= 2;
12469 rel_size *= 2;
12470 }
12471 s->size += ent_size;
12472 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
12473 {
12474 htab->elf.irelplt->size += rel_size;
12475 htab->got_reli_size += rel_size;
12476 }
12477 else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
12478 && !(ent->tls_type != 0
12479 && bfd_link_executable (info)))
12480 {
12481 asection *srel = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
12482 srel->size += rel_size;
12483 }
12484 }
12485 }
12486 }
12487
12488 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, reallocate_got, info);
12489
12490 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
12491 {
12492 struct got_entry *ent;
12493
12494 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
12495 continue;
12496
12497 ent = ppc64_tlsld_got (ibfd);
12498 if (!ent->is_indirect
12499 && ent->got.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
12500 {
12501 asection *s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
12502 ent->got.offset = s->size;
12503 s->size += 16;
12504 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
12505 {
12506 asection *srel = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
12507 srel->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
12508 }
12509 }
12510 }
12511
12512 done_something = htab->elf.irelplt->rawsize != htab->elf.irelplt->size;
12513 if (!done_something)
12514 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
12515 {
12516 asection *got;
12517
12518 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
12519 continue;
12520
12521 got = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
12522 if (got != NULL)
12523 {
12524 done_something = got->rawsize != got->size;
12525 if (done_something)
12526 break;
12527 }
12528 }
12529
12530 if (done_something)
12531 (*htab->params->layout_sections_again) ();
12532
12533 /* Set up for second pass over toc sections to recalculate elf_gp
12534 on input sections. */
12535 htab->toc_bfd = NULL;
12536 htab->toc_first_sec = NULL;
12537 htab->second_toc_pass = TRUE;
12538 return done_something;
12539 }
12540
12541 /* Called after second pass of multitoc partitioning. */
12542
12543 void
12544 ppc64_elf_finish_multitoc_partition (struct bfd_link_info *info)
12545 {
12546 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12547
12548 /* After the second pass, toc_curr tracks the TOC offset used
12549 for code sections below in ppc64_elf_next_input_section. */
12550 htab->toc_curr = TOC_BASE_OFF;
12551 }
12552
12553 /* No toc references were found in ISEC. If the code in ISEC makes no
12554 calls, then there's no need to use toc adjusting stubs when branching
12555 into ISEC. Actually, indirect calls from ISEC are OK as they will
12556 load r2. Returns -1 on error, 0 for no stub needed, 1 for stub
12557 needed, and 2 if a cyclical call-graph was found but no other reason
12558 for a stub was detected. If called from the top level, a return of
12559 2 means the same as a return of 0. */
12560
12561 static int
12562 toc_adjusting_stub_needed (struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *isec)
12563 {
12564 int ret;
12565
12566 /* Mark this section as checked. */
12567 isec->call_check_done = 1;
12568
12569 /* We know none of our code bearing sections will need toc stubs. */
12570 if ((isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
12571 return 0;
12572
12573 if (isec->size == 0)
12574 return 0;
12575
12576 if (isec->output_section == NULL)
12577 return 0;
12578
12579 ret = 0;
12580 if (isec->reloc_count != 0)
12581 {
12582 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel;
12583 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
12584 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
12585
12586 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (isec->owner, isec, NULL, NULL,
12587 info->keep_memory);
12588 if (relstart == NULL)
12589 return -1;
12590
12591 /* Look for branches to outside of this section. */
12592 local_syms = NULL;
12593 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12594 if (htab == NULL)
12595 return -1;
12596
12597 for (rel = relstart; rel < relstart + isec->reloc_count; ++rel)
12598 {
12599 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
12600 unsigned long r_symndx;
12601 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
12602 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
12603 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
12604 asection *sym_sec;
12605 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
12606 bfd_vma sym_value;
12607 bfd_vma dest;
12608
12609 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
12610 if (r_type != R_PPC64_REL24
12611 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
12612 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14
12613 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN
12614 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN
12615 && r_type != R_PPC64_PLTCALL
12616 && r_type != R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC)
12617 continue;
12618
12619 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
12620 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms, r_symndx,
12621 isec->owner))
12622 {
12623 ret = -1;
12624 break;
12625 }
12626
12627 /* Calls to dynamic lib functions go through a plt call stub
12628 that uses r2. */
12629 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
12630 if (eh != NULL
12631 && (eh->elf.plt.plist != NULL
12632 || (eh->oh != NULL
12633 && ppc_follow_link (eh->oh)->elf.plt.plist != NULL)))
12634 {
12635 ret = 1;
12636 break;
12637 }
12638
12639 if (sym_sec == NULL)
12640 /* Ignore other undefined symbols. */
12641 continue;
12642
12643 /* Assume branches to other sections not included in the
12644 link need stubs too, to cover -R and absolute syms. */
12645 if (sym_sec->output_section == NULL)
12646 {
12647 ret = 1;
12648 break;
12649 }
12650
12651 if (h == NULL)
12652 sym_value = sym->st_value;
12653 else
12654 {
12655 if (h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
12656 && h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
12657 abort ();
12658 sym_value = h->root.u.def.value;
12659 }
12660 sym_value += rel->r_addend;
12661
12662 /* If this branch reloc uses an opd sym, find the code section. */
12663 opd = get_opd_info (sym_sec);
12664 if (opd != NULL)
12665 {
12666 if (h == NULL && opd->adjust != NULL)
12667 {
12668 long adjust;
12669
12670 adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (sym_value)];
12671 if (adjust == -1)
12672 /* Assume deleted functions won't ever be called. */
12673 continue;
12674 sym_value += adjust;
12675 }
12676
12677 dest = opd_entry_value (sym_sec, sym_value,
12678 &sym_sec, NULL, FALSE);
12679 if (dest == (bfd_vma) -1)
12680 continue;
12681 }
12682 else
12683 dest = (sym_value
12684 + sym_sec->output_offset
12685 + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
12686
12687 /* Ignore branch to self. */
12688 if (sym_sec == isec)
12689 continue;
12690
12691 /* If the called function uses the toc, we need a stub. */
12692 if (sym_sec->has_toc_reloc
12693 || sym_sec->makes_toc_func_call)
12694 {
12695 ret = 1;
12696 break;
12697 }
12698
12699 /* Assume any branch that needs a long branch stub might in fact
12700 need a plt_branch stub. A plt_branch stub uses r2. */
12701 else if (dest - (isec->output_offset
12702 + isec->output_section->vma
12703 + rel->r_offset) + (1 << 25)
12704 >= (2u << 25) - PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (h
12705 ? h->other
12706 : sym->st_other))
12707 {
12708 ret = 1;
12709 break;
12710 }
12711
12712 /* If calling back to a section in the process of being
12713 tested, we can't say for sure that no toc adjusting stubs
12714 are needed, so don't return zero. */
12715 else if (sym_sec->call_check_in_progress)
12716 ret = 2;
12717
12718 /* Branches to another section that itself doesn't have any TOC
12719 references are OK. Recursively call ourselves to check. */
12720 else if (!sym_sec->call_check_done)
12721 {
12722 int recur;
12723
12724 /* Mark current section as indeterminate, so that other
12725 sections that call back to current won't be marked as
12726 known. */
12727 isec->call_check_in_progress = 1;
12728 recur = toc_adjusting_stub_needed (info, sym_sec);
12729 isec->call_check_in_progress = 0;
12730
12731 if (recur != 0)
12732 {
12733 ret = recur;
12734 if (recur != 2)
12735 break;
12736 }
12737 }
12738 }
12739
12740 if (local_syms != NULL
12741 && (elf_symtab_hdr (isec->owner).contents
12742 != (unsigned char *) local_syms))
12743 free (local_syms);
12744 if (elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != relstart)
12745 free (relstart);
12746 }
12747
12748 if ((ret & 1) == 0
12749 && isec->map_head.s != NULL
12750 && (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
12751 || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0))
12752 {
12753 if (isec->map_head.s->has_toc_reloc
12754 || isec->map_head.s->makes_toc_func_call)
12755 ret = 1;
12756 else if (!isec->map_head.s->call_check_done)
12757 {
12758 int recur;
12759 isec->call_check_in_progress = 1;
12760 recur = toc_adjusting_stub_needed (info, isec->map_head.s);
12761 isec->call_check_in_progress = 0;
12762 if (recur != 0)
12763 ret = recur;
12764 }
12765 }
12766
12767 if (ret == 1)
12768 isec->makes_toc_func_call = 1;
12769
12770 return ret;
12771 }
12772
12773 /* The linker repeatedly calls this function for each input section,
12774 in the order that input sections are linked into output sections.
12775 Build lists of input sections to determine groupings between which
12776 we may insert linker stubs. */
12777
12778 bfd_boolean
12779 ppc64_elf_next_input_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *isec)
12780 {
12781 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12782
12783 if (htab == NULL)
12784 return FALSE;
12785
12786 if ((isec->output_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
12787 && isec->output_section->id < htab->sec_info_arr_size)
12788 {
12789 /* This happens to make the list in reverse order,
12790 which is what we want. */
12791 htab->sec_info[isec->id].u.list
12792 = htab->sec_info[isec->output_section->id].u.list;
12793 htab->sec_info[isec->output_section->id].u.list = isec;
12794 }
12795
12796 if (htab->multi_toc_needed)
12797 {
12798 /* Analyse sections that aren't already flagged as needing a
12799 valid toc pointer. Exclude .fixup for the linux kernel.
12800 .fixup contains branches, but only back to the function that
12801 hit an exception. */
12802 if (!(isec->has_toc_reloc
12803 || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
12804 || strcmp (isec->name, ".fixup") == 0
12805 || isec->call_check_done))
12806 {
12807 if (toc_adjusting_stub_needed (info, isec) < 0)
12808 return FALSE;
12809 }
12810 /* Make all sections use the TOC assigned for this object file.
12811 This will be wrong for pasted sections; We fix that in
12812 check_pasted_section(). */
12813 if (elf_gp (isec->owner) != 0)
12814 htab->toc_curr = elf_gp (isec->owner);
12815 }
12816
12817 htab->sec_info[isec->id].toc_off = htab->toc_curr;
12818 return TRUE;
12819 }
12820
12821 /* Check that all .init and .fini sections use the same toc, if they
12822 have toc relocs. */
12823
12824 static bfd_boolean
12825 check_pasted_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, const char *name)
12826 {
12827 asection *o = bfd_get_section_by_name (info->output_bfd, name);
12828
12829 if (o != NULL)
12830 {
12831 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12832 bfd_vma toc_off = 0;
12833 asection *i;
12834
12835 for (i = o->map_head.s; i != NULL; i = i->map_head.s)
12836 if (i->has_toc_reloc)
12837 {
12838 if (toc_off == 0)
12839 toc_off = htab->sec_info[i->id].toc_off;
12840 else if (toc_off != htab->sec_info[i->id].toc_off)
12841 return FALSE;
12842 }
12843
12844 if (toc_off == 0)
12845 for (i = o->map_head.s; i != NULL; i = i->map_head.s)
12846 if (i->makes_toc_func_call)
12847 {
12848 toc_off = htab->sec_info[i->id].toc_off;
12849 break;
12850 }
12851
12852 /* Make sure the whole pasted function uses the same toc offset. */
12853 if (toc_off != 0)
12854 for (i = o->map_head.s; i != NULL; i = i->map_head.s)
12855 htab->sec_info[i->id].toc_off = toc_off;
12856 }
12857 return TRUE;
12858 }
12859
12860 bfd_boolean
12861 ppc64_elf_check_init_fini (struct bfd_link_info *info)
12862 {
12863 return (check_pasted_section (info, ".init")
12864 & check_pasted_section (info, ".fini"));
12865 }
12866
12867 /* See whether we can group stub sections together. Grouping stub
12868 sections may result in fewer stubs. More importantly, we need to
12869 put all .init* and .fini* stubs at the beginning of the .init or
12870 .fini output sections respectively, because glibc splits the
12871 _init and _fini functions into multiple parts. Putting a stub in
12872 the middle of a function is not a good idea. */
12873
12874 static bfd_boolean
12875 group_sections (struct bfd_link_info *info,
12876 bfd_size_type stub_group_size,
12877 bfd_boolean stubs_always_before_branch)
12878 {
12879 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
12880 asection *osec;
12881 bfd_boolean suppress_size_errors;
12882
12883 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12884 if (htab == NULL)
12885 return FALSE;
12886
12887 suppress_size_errors = FALSE;
12888 if (stub_group_size == 1)
12889 {
12890 /* Default values. */
12891 if (stubs_always_before_branch)
12892 stub_group_size = 0x1e00000;
12893 else
12894 stub_group_size = 0x1c00000;
12895 suppress_size_errors = TRUE;
12896 }
12897
12898 for (osec = info->output_bfd->sections; osec != NULL; osec = osec->next)
12899 {
12900 asection *tail;
12901
12902 if (osec->id >= htab->sec_info_arr_size)
12903 continue;
12904
12905 tail = htab->sec_info[osec->id].u.list;
12906 while (tail != NULL)
12907 {
12908 asection *curr;
12909 asection *prev;
12910 bfd_size_type total;
12911 bfd_boolean big_sec;
12912 bfd_vma curr_toc;
12913 struct map_stub *group;
12914 bfd_size_type group_size;
12915
12916 curr = tail;
12917 total = tail->size;
12918 group_size = (ppc64_elf_section_data (tail) != NULL
12919 && ppc64_elf_section_data (tail)->has_14bit_branch
12920 ? stub_group_size >> 10 : stub_group_size);
12921
12922 big_sec = total > group_size;
12923 if (big_sec && !suppress_size_errors)
12924 /* xgettext:c-format */
12925 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB section %pA exceeds stub group size"),
12926 tail->owner, tail);
12927 curr_toc = htab->sec_info[tail->id].toc_off;
12928
12929 while ((prev = htab->sec_info[curr->id].u.list) != NULL
12930 && ((total += curr->output_offset - prev->output_offset)
12931 < (ppc64_elf_section_data (prev) != NULL
12932 && ppc64_elf_section_data (prev)->has_14bit_branch
12933 ? (group_size = stub_group_size >> 10) : group_size))
12934 && htab->sec_info[prev->id].toc_off == curr_toc)
12935 curr = prev;
12936
12937 /* OK, the size from the start of CURR to the end is less
12938 than group_size and thus can be handled by one stub
12939 section. (or the tail section is itself larger than
12940 group_size, in which case we may be toast.) We should
12941 really be keeping track of the total size of stubs added
12942 here, as stubs contribute to the final output section
12943 size. That's a little tricky, and this way will only
12944 break if stubs added make the total size more than 2^25,
12945 ie. for the default stub_group_size, if stubs total more
12946 than 2097152 bytes, or nearly 75000 plt call stubs. */
12947 group = bfd_alloc (curr->owner, sizeof (*group));
12948 if (group == NULL)
12949 return FALSE;
12950 group->link_sec = curr;
12951 group->stub_sec = NULL;
12952 group->needs_save_res = 0;
12953 group->lr_restore = 0;
12954 group->eh_size = 0;
12955 group->eh_base = 0;
12956 group->next = htab->group;
12957 htab->group = group;
12958 do
12959 {
12960 prev = htab->sec_info[tail->id].u.list;
12961 /* Set up this stub group. */
12962 htab->sec_info[tail->id].u.group = group;
12963 }
12964 while (tail != curr && (tail = prev) != NULL);
12965
12966 /* But wait, there's more! Input sections up to group_size
12967 bytes before the stub section can be handled by it too.
12968 Don't do this if we have a really large section after the
12969 stubs, as adding more stubs increases the chance that
12970 branches may not reach into the stub section. */
12971 if (!stubs_always_before_branch && !big_sec)
12972 {
12973 total = 0;
12974 while (prev != NULL
12975 && ((total += tail->output_offset - prev->output_offset)
12976 < (ppc64_elf_section_data (prev) != NULL
12977 && ppc64_elf_section_data (prev)->has_14bit_branch
12978 ? (group_size = stub_group_size >> 10)
12979 : group_size))
12980 && htab->sec_info[prev->id].toc_off == curr_toc)
12981 {
12982 tail = prev;
12983 prev = htab->sec_info[tail->id].u.list;
12984 htab->sec_info[tail->id].u.group = group;
12985 }
12986 }
12987 tail = prev;
12988 }
12989 }
12990 return TRUE;
12991 }
12992
12993 static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] =
12994 {
12995 0, 0, 0, 16, /* length. */
12996 0, 0, 0, 0, /* id. */
12997 1, /* CIE version. */
12998 'z', 'R', 0, /* Augmentation string. */
12999 4, /* Code alignment. */
13000 0x78, /* Data alignment. */
13001 65, /* RA reg. */
13002 1, /* Augmentation size. */
13003 DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4, /* FDE encoding. */
13004 DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0 /* def_cfa: r1 offset 0. */
13005 };
13006
13007 /* Stripping output sections is normally done before dynamic section
13008 symbols have been allocated. This function is called later, and
13009 handles cases like htab->brlt which is mapped to its own output
13010 section. */
13011
13012 static void
13013 maybe_strip_output (struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *isec)
13014 {
13015 if (isec->size == 0
13016 && isec->output_section->size == 0
13017 && !(isec->output_section->flags & SEC_KEEP)
13018 && !bfd_section_removed_from_list (info->output_bfd,
13019 isec->output_section)
13020 && elf_section_data (isec->output_section)->dynindx == 0)
13021 {
13022 isec->output_section->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
13023 bfd_section_list_remove (info->output_bfd, isec->output_section);
13024 info->output_bfd->section_count--;
13025 }
13026 }
13027
13028 /* Determine and set the size of the stub section for a final link.
13029
13030 The basic idea here is to examine all the relocations looking for
13031 PC-relative calls to a target that is unreachable with a "bl"
13032 instruction. */
13033
13034 bfd_boolean
13035 ppc64_elf_size_stubs (struct bfd_link_info *info)
13036 {
13037 bfd_size_type stub_group_size;
13038 bfd_boolean stubs_always_before_branch;
13039 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
13040
13041 if (htab == NULL)
13042 return FALSE;
13043
13044 if (htab->params->plt_thread_safe == -1 && !bfd_link_executable (info))
13045 htab->params->plt_thread_safe = 1;
13046 if (!htab->opd_abi)
13047 htab->params->plt_thread_safe = 0;
13048 else if (htab->params->plt_thread_safe == -1)
13049 {
13050 static const char *const thread_starter[] =
13051 {
13052 "pthread_create",
13053 /* libstdc++ */
13054 "_ZNSt6thread15_M_start_threadESt10shared_ptrINS_10_Impl_baseEE",
13055 /* librt */
13056 "aio_init", "aio_read", "aio_write", "aio_fsync", "lio_listio",
13057 "mq_notify", "create_timer",
13058 /* libanl */
13059 "getaddrinfo_a",
13060 /* libgomp */
13061 "GOMP_parallel",
13062 "GOMP_parallel_start",
13063 "GOMP_parallel_loop_static",
13064 "GOMP_parallel_loop_static_start",
13065 "GOMP_parallel_loop_dynamic",
13066 "GOMP_parallel_loop_dynamic_start",
13067 "GOMP_parallel_loop_guided",
13068 "GOMP_parallel_loop_guided_start",
13069 "GOMP_parallel_loop_runtime",
13070 "GOMP_parallel_loop_runtime_start",
13071 "GOMP_parallel_sections",
13072 "GOMP_parallel_sections_start",
13073 /* libgo */
13074 "__go_go",
13075 };
13076 unsigned i;
13077
13078 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (thread_starter); i++)
13079 {
13080 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
13081 h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, thread_starter[i],
13082 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
13083 htab->params->plt_thread_safe = h != NULL && h->ref_regular;
13084 if (htab->params->plt_thread_safe)
13085 break;
13086 }
13087 }
13088 stubs_always_before_branch = htab->params->group_size < 0;
13089 if (htab->params->group_size < 0)
13090 stub_group_size = -htab->params->group_size;
13091 else
13092 stub_group_size = htab->params->group_size;
13093
13094 if (!group_sections (info, stub_group_size, stubs_always_before_branch))
13095 return FALSE;
13096
13097 htab->tga_group = NULL;
13098 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_regsave
13099 && htab->tga_desc_fd != NULL
13100 && (htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
13101 || htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
13102 && htab->tls_get_addr_fd != NULL
13103 && is_static_defined (&htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf))
13104 {
13105 asection *sym_sec, *code_sec, *stub_sec;
13106 bfd_vma sym_value;
13107 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
13108
13109 sym_sec = htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf.root.u.def.section;
13110 sym_value = defined_sym_val (&htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf);
13111 code_sec = sym_sec;
13112 opd = get_opd_info (sym_sec);
13113 if (opd != NULL)
13114 opd_entry_value (sym_sec, sym_value, &code_sec, NULL, FALSE);
13115 htab->tga_group = htab->sec_info[code_sec->id].u.group;
13116 stub_sec = (*htab->params->add_stub_section) (".tga_desc.stub",
13117 htab->tga_group->link_sec);
13118 if (stub_sec == NULL)
13119 return FALSE;
13120 htab->tga_group->stub_sec = stub_sec;
13121
13122 htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
13123 htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.root.u.def.section = stub_sec;
13124 htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.root.u.def.value = 0;
13125 htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.type = STT_FUNC;
13126 htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.def_regular = 1;
13127 htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.non_elf = 0;
13128 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &htab->tga_desc_fd->elf, TRUE);
13129 }
13130
13131 #define STUB_SHRINK_ITER 20
13132 /* Loop until no stubs added. After iteration 20 of this loop we may
13133 exit on a stub section shrinking. This is to break out of a
13134 pathological case where adding stubs on one iteration decreases
13135 section gaps (perhaps due to alignment), which then requires
13136 fewer or smaller stubs on the next iteration. */
13137
13138 while (1)
13139 {
13140 bfd *input_bfd;
13141 unsigned int bfd_indx;
13142 struct map_stub *group;
13143
13144 htab->stub_iteration += 1;
13145
13146 for (input_bfd = info->input_bfds, bfd_indx = 0;
13147 input_bfd != NULL;
13148 input_bfd = input_bfd->link.next, bfd_indx++)
13149 {
13150 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
13151 asection *section;
13152 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
13153
13154 if (!is_ppc64_elf (input_bfd))
13155 continue;
13156
13157 /* We'll need the symbol table in a second. */
13158 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
13159 if (symtab_hdr->sh_info == 0)
13160 continue;
13161
13162 /* Walk over each section attached to the input bfd. */
13163 for (section = input_bfd->sections;
13164 section != NULL;
13165 section = section->next)
13166 {
13167 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs, *irelaend, *irela;
13168
13169 /* If there aren't any relocs, then there's nothing more
13170 to do. */
13171 if ((section->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
13172 || (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
13173 || (section->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0
13174 || (section->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
13175 || section->reloc_count == 0)
13176 continue;
13177
13178 /* If this section is a link-once section that will be
13179 discarded, then don't create any stubs. */
13180 if (section->output_section == NULL
13181 || section->output_section->owner != info->output_bfd)
13182 continue;
13183
13184 /* Get the relocs. */
13185 internal_relocs
13186 = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (input_bfd, section, NULL, NULL,
13187 info->keep_memory);
13188 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
13189 goto error_ret_free_local;
13190
13191 /* Now examine each relocation. */
13192 irela = internal_relocs;
13193 irelaend = irela + section->reloc_count;
13194 for (; irela < irelaend; irela++)
13195 {
13196 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
13197 unsigned int r_indx;
13198 enum ppc_stub_type stub_type;
13199 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
13200 asection *sym_sec, *code_sec;
13201 bfd_vma sym_value, code_value;
13202 bfd_vma destination;
13203 unsigned long local_off;
13204 bfd_boolean ok_dest;
13205 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *hash;
13206 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
13207 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
13208 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
13209 char *stub_name;
13210 const asection *id_sec;
13211 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
13212 struct plt_entry *plt_ent;
13213
13214 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (irela->r_info);
13215 r_indx = ELF64_R_SYM (irela->r_info);
13216
13217 if (r_type >= R_PPC64_max)
13218 {
13219 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
13220 goto error_ret_free_internal;
13221 }
13222
13223 /* Only look for stubs on branch instructions. */
13224 if (r_type != R_PPC64_REL24
13225 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
13226 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14
13227 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN
13228 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
13229 continue;
13230
13231 /* Now determine the call target, its name, value,
13232 section. */
13233 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
13234 r_indx, input_bfd))
13235 goto error_ret_free_internal;
13236 hash = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
13237
13238 ok_dest = FALSE;
13239 fdh = NULL;
13240 sym_value = 0;
13241 if (hash == NULL)
13242 {
13243 sym_value = sym->st_value;
13244 if (sym_sec != NULL
13245 && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
13246 ok_dest = TRUE;
13247 }
13248 else if (hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
13249 || hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
13250 {
13251 sym_value = hash->elf.root.u.def.value;
13252 if (sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
13253 ok_dest = TRUE;
13254 }
13255 else if (hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
13256 || hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
13257 {
13258 /* Recognise an old ABI func code entry sym, and
13259 use the func descriptor sym instead if it is
13260 defined. */
13261 if (hash->elf.root.root.string[0] == '.'
13262 && hash->oh != NULL)
13263 {
13264 fdh = ppc_follow_link (hash->oh);
13265 if (fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
13266 || fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
13267 {
13268 sym_sec = fdh->elf.root.u.def.section;
13269 sym_value = fdh->elf.root.u.def.value;
13270 if (sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
13271 ok_dest = TRUE;
13272 }
13273 else
13274 fdh = NULL;
13275 }
13276 }
13277 else
13278 {
13279 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
13280 goto error_ret_free_internal;
13281 }
13282
13283 destination = 0;
13284 local_off = 0;
13285 if (ok_dest)
13286 {
13287 sym_value += irela->r_addend;
13288 destination = (sym_value
13289 + sym_sec->output_offset
13290 + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
13291 local_off = PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (hash
13292 ? hash->elf.other
13293 : sym->st_other);
13294 }
13295
13296 code_sec = sym_sec;
13297 code_value = sym_value;
13298 opd = get_opd_info (sym_sec);
13299 if (opd != NULL)
13300 {
13301 bfd_vma dest;
13302
13303 if (hash == NULL && opd->adjust != NULL)
13304 {
13305 long adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (sym_value)];
13306 if (adjust == -1)
13307 continue;
13308 code_value += adjust;
13309 sym_value += adjust;
13310 }
13311 dest = opd_entry_value (sym_sec, sym_value,
13312 &code_sec, &code_value, FALSE);
13313 if (dest != (bfd_vma) -1)
13314 {
13315 destination = dest;
13316 if (fdh != NULL)
13317 {
13318 /* Fixup old ABI sym to point at code
13319 entry. */
13320 hash->elf.root.type = bfd_link_hash_defweak;
13321 hash->elf.root.u.def.section = code_sec;
13322 hash->elf.root.u.def.value = code_value;
13323 }
13324 }
13325 }
13326
13327 /* Determine what (if any) linker stub is needed. */
13328 plt_ent = NULL;
13329 stub_type = ppc_type_of_stub (section, irela, &hash,
13330 &plt_ent, destination,
13331 local_off);
13332
13333 if (r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC)
13334 {
13335 if (stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call)
13336 stub_type = ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc;
13337 else if (stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch
13338 || (code_sec != NULL
13339 && code_sec->output_section != NULL
13340 && (((hash ? hash->elf.other : sym->st_other)
13341 & STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK)
13342 > 1 << STO_PPC64_LOCAL_BIT)))
13343 stub_type = ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc;
13344 }
13345 else if (stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_call)
13346 {
13347 /* Check whether we need a TOC adjusting stub.
13348 Since the linker pastes together pieces from
13349 different object files when creating the
13350 _init and _fini functions, it may be that a
13351 call to what looks like a local sym is in
13352 fact a call needing a TOC adjustment. */
13353 if ((code_sec != NULL
13354 && code_sec->output_section != NULL
13355 && (htab->sec_info[code_sec->id].toc_off
13356 != htab->sec_info[section->id].toc_off)
13357 && (code_sec->has_toc_reloc
13358 || code_sec->makes_toc_func_call))
13359 || (((hash ? hash->elf.other : sym->st_other)
13360 & STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK)
13361 == 1 << STO_PPC64_LOCAL_BIT))
13362 stub_type = ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off;
13363 }
13364
13365 if (stub_type == ppc_stub_none)
13366 continue;
13367
13368 /* __tls_get_addr calls might be eliminated. */
13369 if (stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_call
13370 && stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc
13371 && hash != NULL
13372 && is_tls_get_addr (&hash->elf, htab)
13373 && section->has_tls_reloc
13374 && irela != internal_relocs)
13375 {
13376 /* Get tls info. */
13377 unsigned char *tls_mask;
13378
13379 if (!get_tls_mask (&tls_mask, NULL, NULL, &local_syms,
13380 irela - 1, input_bfd))
13381 goto error_ret_free_internal;
13382 if ((*tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
13383 && (*tls_mask & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) == 0)
13384 continue;
13385 }
13386
13387 if (stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call)
13388 {
13389 if (!htab->opd_abi
13390 && htab->params->plt_localentry0 != 0
13391 && is_elfv2_localentry0 (&hash->elf))
13392 htab->has_plt_localentry0 = 1;
13393 else if (irela + 1 < irelaend
13394 && irela[1].r_offset == irela->r_offset + 4
13395 && (ELF64_R_TYPE (irela[1].r_info)
13396 == R_PPC64_TOCSAVE))
13397 {
13398 if (!tocsave_find (htab, INSERT,
13399 &local_syms, irela + 1, input_bfd))
13400 goto error_ret_free_internal;
13401 }
13402 else
13403 stub_type = ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save;
13404 }
13405
13406 /* Support for grouping stub sections. */
13407 id_sec = htab->sec_info[section->id].u.group->link_sec;
13408
13409 /* Get the name of this stub. */
13410 stub_name = ppc_stub_name (id_sec, sym_sec, hash, irela);
13411 if (!stub_name)
13412 goto error_ret_free_internal;
13413
13414 stub_entry = ppc_stub_hash_lookup (&htab->stub_hash_table,
13415 stub_name, FALSE, FALSE);
13416 if (stub_entry != NULL)
13417 {
13418 enum ppc_stub_type old_type;
13419 /* A stub has already been created, but it may
13420 not be the required type. We shouldn't be
13421 transitioning from plt_call to long_branch
13422 stubs or vice versa, but we might be
13423 upgrading from plt_call to plt_call_r2save or
13424 from long_branch to long_branch_r2off. */
13425 free (stub_name);
13426 old_type = stub_entry->stub_type;
13427 switch (old_type)
13428 {
13429 default:
13430 abort ();
13431
13432 case ppc_stub_save_res:
13433 continue;
13434
13435 case ppc_stub_plt_call:
13436 case ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save:
13437 case ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc:
13438 case ppc_stub_plt_call_both:
13439 if (stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call)
13440 continue;
13441 else if (stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
13442 {
13443 if (old_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
13444 stub_type = ppc_stub_plt_call_both;
13445 }
13446 else if (stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
13447 {
13448 if (old_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
13449 stub_type = ppc_stub_plt_call_both;
13450 }
13451 else
13452 abort ();
13453 break;
13454
13455 case ppc_stub_plt_branch:
13456 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off:
13457 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc:
13458 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_both:
13459 old_type += (ppc_stub_long_branch
13460 - ppc_stub_plt_branch);
13461 /* Fall through. */
13462 case ppc_stub_long_branch:
13463 case ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off:
13464 case ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc:
13465 case ppc_stub_long_branch_both:
13466 if (stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch)
13467 continue;
13468 else if (stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off)
13469 {
13470 if (old_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc)
13471 stub_type = ppc_stub_long_branch_both;
13472 }
13473 else if (stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc)
13474 {
13475 if (old_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off)
13476 stub_type = ppc_stub_long_branch_both;
13477 }
13478 else
13479 abort ();
13480 break;
13481 }
13482 if (old_type < stub_type)
13483 stub_entry->stub_type = stub_type;
13484 continue;
13485 }
13486
13487 stub_entry = ppc_add_stub (stub_name, section, info);
13488 if (stub_entry == NULL)
13489 {
13490 free (stub_name);
13491 error_ret_free_internal:
13492 if (elf_section_data (section)->relocs == NULL)
13493 free (internal_relocs);
13494 error_ret_free_local:
13495 if (local_syms != NULL
13496 && (symtab_hdr->contents
13497 != (unsigned char *) local_syms))
13498 free (local_syms);
13499 return FALSE;
13500 }
13501
13502 stub_entry->stub_type = stub_type;
13503 if (stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
13504 && stub_type <= ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
13505 {
13506 stub_entry->target_value = sym_value;
13507 stub_entry->target_section = sym_sec;
13508 }
13509 else
13510 {
13511 stub_entry->target_value = code_value;
13512 stub_entry->target_section = code_sec;
13513 }
13514 stub_entry->h = hash;
13515 stub_entry->plt_ent = plt_ent;
13516 stub_entry->symtype
13517 = hash ? hash->elf.type : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info);
13518 stub_entry->other = hash ? hash->elf.other : sym->st_other;
13519
13520 if (hash != NULL
13521 && (hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
13522 || hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
13523 htab->stub_globals += 1;
13524 }
13525
13526 /* We're done with the internal relocs, free them. */
13527 if (elf_section_data (section)->relocs != internal_relocs)
13528 free (internal_relocs);
13529 }
13530
13531 if (local_syms != NULL
13532 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
13533 {
13534 if (!info->keep_memory)
13535 free (local_syms);
13536 else
13537 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
13538 }
13539 }
13540
13541 /* We may have added some stubs. Find out the new size of the
13542 stub sections. */
13543 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13544 {
13545 group->lr_restore = 0;
13546 group->eh_size = 0;
13547 if (group->stub_sec != NULL)
13548 {
13549 asection *stub_sec = group->stub_sec;
13550
13551 if (htab->stub_iteration <= STUB_SHRINK_ITER
13552 || stub_sec->rawsize < stub_sec->size)
13553 /* Past STUB_SHRINK_ITER, rawsize is the max size seen. */
13554 stub_sec->rawsize = stub_sec->size;
13555 stub_sec->size = 0;
13556 stub_sec->reloc_count = 0;
13557 stub_sec->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
13558 }
13559 }
13560 if (htab->tga_group != NULL)
13561 {
13562 /* See emit_tga_desc and emit_tga_desc_eh_frame. */
13563 htab->tga_group->eh_size
13564 = 1 + 2 + (htab->opd_abi != 0) + 3 + 8 * 2 + 3 + 8 + 3;
13565 htab->tga_group->lr_restore = 23 * 4;
13566 htab->tga_group->stub_sec->size = 24 * 4;
13567 }
13568
13569 if (htab->stub_iteration <= STUB_SHRINK_ITER
13570 || htab->brlt->rawsize < htab->brlt->size)
13571 htab->brlt->rawsize = htab->brlt->size;
13572 htab->brlt->size = 0;
13573 htab->brlt->reloc_count = 0;
13574 htab->brlt->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
13575 if (htab->relbrlt != NULL)
13576 htab->relbrlt->size = 0;
13577
13578 bfd_hash_traverse (&htab->stub_hash_table, ppc_size_one_stub, info);
13579
13580 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13581 if (group->needs_save_res)
13582 group->stub_sec->size += htab->sfpr->size;
13583
13584 if (info->emitrelocations
13585 && htab->glink != NULL && htab->glink->size != 0)
13586 {
13587 htab->glink->reloc_count = 1;
13588 htab->glink->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
13589 }
13590
13591 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
13592 && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section)
13593 && htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->size > 8)
13594 {
13595 size_t size = 0, align = 4;
13596
13597 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13598 if (group->eh_size != 0)
13599 size += (group->eh_size + 17 + align - 1) & -align;
13600 if (htab->glink != NULL && htab->glink->size != 0)
13601 size += (24 + align - 1) & -align;
13602 if (size != 0)
13603 size += (sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + align - 1) & -align;
13604 align = 1ul << htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->alignment_power;
13605 size = (size + align - 1) & -align;
13606 htab->glink_eh_frame->rawsize = htab->glink_eh_frame->size;
13607 htab->glink_eh_frame->size = size;
13608 }
13609
13610 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align != 0)
13611 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13612 if (group->stub_sec != NULL)
13613 {
13614 int align = abs (htab->params->plt_stub_align);
13615 group->stub_sec->size
13616 = (group->stub_sec->size + (1 << align) - 1) & -(1 << align);
13617 }
13618
13619 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13620 if (group->stub_sec != NULL
13621 && group->stub_sec->rawsize != group->stub_sec->size
13622 && (htab->stub_iteration <= STUB_SHRINK_ITER
13623 || group->stub_sec->rawsize < group->stub_sec->size))
13624 break;
13625
13626 if (group == NULL
13627 && (htab->brlt->rawsize == htab->brlt->size
13628 || (htab->stub_iteration > STUB_SHRINK_ITER
13629 && htab->brlt->rawsize > htab->brlt->size))
13630 && (htab->glink_eh_frame == NULL
13631 || htab->glink_eh_frame->rawsize == htab->glink_eh_frame->size)
13632 && (htab->tga_group == NULL
13633 || htab->stub_iteration > 1))
13634 break;
13635
13636 /* Ask the linker to do its stuff. */
13637 (*htab->params->layout_sections_again) ();
13638 }
13639
13640 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
13641 && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0)
13642 {
13643 bfd_vma val;
13644 bfd_byte *p, *last_fde;
13645 size_t last_fde_len, size, align, pad;
13646 struct map_stub *group;
13647
13648 /* It is necessary to at least have a rough outline of the
13649 linker generated CIEs and FDEs written before
13650 bfd_elf_discard_info is run, in order for these FDEs to be
13651 indexed in .eh_frame_hdr. */
13652 p = bfd_zalloc (htab->glink_eh_frame->owner, htab->glink_eh_frame->size);
13653 if (p == NULL)
13654 return FALSE;
13655 htab->glink_eh_frame->contents = p;
13656 last_fde = p;
13657 align = 4;
13658
13659 memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie));
13660 /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian). */
13661 last_fde_len = ((sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + align - 1) & -align) - 4;
13662 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, last_fde_len, p);
13663 p += last_fde_len + 4;
13664
13665 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13666 if (group->eh_size != 0)
13667 {
13668 group->eh_base = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
13669 last_fde = p;
13670 last_fde_len = ((group->eh_size + 17 + align - 1) & -align) - 4;
13671 /* FDE length. */
13672 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, last_fde_len, p);
13673 p += 4;
13674 /* CIE pointer. */
13675 val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
13676 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
13677 p += 4;
13678 /* Offset to stub section, written later. */
13679 p += 4;
13680 /* stub section size. */
13681 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, group->stub_sec->size, p);
13682 p += 4;
13683 /* Augmentation. */
13684 p += 1;
13685 /* Make sure we don't have all nops. This is enough for
13686 elf-eh-frame.c to detect the last non-nop opcode. */
13687 p[group->eh_size - 1] = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 1;
13688 p = last_fde + last_fde_len + 4;
13689 }
13690 if (htab->glink != NULL && htab->glink->size != 0)
13691 {
13692 last_fde = p;
13693 last_fde_len = ((24 + align - 1) & -align) - 4;
13694 /* FDE length. */
13695 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, last_fde_len, p);
13696 p += 4;
13697 /* CIE pointer. */
13698 val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
13699 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
13700 p += 4;
13701 /* Offset to .glink, written later. */
13702 p += 4;
13703 /* .glink size. */
13704 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size - 8, p);
13705 p += 4;
13706 /* Augmentation. */
13707 p += 1;
13708
13709 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 1;
13710 *p++ = DW_CFA_register;
13711 *p++ = 65;
13712 *p++ = htab->opd_abi ? 12 : 0;
13713 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + (htab->opd_abi ? 5 : 7);
13714 *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
13715 *p++ = 65;
13716 p += ((24 + align - 1) & -align) - 24;
13717 }
13718 /* Subsume any padding into the last FDE if user .eh_frame
13719 sections are aligned more than glink_eh_frame. Otherwise any
13720 zero padding will be seen as a terminator. */
13721 align = 1ul << htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->alignment_power;
13722 size = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
13723 pad = ((size + align - 1) & -align) - size;
13724 htab->glink_eh_frame->size = size + pad;
13725 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, last_fde_len + pad, last_fde);
13726 }
13727
13728 maybe_strip_output (info, htab->brlt);
13729 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL)
13730 maybe_strip_output (info, htab->glink_eh_frame);
13731
13732 return TRUE;
13733 }
13734
13735 /* Called after we have determined section placement. If sections
13736 move, we'll be called again. Provide a value for TOCstart. */
13737
13738 bfd_vma
13739 ppc64_elf_set_toc (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd *obfd)
13740 {
13741 asection *s;
13742 bfd_vma TOCstart, adjust;
13743
13744 if (info != NULL)
13745 {
13746 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
13747 struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
13748
13749 if (is_elf_hash_table (htab)
13750 && htab->hgot != NULL)
13751 h = htab->hgot;
13752 else
13753 {
13754 h = elf_link_hash_lookup (htab, ".TOC.", FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
13755 if (is_elf_hash_table (htab))
13756 htab->hgot = h;
13757 }
13758 if (h != NULL
13759 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
13760 && !h->root.linker_def
13761 && (!is_elf_hash_table (htab)
13762 || h->def_regular))
13763 {
13764 TOCstart = defined_sym_val (h) - TOC_BASE_OFF;
13765 _bfd_set_gp_value (obfd, TOCstart);
13766 return TOCstart;
13767 }
13768 }
13769
13770 /* The TOC consists of sections .got, .toc, .tocbss, .plt in that
13771 order. The TOC starts where the first of these sections starts. */
13772 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (obfd, ".got");
13773 if (s == NULL || (s->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
13774 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (obfd, ".toc");
13775 if (s == NULL || (s->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
13776 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (obfd, ".tocbss");
13777 if (s == NULL || (s->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
13778 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (obfd, ".plt");
13779 if (s == NULL || (s->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
13780 {
13781 /* This may happen for
13782 o references to TOC base (SYM@toc / TOC[tc0]) without a
13783 .toc directive
13784 o bad linker script
13785 o --gc-sections and empty TOC sections
13786
13787 FIXME: Warn user? */
13788
13789 /* Look for a likely section. We probably won't even be
13790 using TOCstart. */
13791 for (s = obfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
13792 if ((s->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_SMALL_DATA | SEC_READONLY
13793 | SEC_EXCLUDE))
13794 == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_SMALL_DATA))
13795 break;
13796 if (s == NULL)
13797 for (s = obfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
13798 if ((s->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_SMALL_DATA | SEC_EXCLUDE))
13799 == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_SMALL_DATA))
13800 break;
13801 if (s == NULL)
13802 for (s = obfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
13803 if ((s->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_READONLY | SEC_EXCLUDE))
13804 == SEC_ALLOC)
13805 break;
13806 if (s == NULL)
13807 for (s = obfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
13808 if ((s->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_ALLOC)
13809 break;
13810 }
13811
13812 TOCstart = 0;
13813 if (s != NULL)
13814 TOCstart = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
13815
13816 /* Force alignment. */
13817 adjust = TOCstart & (TOC_BASE_ALIGN - 1);
13818 TOCstart -= adjust;
13819 _bfd_set_gp_value (obfd, TOCstart);
13820
13821 if (info != NULL && s != NULL)
13822 {
13823 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
13824
13825 if (htab != NULL)
13826 {
13827 if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
13828 {
13829 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = TOC_BASE_OFF - adjust;
13830 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section = s;
13831 }
13832 }
13833 else
13834 {
13835 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh = NULL;
13836 _bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol (info, obfd, ".TOC.", BSF_GLOBAL,
13837 s, TOC_BASE_OFF - adjust,
13838 NULL, FALSE, FALSE, &bh);
13839 }
13840 }
13841 return TOCstart;
13842 }
13843
13844 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse from ppc64_elf_build_stubs to
13845 write out any global entry stubs, and PLT relocations. */
13846
13847 static bfd_boolean
13848 build_global_entry_stubs_and_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
13849 {
13850 struct bfd_link_info *info;
13851 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
13852 struct plt_entry *ent;
13853 asection *s;
13854
13855 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
13856 return TRUE;
13857
13858 info = inf;
13859 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
13860 if (htab == NULL)
13861 return FALSE;
13862
13863 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
13864 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
13865 {
13866 /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage
13867 table. Set it up. */
13868 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
13869 asection *plt, *relplt;
13870 bfd_byte *loc;
13871
13872 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
13873 || h->dynindx == -1)
13874 {
13875 if (!(h->def_regular
13876 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
13877 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)))
13878 continue;
13879 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
13880 {
13881 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
13882 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
13883 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
13884 if (htab->opd_abi)
13885 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_JMP_IREL);
13886 else
13887 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_IRELATIVE);
13888 }
13889 else
13890 {
13891 plt = htab->pltlocal;
13892 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
13893 {
13894 relplt = htab->relpltlocal;
13895 if (htab->opd_abi)
13896 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT);
13897 else
13898 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
13899 }
13900 else
13901 relplt = NULL;
13902 }
13903 rela.r_addend = defined_sym_val (h) + ent->addend;
13904
13905 if (relplt == NULL)
13906 {
13907 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
13908 bfd_put_64 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc);
13909 if (htab->opd_abi)
13910 {
13911 bfd_vma toc = elf_gp (info->output_bfd);
13912 toc += htab->sec_info[h->root.u.def.section->id].toc_off;
13913 bfd_put_64 (info->output_bfd, toc, loc + 8);
13914 }
13915 }
13916 else
13917 {
13918 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
13919 + plt->output_offset
13920 + ent->plt.offset);
13921 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
13922 * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
13923 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
13924 }
13925 }
13926 else
13927 {
13928 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
13929 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
13930 + ent->plt.offset);
13931 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT);
13932 rela.r_addend = ent->addend;
13933 loc = (htab->elf.srelplt->contents
13934 + ((ent->plt.offset - PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE (htab))
13935 / PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab) * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela)));
13936 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h))
13937 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
13938 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
13939 }
13940 }
13941
13942 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
13943 return TRUE;
13944
13945 if (h->def_regular)
13946 return TRUE;
13947
13948 s = htab->global_entry;
13949 if (s == NULL || s->size == 0)
13950 return TRUE;
13951
13952 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
13953 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1
13954 && ent->addend == 0)
13955 {
13956 bfd_byte *p;
13957 asection *plt;
13958 bfd_vma off;
13959
13960 p = s->contents + h->root.u.def.value;
13961 plt = htab->elf.splt;
13962 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
13963 || h->dynindx == -1)
13964 {
13965 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
13966 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
13967 else
13968 plt = htab->pltlocal;
13969 }
13970 off = ent->plt.offset + plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
13971 off -= h->root.u.def.value + s->output_offset + s->output_section->vma;
13972
13973 if (off + 0x80008000 > 0xffffffff || (off & 3) != 0)
13974 {
13975 info->callbacks->einfo
13976 (_("%P: linkage table error against `%pT'\n"),
13977 h->root.root.string);
13978 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
13979 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
13980 }
13981
13982 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_global_entry - 1] += 1;
13983 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
13984 {
13985 size_t len = strlen (h->root.root.string);
13986 char *name = bfd_malloc (sizeof "12345678.global_entry." + len);
13987
13988 if (name == NULL)
13989 return FALSE;
13990
13991 sprintf (name, "%08x.global_entry.%s", s->id, h->root.root.string);
13992 h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
13993 if (h == NULL)
13994 return FALSE;
13995 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
13996 {
13997 h->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
13998 h->root.u.def.section = s;
13999 h->root.u.def.value = p - s->contents;
14000 h->ref_regular = 1;
14001 h->def_regular = 1;
14002 h->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
14003 h->forced_local = 1;
14004 h->non_elf = 0;
14005 h->root.linker_def = 1;
14006 }
14007 }
14008
14009 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
14010 {
14011 bfd_put_32 (s->owner, ADDIS_R12_R12 | PPC_HA (off), p);
14012 p += 4;
14013 }
14014 bfd_put_32 (s->owner, LD_R12_0R12 | PPC_LO (off), p);
14015 p += 4;
14016 bfd_put_32 (s->owner, MTCTR_R12, p);
14017 p += 4;
14018 bfd_put_32 (s->owner, BCTR, p);
14019 break;
14020 }
14021 return TRUE;
14022 }
14023
14024 /* Write PLT relocs for locals. */
14025
14026 static bfd_boolean
14027 write_plt_relocs_for_local_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info)
14028 {
14029 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
14030 bfd *ibfd;
14031
14032 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
14033 {
14034 struct got_entry **lgot_ents, **end_lgot_ents;
14035 struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt;
14036 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
14037 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
14038 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
14039 struct plt_entry *ent;
14040
14041 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
14042 continue;
14043
14044 lgot_ents = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd);
14045 if (!lgot_ents)
14046 continue;
14047
14048 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
14049 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
14050 end_lgot_ents = lgot_ents + locsymcount;
14051 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_lgot_ents;
14052 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
14053 for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt)
14054 for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
14055 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
14056 {
14057 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
14058 asection *sym_sec;
14059 asection *plt, *relplt;
14060 bfd_byte *loc;
14061 bfd_vma val;
14062
14063 if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
14064 lplt - local_plt, ibfd))
14065 {
14066 if (local_syms != NULL
14067 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
14068 free (local_syms);
14069 return FALSE;
14070 }
14071
14072 val = sym->st_value + ent->addend;
14073 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
14074 val += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (sym->st_other);
14075 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
14076 val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma;
14077
14078 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
14079 {
14080 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
14081 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
14082 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
14083 }
14084 else
14085 {
14086 plt = htab->pltlocal;
14087 relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
14088 }
14089
14090 if (relplt == NULL)
14091 {
14092 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
14093 bfd_put_64 (info->output_bfd, val, loc);
14094 if (htab->opd_abi)
14095 {
14096 bfd_vma toc = elf_gp (ibfd);
14097 bfd_put_64 (info->output_bfd, toc, loc + 8);
14098 }
14099 }
14100 else
14101 {
14102 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
14103 rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset
14104 + plt->output_offset
14105 + plt->output_section->vma);
14106 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
14107 {
14108 if (htab->opd_abi)
14109 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_JMP_IREL);
14110 else
14111 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_IRELATIVE);
14112 }
14113 else
14114 {
14115 if (htab->opd_abi)
14116 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT);
14117 else
14118 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
14119 }
14120 rela.r_addend = val;
14121 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
14122 * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
14123 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
14124 }
14125 }
14126
14127 if (local_syms != NULL
14128 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
14129 {
14130 if (!info->keep_memory)
14131 free (local_syms);
14132 else
14133 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
14134 }
14135 }
14136 return TRUE;
14137 }
14138
14139 /* Emit the static wrapper function preserving registers around a
14140 __tls_get_addr_opt call. */
14141
14142 static bfd_boolean
14143 emit_tga_desc (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab)
14144 {
14145 asection *stub_sec = htab->tga_group->stub_sec;
14146 unsigned int cfa_updt = 11 * 4;
14147 bfd_byte *p;
14148 bfd_vma to, from, delta;
14149
14150 BFD_ASSERT (htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
14151 && htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.root.u.def.section == stub_sec
14152 && htab->tga_desc_fd->elf.root.u.def.value == 0);
14153 to = defined_sym_val (&htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf);
14154 from = defined_sym_val (&htab->tga_desc_fd->elf) + cfa_updt;
14155 delta = to - from;
14156 if (delta + (1 << 25) >= 1 << 26)
14157 {
14158 _bfd_error_handler (_("__tls_get_addr call offset overflow"));
14159 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
14160 return FALSE;
14161 }
14162
14163 p = stub_sec->contents;
14164 p = tls_get_addr_prologue (htab->elf.dynobj, p, htab);
14165 bfd_put_32 (stub_sec->owner, B_DOT | 1 | (delta & 0x3fffffc), p);
14166 p += 4;
14167 p = tls_get_addr_epilogue (htab->elf.dynobj, p, htab);
14168 return stub_sec->size == (bfd_size_type) (p - stub_sec->contents);
14169 }
14170
14171 /* Emit eh_frame describing the static wrapper function. */
14172
14173 static bfd_byte *
14174 emit_tga_desc_eh_frame (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab, bfd_byte *p)
14175 {
14176 unsigned int cfa_updt = 11 * 4;
14177 unsigned int i;
14178
14179 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + cfa_updt / 4;
14180 *p++ = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
14181 if (htab->opd_abi)
14182 {
14183 *p++ = 128;
14184 *p++ = 1;
14185 }
14186 else
14187 *p++ = 96;
14188 *p++ = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
14189 *p++ = 65;
14190 *p++ = (-16 / 8) & 0x7f;
14191 for (i = 4; i < 12; i++)
14192 {
14193 *p++ = DW_CFA_offset + i;
14194 *p++ = (htab->opd_abi ? 13 : 12) - i;
14195 }
14196 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 10;
14197 *p++ = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
14198 *p++ = 0;
14199 for (i = 4; i < 12; i++)
14200 *p++ = DW_CFA_restore + i;
14201 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 2;
14202 *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
14203 *p++ = 65;
14204 return p;
14205 }
14206
14207 /* Build all the stubs associated with the current output file.
14208 The stubs are kept in a hash table attached to the main linker
14209 hash table. This function is called via gldelf64ppc_finish. */
14210
14211 bfd_boolean
14212 ppc64_elf_build_stubs (struct bfd_link_info *info,
14213 char **stats)
14214 {
14215 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
14216 struct map_stub *group;
14217 asection *stub_sec;
14218 bfd_byte *p;
14219 int stub_sec_count = 0;
14220
14221 if (htab == NULL)
14222 return FALSE;
14223
14224 /* Allocate memory to hold the linker stubs. */
14225 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
14226 {
14227 group->eh_size = 0;
14228 group->lr_restore = 0;
14229 if ((stub_sec = group->stub_sec) != NULL
14230 && stub_sec->size != 0)
14231 {
14232 stub_sec->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->params->stub_bfd,
14233 stub_sec->size);
14234 if (stub_sec->contents == NULL)
14235 return FALSE;
14236 stub_sec->size = 0;
14237 }
14238 }
14239
14240 if (htab->glink != NULL && htab->glink->size != 0)
14241 {
14242 unsigned int indx;
14243 bfd_vma plt0;
14244
14245 /* Build the .glink plt call stub. */
14246 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
14247 {
14248 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
14249 h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve",
14250 TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
14251 if (h == NULL)
14252 return FALSE;
14253 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
14254 {
14255 h->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
14256 h->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
14257 h->root.u.def.value = 8;
14258 h->ref_regular = 1;
14259 h->def_regular = 1;
14260 h->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
14261 h->forced_local = 1;
14262 h->non_elf = 0;
14263 h->root.linker_def = 1;
14264 }
14265 }
14266 plt0 = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
14267 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
14268 - 16);
14269 if (info->emitrelocations)
14270 {
14271 Elf_Internal_Rela *r = get_relocs (htab->glink, 1);
14272 if (r == NULL)
14273 return FALSE;
14274 r->r_offset = (htab->glink->output_offset
14275 + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
14276 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL64);
14277 r->r_addend = plt0;
14278 }
14279 p = htab->glink->contents;
14280 plt0 -= htab->glink->output_section->vma + htab->glink->output_offset;
14281 bfd_put_64 (htab->glink->owner, plt0, p);
14282 p += 8;
14283 if (htab->opd_abi)
14284 {
14285 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MFLR_R12, p);
14286 p += 4;
14287 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, BCL_20_31, p);
14288 p += 4;
14289 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MFLR_R11, p);
14290 p += 4;
14291 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R2_0R11 | (-16 & 0xfffc), p);
14292 p += 4;
14293 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MTLR_R12, p);
14294 p += 4;
14295 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, ADD_R11_R2_R11, p);
14296 p += 4;
14297 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R12_0R11, p);
14298 p += 4;
14299 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R2_0R11 | 8, p);
14300 p += 4;
14301 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MTCTR_R12, p);
14302 p += 4;
14303 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R11_0R11 | 16, p);
14304 p += 4;
14305 }
14306 else
14307 {
14308 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MFLR_R0, p);
14309 p += 4;
14310 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, BCL_20_31, p);
14311 p += 4;
14312 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MFLR_R11, p);
14313 p += 4;
14314 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, STD_R2_0R1 + 24, p);
14315 p += 4;
14316 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R2_0R11 | (-16 & 0xfffc), p);
14317 p += 4;
14318 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MTLR_R0, p);
14319 p += 4;
14320 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, SUB_R12_R12_R11, p);
14321 p += 4;
14322 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, ADD_R11_R2_R11, p);
14323 p += 4;
14324 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, ADDI_R0_R12 | (-48 & 0xffff), p);
14325 p += 4;
14326 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R12_0R11, p);
14327 p += 4;
14328 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, SRDI_R0_R0_2, p);
14329 p += 4;
14330 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MTCTR_R12, p);
14331 p += 4;
14332 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R11_0R11 | 8, p);
14333 p += 4;
14334 }
14335 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, BCTR, p);
14336 p += 4;
14337 BFD_ASSERT (p == htab->glink->contents + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE (htab));
14338
14339 /* Build the .glink lazy link call stubs. */
14340 indx = 0;
14341 while (p < htab->glink->contents + htab->glink->size)
14342 {
14343 if (htab->opd_abi)
14344 {
14345 if (indx < 0x8000)
14346 {
14347 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LI_R0_0 | indx, p);
14348 p += 4;
14349 }
14350 else
14351 {
14352 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LIS_R0_0 | PPC_HI (indx), p);
14353 p += 4;
14354 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, ORI_R0_R0_0 | PPC_LO (indx),
14355 p);
14356 p += 4;
14357 }
14358 }
14359 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner,
14360 B_DOT | ((htab->glink->contents - p + 8) & 0x3fffffc), p);
14361 indx++;
14362 p += 4;
14363 }
14364 }
14365
14366 if (htab->tga_group != NULL)
14367 {
14368 htab->tga_group->lr_restore = 23 * 4;
14369 htab->tga_group->stub_sec->size = 24 * 4;
14370 if (!emit_tga_desc (htab))
14371 return FALSE;
14372 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
14373 && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0)
14374 {
14375 size_t align = 4;
14376
14377 p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
14378 p += (sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + align - 1) & -align;
14379 p += 17;
14380 htab->tga_group->eh_size = emit_tga_desc_eh_frame (htab, p) - p;
14381 }
14382 }
14383
14384 /* Build .glink global entry stubs, and PLT relocs for globals. */
14385 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, build_global_entry_stubs_and_plt, info);
14386
14387 if (!write_plt_relocs_for_local_syms (info))
14388 return FALSE;
14389
14390 if (htab->brlt != NULL && htab->brlt->size != 0)
14391 {
14392 htab->brlt->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->brlt->owner,
14393 htab->brlt->size);
14394 if (htab->brlt->contents == NULL)
14395 return FALSE;
14396 }
14397 if (htab->relbrlt != NULL && htab->relbrlt->size != 0)
14398 {
14399 htab->relbrlt->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->relbrlt->owner,
14400 htab->relbrlt->size);
14401 if (htab->relbrlt->contents == NULL)
14402 return FALSE;
14403 }
14404
14405 /* Build the stubs as directed by the stub hash table. */
14406 bfd_hash_traverse (&htab->stub_hash_table, ppc_build_one_stub, info);
14407
14408 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
14409 if (group->needs_save_res)
14410 group->stub_sec->size += htab->sfpr->size;
14411
14412 if (htab->relbrlt != NULL)
14413 htab->relbrlt->reloc_count = 0;
14414
14415 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align != 0)
14416 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
14417 if ((stub_sec = group->stub_sec) != NULL)
14418 {
14419 int align = abs (htab->params->plt_stub_align);
14420 stub_sec->size = (stub_sec->size + (1 << align) - 1) & -(1 << align);
14421 }
14422
14423 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
14424 if (group->needs_save_res)
14425 {
14426 stub_sec = group->stub_sec;
14427 memcpy (stub_sec->contents + stub_sec->size - htab->sfpr->size,
14428 htab->sfpr->contents, htab->sfpr->size);
14429 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
14430 {
14431 unsigned int i;
14432
14433 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (save_res_funcs); i++)
14434 if (!sfpr_define (info, &save_res_funcs[i], stub_sec))
14435 return FALSE;
14436 }
14437 }
14438
14439 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
14440 && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0)
14441 {
14442 bfd_vma val;
14443 size_t align = 4;
14444
14445 p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
14446 p += (sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + align - 1) & -align;
14447
14448 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
14449 if (group->eh_size != 0)
14450 {
14451 /* Offset to stub section. */
14452 val = (group->stub_sec->output_section->vma
14453 + group->stub_sec->output_offset);
14454 val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
14455 + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset
14456 + (p + 8 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents));
14457 if (val + 0x80000000 > 0xffffffff)
14458 {
14459 _bfd_error_handler
14460 (_("%s offset too large for .eh_frame sdata4 encoding"),
14461 group->stub_sec->name);
14462 return FALSE;
14463 }
14464 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p + 8);
14465 p += (group->eh_size + 17 + 3) & -4;
14466 }
14467 if (htab->glink != NULL && htab->glink->size != 0)
14468 {
14469 /* Offset to .glink. */
14470 val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
14471 + htab->glink->output_offset
14472 + 8);
14473 val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
14474 + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset
14475 + (p + 8 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents));
14476 if (val + 0x80000000 > 0xffffffff)
14477 {
14478 _bfd_error_handler
14479 (_("%s offset too large for .eh_frame sdata4 encoding"),
14480 htab->glink->name);
14481 return FALSE;
14482 }
14483 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p + 8);
14484 p += (24 + align - 1) & -align;
14485 }
14486 }
14487
14488 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
14489 if ((stub_sec = group->stub_sec) != NULL)
14490 {
14491 stub_sec_count += 1;
14492 if (stub_sec->rawsize != stub_sec->size
14493 && (htab->stub_iteration <= STUB_SHRINK_ITER
14494 || stub_sec->rawsize < stub_sec->size))
14495 break;
14496 }
14497
14498 if (group != NULL)
14499 {
14500 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
14501 _bfd_error_handler (_("stubs don't match calculated size"));
14502 }
14503
14504 if (htab->stub_error)
14505 return FALSE;
14506
14507 if (stats != NULL)
14508 {
14509 size_t len;
14510 *stats = bfd_malloc (500);
14511 if (*stats == NULL)
14512 return FALSE;
14513
14514 len = sprintf (*stats,
14515 ngettext ("linker stubs in %u group\n",
14516 "linker stubs in %u groups\n",
14517 stub_sec_count),
14518 stub_sec_count);
14519 sprintf (*stats + len, _(" branch %lu\n"
14520 " branch toc adj %lu\n"
14521 " branch notoc %lu\n"
14522 " branch both %lu\n"
14523 " long branch %lu\n"
14524 " long toc adj %lu\n"
14525 " long notoc %lu\n"
14526 " long both %lu\n"
14527 " plt call %lu\n"
14528 " plt call save %lu\n"
14529 " plt call notoc %lu\n"
14530 " plt call both %lu\n"
14531 " global entry %lu"),
14532 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_long_branch - 1],
14533 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off - 1],
14534 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc - 1],
14535 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_long_branch_both - 1],
14536 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_branch - 1],
14537 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off - 1],
14538 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc - 1],
14539 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_branch_both - 1],
14540 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_call - 1],
14541 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save - 1],
14542 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc - 1],
14543 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_call_both - 1],
14544 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_global_entry - 1]);
14545 }
14546 return TRUE;
14547 }
14548
14549 /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in
14550 discarded sections. */
14551
14552 static unsigned int
14553 ppc64_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec)
14554 {
14555 if (strcmp (".opd", sec->name) == 0)
14556 return 0;
14557
14558 if (strcmp (".toc", sec->name) == 0)
14559 return 0;
14560
14561 if (strcmp (".toc1", sec->name) == 0)
14562 return 0;
14563
14564 return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
14565 }
14566
14567 /* These are the dynamic relocations supported by glibc. */
14568
14569 static bfd_boolean
14570 ppc64_glibc_dynamic_reloc (enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type)
14571 {
14572 switch (r_type)
14573 {
14574 case R_PPC64_RELATIVE:
14575 case R_PPC64_NONE:
14576 case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
14577 case R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT:
14578 case R_PPC64_IRELATIVE:
14579 case R_PPC64_JMP_IREL:
14580 case R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT:
14581 case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
14582 case R_PPC64_DTPREL64:
14583 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
14584 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
14585 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
14586 case R_PPC64_TPREL16:
14587 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
14588 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI:
14589 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:
14590 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
14591 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
14592 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:
14593 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:
14594 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
14595 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
14596 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
14597 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO:
14598 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI:
14599 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH:
14600 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA:
14601 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA:
14602 case R_PPC64_REL30:
14603 case R_PPC64_COPY:
14604 case R_PPC64_UADDR64:
14605 case R_PPC64_UADDR32:
14606 case R_PPC64_ADDR32:
14607 case R_PPC64_ADDR24:
14608 case R_PPC64_ADDR16:
14609 case R_PPC64_UADDR16:
14610 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
14611 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER:
14612 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST:
14613 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA:
14614 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA:
14615 case R_PPC64_ADDR14:
14616 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
14617 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
14618 case R_PPC64_REL32:
14619 case R_PPC64_REL64:
14620 return TRUE;
14621
14622 default:
14623 return FALSE;
14624 }
14625 }
14626
14627 /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker
14628 to handle the relocations for a section.
14629
14630 The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section
14631 actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be
14632 zero.
14633
14634 This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as
14635 necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a
14636 relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as
14637 necessary.
14638
14639 This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc
14640 address or the reloc symbol index.
14641
14642 LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols.
14643
14644 LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file
14645 corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol.
14646
14647 The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found
14648 via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd).
14649
14650 When generating relocatable output, this function must handle
14651 STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially. The output symbol is
14652 going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output
14653 section, which means that the addend must be adjusted
14654 accordingly. */
14655
14656 static bfd_boolean
14657 ppc64_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
14658 struct bfd_link_info *info,
14659 bfd *input_bfd,
14660 asection *input_section,
14661 bfd_byte *contents,
14662 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
14663 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
14664 asection **local_sections)
14665 {
14666 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
14667 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
14668 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
14669 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
14670 Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
14671 Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
14672 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
14673 bfd_byte *loc;
14674 struct got_entry **local_got_ents;
14675 bfd_vma TOCstart;
14676 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
14677 bfd_boolean is_opd;
14678 /* Assume 'at' branch hints. */
14679 bfd_boolean is_isa_v2 = TRUE;
14680 bfd_boolean warned_dynamic = FALSE;
14681 bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0);
14682
14683 /* Initialize howto table if needed. */
14684 if (!ppc64_elf_howto_table[R_PPC64_ADDR32])
14685 ppc_howto_init ();
14686
14687 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
14688 if (htab == NULL)
14689 return FALSE;
14690
14691 /* Don't relocate stub sections. */
14692 if (input_section->owner == htab->params->stub_bfd)
14693 return TRUE;
14694
14695 if (!is_ppc64_elf (input_bfd))
14696 {
14697 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
14698 return FALSE;
14699 }
14700
14701 local_got_ents = elf_local_got_ents (input_bfd);
14702 TOCstart = elf_gp (output_bfd);
14703 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
14704 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
14705 is_opd = ppc64_elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_type == sec_opd;
14706
14707 rel = wrel = relocs;
14708 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
14709 for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
14710 {
14711 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
14712 bfd_vma addend;
14713 bfd_reloc_status_type r;
14714 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
14715 asection *sec;
14716 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h_elf;
14717 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h;
14718 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
14719 const char *sym_name;
14720 unsigned long r_symndx, toc_symndx;
14721 bfd_vma toc_addend;
14722 unsigned char tls_mask, tls_gd, tls_type;
14723 unsigned char sym_type;
14724 bfd_vma relocation;
14725 bfd_boolean unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc;
14726 bfd_boolean warned;
14727 enum { DEST_NORMAL, DEST_OPD, DEST_STUB } reloc_dest;
14728 unsigned int insn;
14729 unsigned int mask;
14730 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
14731 bfd_vma max_br_offset;
14732 bfd_vma from;
14733 Elf_Internal_Rela orig_rel;
14734 reloc_howto_type *howto;
14735 struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto;
14736 uint64_t pinsn;
14737 bfd_vma offset;
14738
14739 again:
14740 orig_rel = *rel;
14741
14742 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
14743 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
14744
14745 /* For old style R_PPC64_TOC relocs with a zero symbol, use the
14746 symbol of the previous ADDR64 reloc. The symbol gives us the
14747 proper TOC base to use. */
14748 if (rel->r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC)
14749 && wrel != relocs
14750 && ELF64_R_TYPE (wrel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC64_ADDR64
14751 && is_opd)
14752 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (wrel[-1].r_info);
14753
14754 sym = NULL;
14755 sec = NULL;
14756 h_elf = NULL;
14757 sym_name = NULL;
14758 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
14759 warned = FALSE;
14760
14761 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
14762 {
14763 /* It's a local symbol. */
14764 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
14765
14766 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
14767 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
14768 sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec);
14769 sym_type = ELF64_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info);
14770 relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
14771 opd = get_opd_info (sec);
14772 if (opd != NULL && opd->adjust != NULL)
14773 {
14774 long adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (sym->st_value
14775 + rel->r_addend)];
14776 if (adjust == -1)
14777 relocation = 0;
14778 else
14779 {
14780 /* If this is a relocation against the opd section sym
14781 and we have edited .opd, adjust the reloc addend so
14782 that ld -r and ld --emit-relocs output is correct.
14783 If it is a reloc against some other .opd symbol,
14784 then the symbol value will be adjusted later. */
14785 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
14786 rel->r_addend += adjust;
14787 else
14788 relocation += adjust;
14789 }
14790 }
14791 }
14792 else
14793 {
14794 bfd_boolean ignored;
14795
14796 RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
14797 r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
14798 h_elf, sec, relocation,
14799 unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
14800 sym_name = h_elf->root.root.string;
14801 sym_type = h_elf->type;
14802 if (sec != NULL
14803 && sec->owner == output_bfd
14804 && strcmp (sec->name, ".opd") == 0)
14805 {
14806 /* This is a symbol defined in a linker script. All
14807 such are defined in output sections, even those
14808 defined by simple assignment from a symbol defined in
14809 an input section. Transfer the symbol to an
14810 appropriate input .opd section, so that a branch to
14811 this symbol will be mapped to the location specified
14812 by the opd entry. */
14813 struct bfd_link_order *lo;
14814 for (lo = sec->map_head.link_order; lo != NULL; lo = lo->next)
14815 if (lo->type == bfd_indirect_link_order)
14816 {
14817 asection *isec = lo->u.indirect.section;
14818 if (h_elf->root.u.def.value >= isec->output_offset
14819 && h_elf->root.u.def.value < (isec->output_offset
14820 + isec->size))
14821 {
14822 h_elf->root.u.def.value -= isec->output_offset;
14823 h_elf->root.u.def.section = isec;
14824 sec = isec;
14825 break;
14826 }
14827 }
14828 }
14829 }
14830 h = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h_elf);
14831
14832 if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
14833 {
14834 _bfd_clear_contents (ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type],
14835 input_bfd, input_section,
14836 contents, rel->r_offset);
14837 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
14838 wrel->r_info = 0;
14839 wrel->r_addend = 0;
14840
14841 /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
14842 symbols defined in discarded sections. Not done for
14843 non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the
14844 eh_frame editing code expects to be present. */
14845 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
14846 && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
14847 wrel--;
14848
14849 continue;
14850 }
14851
14852 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
14853 goto copy_reloc;
14854
14855 if (h != NULL && &h->elf == htab->elf.hgot)
14856 {
14857 relocation = TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
14858 sec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
14859 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
14860 }
14861
14862 /* TLS optimizations. Replace instruction sequences and relocs
14863 based on information we collected in tls_optimize. We edit
14864 RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible
14865 for the final instruction stream. */
14866 tls_mask = 0;
14867 tls_gd = 0;
14868 toc_symndx = 0;
14869 if (h != NULL)
14870 tls_mask = h->tls_mask;
14871 else if (local_got_ents != NULL)
14872 {
14873 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
14874 (local_got_ents + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
14875 unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
14876 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
14877 tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx];
14878 }
14879 if (((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0 || tls_mask == (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
14880 && (r_type == R_PPC64_TLS
14881 || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSGD
14882 || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSLD))
14883 {
14884 /* Check for toc tls entries. */
14885 unsigned char *toc_tls;
14886
14887 if (!get_tls_mask (&toc_tls, &toc_symndx, &toc_addend,
14888 &local_syms, rel, input_bfd))
14889 return FALSE;
14890
14891 if (toc_tls)
14892 tls_mask = *toc_tls;
14893 }
14894
14895 /* Check that tls relocs are used with tls syms, and non-tls
14896 relocs are used with non-tls syms. */
14897 if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF
14898 && r_type != R_PPC64_NONE
14899 && (h == NULL
14900 || h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
14901 || h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
14902 && IS_PPC64_TLS_RELOC (r_type) != (sym_type == STT_TLS))
14903 {
14904 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
14905 && (r_type == R_PPC64_TLS
14906 || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSGD
14907 || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSLD))
14908 /* R_PPC64_TLS is OK against a symbol in the TOC. */
14909 ;
14910 else
14911 info->callbacks->einfo
14912 (!IS_PPC64_TLS_RELOC (r_type)
14913 /* xgettext:c-format */
14914 ? _("%H: %s used with TLS symbol `%pT'\n")
14915 /* xgettext:c-format */
14916 : _("%H: %s used with non-TLS symbol `%pT'\n"),
14917 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
14918 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name,
14919 sym_name);
14920 }
14921
14922 /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane. */
14923 if (R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS != R_PPC64_TOC16_DS + 1
14924 || R_PPC64_TOC16_LO != R_PPC64_TOC16 + 1
14925 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)
14926 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3)
14927 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3)
14928 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3)
14929 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS & 3)
14930 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS & 3)
14931 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3)
14932 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3))
14933 abort ();
14934
14935 switch (r_type)
14936 {
14937 default:
14938 break;
14939
14940 case R_PPC64_LO_DS_OPT:
14941 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
14942 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) != 58u << 26)
14943 abort ();
14944 insn += (14u << 26) - (58u << 26);
14945 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
14946 r_type = R_PPC64_TOC16_LO;
14947 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
14948 break;
14949
14950 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
14951 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
14952 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
14953 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
14954 {
14955 /* Check for toc tls entries. */
14956 unsigned char *toc_tls;
14957 int retval;
14958
14959 retval = get_tls_mask (&toc_tls, &toc_symndx, &toc_addend,
14960 &local_syms, rel, input_bfd);
14961 if (retval == 0)
14962 return FALSE;
14963
14964 if (toc_tls)
14965 {
14966 tls_mask = *toc_tls;
14967 if (r_type == R_PPC64_TOC16_DS
14968 || r_type == R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS)
14969 {
14970 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
14971 && (tls_mask & (TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL)) == 0)
14972 goto toctprel;
14973 }
14974 else
14975 {
14976 /* If we found a GD reloc pair, then we might be
14977 doing a GD->IE transition. */
14978 if (retval == 2)
14979 {
14980 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
14981 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
14982 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
14983 goto tls_ldgd_opt;
14984 }
14985 else if (retval == 3)
14986 {
14987 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
14988 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
14989 goto tls_ldgd_opt;
14990 }
14991 }
14992 }
14993 }
14994 break;
14995
14996 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
14997 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
14998 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
14999 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
15000 {
15001 rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
15002 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
15003 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
15004 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15005 }
15006 break;
15007
15008 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS:
15009 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
15010 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
15011 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
15012 {
15013 toctprel:
15014 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
15015 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
15016 insn &= 31 << 21;
15017 insn |= 0x3c0d0000; /* addis 0,13,0 */
15018 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
15019 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
15020 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA;
15021 if (toc_symndx != 0)
15022 {
15023 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (toc_symndx, r_type);
15024 rel->r_addend = toc_addend;
15025 /* We changed the symbol. Start over in order to
15026 get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
15027 goto again;
15028 }
15029 else
15030 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15031 }
15032 break;
15033
15034 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL34:
15035 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
15036 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
15037 {
15038 /* pld ra,sym@got@tprel@pcrel -> paddi ra,r13,sym@tprel */
15039 pinsn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
15040 pinsn <<= 32;
15041 pinsn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15042 pinsn += ((2ULL << 56) + (-1ULL << 52)
15043 + (14ULL << 26) - (57ULL << 26) + (13ULL << 16));
15044 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn >> 32,
15045 contents + rel->r_offset);
15046 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn & 0xffffffff,
15047 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15048 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL34;
15049 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15050 }
15051 break;
15052
15053 case R_PPC64_TLS:
15054 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
15055 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
15056 {
15057 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
15058 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 13);
15059 if (insn == 0)
15060 break;
15061 if ((rel->r_offset & 3) == 0)
15062 {
15063 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
15064 /* Was PPC64_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now
15065 PPC64_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word. */
15066 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
15067 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO;
15068 if (toc_symndx != 0)
15069 {
15070 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (toc_symndx, r_type);
15071 rel->r_addend = toc_addend;
15072 /* We changed the symbol. Start over in order to
15073 get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
15074 goto again;
15075 }
15076 else
15077 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15078 }
15079 else if ((rel->r_offset & 3) == 1)
15080 {
15081 /* For pcrel IE to LE we already have the full
15082 offset and thus don't need an addi here. A nop
15083 or mr will do. */
15084 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14 << 26)
15085 {
15086 /* Extract regs from addi rt,ra,si. */
15087 unsigned int rt = (insn >> 21) & 0x1f;
15088 unsigned int ra = (insn >> 16) & 0x1f;
15089 if (rt == ra)
15090 insn = NOP;
15091 else
15092 {
15093 /* Build or ra,rs,rb with rb==rs, ie. mr ra,rs. */
15094 insn = (rt << 16) | (ra << 21) | (ra << 11);
15095 insn |= (31u << 26) | (444u << 1);
15096 }
15097 }
15098 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset - 1);
15099 }
15100 }
15101 break;
15102
15103 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
15104 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
15105 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
15106 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
15107 goto tls_gdld_hi;
15108 break;
15109
15110 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
15111 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
15112 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
15113 {
15114 tls_gdld_hi:
15115 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
15116 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
15117 + R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS);
15118 else
15119 {
15120 rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
15121 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
15122 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
15123 }
15124 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15125 }
15126 break;
15127
15128 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16:
15129 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
15130 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
15131 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
15132 goto tls_ldgd_opt;
15133 break;
15134
15135 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16:
15136 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
15137 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
15138 {
15139 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
15140
15141 tls_ldgd_opt:
15142 offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
15143 /* If not using the newer R_PPC64_TLSGD/LD to mark
15144 __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call
15145 stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next
15146 reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with
15147 the current reloc. Edit both insns. */
15148 if (input_section->nomark_tls_get_addr
15149 && rel + 1 < relend
15150 && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1,
15151 htab->tls_get_addr_fd,
15152 htab->tga_desc_fd,
15153 htab->tls_get_addr,
15154 htab->tga_desc))
15155 offset = rel[1].r_offset;
15156 /* We read the low GOT_TLS (or TOC16) insn because we
15157 need to keep the destination reg. It may be
15158 something other than the usual r3, and moved to r3
15159 before the call by intervening code. */
15160 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
15161 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
15162 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
15163 {
15164 /* IE */
15165 insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16);
15166 insn1 |= 58u << 26; /* ld */
15167 insn2 = 0x7c636a14; /* add 3,3,13 */
15168 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
15169 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC64_NONE);
15170 if (r_type == R_PPC64_TOC16
15171 || r_type == R_PPC64_TOC16_LO)
15172 r_type += R_PPC64_TOC16_DS - R_PPC64_TOC16;
15173 else
15174 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16 & 1)) & 1)
15175 + R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS);
15176 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15177 }
15178 else
15179 {
15180 /* LE */
15181 insn1 &= 0x1f << 21;
15182 insn1 |= 0x3c0d0000; /* addis r,13,0 */
15183 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
15184 if (tls_gd == 0)
15185 {
15186 /* Was an LD reloc. */
15187 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
15188 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
15189 }
15190 else if (toc_symndx != 0)
15191 {
15192 r_symndx = toc_symndx;
15193 rel->r_addend = toc_addend;
15194 }
15195 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA;
15196 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15197 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
15198 {
15199 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx,
15200 R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO);
15201 rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset;
15202 rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend;
15203 }
15204 }
15205 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1,
15206 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
15207 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
15208 {
15209 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
15210 if (offset + 8 <= input_section->size)
15211 {
15212 insn2 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset + 4);
15213 if (insn2 == LD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab))
15214 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset + 4);
15215 }
15216 }
15217 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) == 0
15218 && (tls_gd == 0 || toc_symndx != 0))
15219 {
15220 /* We changed the symbol. Start over in order
15221 to get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
15222 goto again;
15223 }
15224 }
15225 break;
15226
15227 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD34:
15228 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
15229 {
15230 pinsn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
15231 pinsn <<= 32;
15232 pinsn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15233 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
15234 {
15235 /* IE, pla -> pld */
15236 pinsn += (-2ULL << 56) + (57ULL << 26) - (14ULL << 26);
15237 r_type = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL34;
15238 }
15239 else
15240 {
15241 /* LE, pla pcrel -> paddi r13 */
15242 pinsn += (-1ULL << 52) + (13ULL << 16);
15243 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL34;
15244 }
15245 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15246 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn >> 32,
15247 contents + rel->r_offset);
15248 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn & 0xffffffff,
15249 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15250 }
15251 break;
15252
15253 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD34:
15254 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
15255 {
15256 pinsn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
15257 pinsn <<= 32;
15258 pinsn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15259 pinsn += (-1ULL << 52) + (13ULL << 16);
15260 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn >> 32,
15261 contents + rel->r_offset);
15262 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn & 0xffffffff,
15263 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15264 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
15265 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
15266 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL34;
15267 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15268 goto again;
15269 }
15270 break;
15271
15272 case R_PPC64_TLSGD:
15273 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
15274 && rel + 1 < relend)
15275 {
15276 unsigned int insn2;
15277 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type1 = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
15278
15279 offset = rel->r_offset;
15280 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (r_type1))
15281 {
15282 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
15283 if (r_type1 == R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34
15284 || r_type1 == R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC)
15285 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset + 4);
15286 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC64_NONE);
15287 break;
15288 }
15289
15290 if (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC64_PLTCALL)
15291 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset + 4);
15292
15293 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
15294 {
15295 /* IE */
15296 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
15297 insn2 = 0x7c636a14; /* add 3,3,13 */
15298 }
15299 else
15300 {
15301 /* LE */
15302 if (toc_symndx != 0)
15303 {
15304 r_symndx = toc_symndx;
15305 rel->r_addend = toc_addend;
15306 }
15307 if (r_type1 == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
15308 || r_type1 == R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC)
15309 {
15310 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
15311 insn2 = NOP;
15312 }
15313 else
15314 {
15315 rel->r_offset = offset + d_offset;
15316 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO;
15317 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
15318 }
15319 }
15320 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15321 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
15322 BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
15323 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC64_NONE);
15324 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
15325 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) == 0
15326 && toc_symndx != 0
15327 && r_type != R_PPC64_NONE)
15328 goto again;
15329 }
15330 break;
15331
15332 case R_PPC64_TLSLD:
15333 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
15334 && rel + 1 < relend)
15335 {
15336 unsigned int insn2;
15337 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type1 = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
15338
15339 offset = rel->r_offset;
15340 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (r_type1))
15341 {
15342 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
15343 if (r_type1 == R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34
15344 || r_type1 == R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC)
15345 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset + 4);
15346 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC64_NONE);
15347 break;
15348 }
15349
15350 if (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC64_PLTCALL)
15351 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset + 4);
15352
15353 if (r_type1 == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
15354 || r_type1 == R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC)
15355 {
15356 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
15357 insn2 = NOP;
15358 }
15359 else
15360 {
15361 rel->r_offset = offset + d_offset;
15362 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
15363 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO;
15364 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
15365 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
15366 }
15367 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15368 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
15369 BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
15370 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC64_NONE);
15371 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
15372 if (r_type != R_PPC64_NONE)
15373 goto again;
15374 }
15375 break;
15376
15377 case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
15378 if (rel + 1 < relend
15379 && rel[1].r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_DTPREL64)
15380 && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset + 8)
15381 {
15382 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
15383 {
15384 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_NONE);
15385 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
15386 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL64;
15387 else
15388 {
15389 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, 1, contents + rel->r_offset);
15390 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
15391 }
15392 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15393 }
15394 }
15395 else
15396 {
15397 if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
15398 {
15399 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, 1, contents + rel->r_offset);
15400 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
15401 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15402 }
15403 }
15404 break;
15405
15406 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
15407 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
15408 {
15409 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
15410 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15411 }
15412 break;
15413
15414 case R_PPC64_ENTRY:
15415 relocation = TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
15416 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
15417 && !info->traditional_format
15418 && relocation + 0x80008000 <= 0xffffffff)
15419 {
15420 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
15421
15422 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
15423 insn2 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15424 if ((insn1 & ~0xfffc) == LD_R2_0R12
15425 && insn2 == ADD_R2_R2_R12)
15426 {
15427 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
15428 LIS_R2 + PPC_HA (relocation),
15429 contents + rel->r_offset);
15430 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
15431 ADDI_R2_R2 + PPC_LO (relocation),
15432 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15433 }
15434 }
15435 else
15436 {
15437 relocation -= (rel->r_offset
15438 + input_section->output_offset
15439 + input_section->output_section->vma);
15440 if (relocation + 0x80008000 <= 0xffffffff)
15441 {
15442 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
15443
15444 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
15445 insn2 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15446 if ((insn1 & ~0xfffc) == LD_R2_0R12
15447 && insn2 == ADD_R2_R2_R12)
15448 {
15449 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
15450 ADDIS_R2_R12 + PPC_HA (relocation),
15451 contents + rel->r_offset);
15452 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
15453 ADDI_R2_R2 + PPC_LO (relocation),
15454 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15455 }
15456 }
15457 }
15458 break;
15459
15460 case R_PPC64_REL16_HA:
15461 /* If we are generating a non-PIC executable, edit
15462 . 0: addis 2,12,.TOC.-0b@ha
15463 . addi 2,2,.TOC.-0b@l
15464 used by ELFv2 global entry points to set up r2, to
15465 . lis 2,.TOC.@ha
15466 . addi 2,2,.TOC.@l
15467 if .TOC. is in range. */
15468 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
15469 && !info->traditional_format
15470 && !htab->opd_abi
15471 && rel->r_addend == d_offset
15472 && h != NULL && &h->elf == htab->elf.hgot
15473 && rel + 1 < relend
15474 && rel[1].r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_REL16_LO)
15475 && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset + 4
15476 && rel[1].r_addend == rel->r_addend + 4
15477 && relocation + 0x80008000 <= 0xffffffff)
15478 {
15479 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
15480 offset = rel->r_offset - d_offset;
15481 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
15482 insn2 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset + 4);
15483 if ((insn1 & 0xffff0000) == ADDIS_R2_R12
15484 && (insn2 & 0xffff0000) == ADDI_R2_R2)
15485 {
15486 r_type = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA;
15487 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15488 rel->r_addend -= d_offset;
15489 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO);
15490 rel[1].r_addend -= d_offset + 4;
15491 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, LIS_R2, contents + offset);
15492 }
15493 }
15494 break;
15495 }
15496
15497 /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn. */
15498 insn = 0;
15499 max_br_offset = 1 << 25;
15500 addend = rel->r_addend;
15501 reloc_dest = DEST_NORMAL;
15502 switch (r_type)
15503 {
15504 default:
15505 break;
15506
15507 case R_PPC64_TOCSAVE:
15508 if (relocation + addend == (rel->r_offset
15509 + input_section->output_offset
15510 + input_section->output_section->vma)
15511 && tocsave_find (htab, NO_INSERT,
15512 &local_syms, rel, input_bfd))
15513 {
15514 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
15515 if (insn == NOP
15516 || insn == CROR_151515 || insn == CROR_313131)
15517 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
15518 STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab),
15519 contents + rel->r_offset);
15520 }
15521 break;
15522
15523 /* Branch taken prediction relocations. */
15524 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
15525 case R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN:
15526 insn = 0x01 << 21; /* 'y' or 't' bit, lowest bit of BO field. */
15527 /* Fall through. */
15528
15529 /* Branch not taken prediction relocations. */
15530 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
15531 case R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
15532 insn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
15533 contents + rel->r_offset) & ~(0x01 << 21);
15534 /* Fall through. */
15535
15536 case R_PPC64_REL14:
15537 max_br_offset = 1 << 15;
15538 /* Fall through. */
15539
15540 case R_PPC64_REL24:
15541 case R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC:
15542 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL:
15543 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC:
15544 /* Calls to functions with a different TOC, such as calls to
15545 shared objects, need to alter the TOC pointer. This is
15546 done using a linkage stub. A REL24 branching to these
15547 linkage stubs needs to be followed by a nop, as the nop
15548 will be replaced with an instruction to restore the TOC
15549 base pointer. */
15550 fdh = h;
15551 if (h != NULL
15552 && h->oh != NULL
15553 && h->oh->is_func_descriptor)
15554 fdh = ppc_follow_link (h->oh);
15555 stub_entry = ppc_get_stub_entry (input_section, sec, fdh, &orig_rel,
15556 htab);
15557 if ((r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL
15558 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC)
15559 && stub_entry != NULL
15560 && stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
15561 && stub_entry->stub_type <= ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
15562 stub_entry = NULL;
15563
15564 if (stub_entry != NULL
15565 && ((stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
15566 && stub_entry->stub_type <= ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
15567 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off
15568 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both
15569 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off
15570 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both))
15571 {
15572 bfd_boolean can_plt_call = FALSE;
15573
15574 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call
15575 && !htab->opd_abi
15576 && htab->params->plt_localentry0 != 0
15577 && is_elfv2_localentry0 (&h->elf))
15578 {
15579 /* The function doesn't use or change r2. */
15580 can_plt_call = TRUE;
15581 }
15582 else if (r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC)
15583 {
15584 /* NOTOC calls don't need to restore r2. */
15585 can_plt_call = TRUE;
15586 }
15587
15588 /* All of these stubs may modify r2, so there must be a
15589 branch and link followed by a nop. The nop is
15590 replaced by an insn to restore r2. */
15591 else if (rel->r_offset + 8 <= input_section->size)
15592 {
15593 unsigned long br;
15594
15595 br = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
15596 contents + rel->r_offset);
15597 if ((br & 1) != 0)
15598 {
15599 unsigned long nop;
15600
15601 nop = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
15602 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15603 if (nop == LD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab))
15604 can_plt_call = TRUE;
15605 else if (nop == NOP
15606 || nop == CROR_151515
15607 || nop == CROR_313131)
15608 {
15609 if (h != NULL
15610 && is_tls_get_addr (&h->elf, htab)
15611 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt)
15612 {
15613 /* Special stub used, leave nop alone. */
15614 }
15615 else
15616 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
15617 LD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab),
15618 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15619 can_plt_call = TRUE;
15620 }
15621 }
15622 }
15623
15624 if (!can_plt_call && h != NULL)
15625 {
15626 const char *name = h->elf.root.root.string;
15627
15628 if (*name == '.')
15629 ++name;
15630
15631 if (strncmp (name, "__libc_start_main", 17) == 0
15632 && (name[17] == 0 || name[17] == '@'))
15633 {
15634 /* Allow crt1 branch to go via a toc adjusting
15635 stub. Other calls that never return could do
15636 the same, if we could detect such. */
15637 can_plt_call = TRUE;
15638 }
15639 }
15640
15641 if (!can_plt_call)
15642 {
15643 /* g++ as of 20130507 emits self-calls without a
15644 following nop. This is arguably wrong since we
15645 have conflicting information. On the one hand a
15646 global symbol and on the other a local call
15647 sequence, but don't error for this special case.
15648 It isn't possible to cheaply verify we have
15649 exactly such a call. Allow all calls to the same
15650 section. */
15651 asection *code_sec = sec;
15652
15653 if (get_opd_info (sec) != NULL)
15654 {
15655 bfd_vma off = (relocation + addend
15656 - sec->output_section->vma
15657 - sec->output_offset);
15658
15659 opd_entry_value (sec, off, &code_sec, NULL, FALSE);
15660 }
15661 if (code_sec == input_section)
15662 can_plt_call = TRUE;
15663 }
15664
15665 if (!can_plt_call)
15666 {
15667 if (stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
15668 && stub_entry->stub_type <= ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
15669 info->callbacks->einfo
15670 /* xgettext:c-format */
15671 (_("%H: call to `%pT' lacks nop, can't restore toc; "
15672 "(plt call stub)\n"),
15673 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
15674 else
15675 info->callbacks->einfo
15676 /* xgettext:c-format */
15677 (_("%H: call to `%pT' lacks nop, can't restore toc; "
15678 "(toc save/adjust stub)\n"),
15679 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
15680
15681 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
15682 ret = FALSE;
15683 }
15684
15685 if (can_plt_call
15686 && stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
15687 && stub_entry->stub_type <= ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
15688 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
15689 }
15690
15691 if ((stub_entry == NULL
15692 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch
15693 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch)
15694 && get_opd_info (sec) != NULL)
15695 {
15696 /* The branch destination is the value of the opd entry. */
15697 bfd_vma off = (relocation + addend
15698 - sec->output_section->vma
15699 - sec->output_offset);
15700 bfd_vma dest = opd_entry_value (sec, off, NULL, NULL, FALSE);
15701 if (dest != (bfd_vma) -1)
15702 {
15703 relocation = dest;
15704 addend = 0;
15705 reloc_dest = DEST_OPD;
15706 }
15707 }
15708
15709 /* If the branch is out of reach we ought to have a long
15710 branch stub. */
15711 from = (rel->r_offset
15712 + input_section->output_offset
15713 + input_section->output_section->vma);
15714
15715 relocation += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (fdh
15716 ? fdh->elf.other
15717 : sym->st_other);
15718
15719 if (stub_entry != NULL
15720 && (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch
15721 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch)
15722 && (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
15723 || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
15724 || (relocation + addend - from + max_br_offset
15725 < 2 * max_br_offset)))
15726 /* Don't use the stub if this branch is in range. */
15727 stub_entry = NULL;
15728
15729 if (stub_entry != NULL
15730 && (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc
15731 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both
15732 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc
15733 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both)
15734 && (r_type != R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
15735 || ((fdh ? fdh->elf.other : sym->st_other)
15736 & STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK) <= 1 << STO_PPC64_LOCAL_BIT)
15737 && (relocation + addend - from + max_br_offset
15738 < 2 * max_br_offset))
15739 stub_entry = NULL;
15740
15741 if (stub_entry != NULL
15742 && (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off
15743 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both
15744 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off
15745 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both)
15746 && r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
15747 && (relocation + addend - from + max_br_offset
15748 < 2 * max_br_offset))
15749 stub_entry = NULL;
15750
15751 if (stub_entry != NULL)
15752 {
15753 /* Munge up the value and addend so that we call the stub
15754 rather than the procedure directly. */
15755 asection *stub_sec = stub_entry->group->stub_sec;
15756
15757 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_save_res)
15758 relocation += (stub_sec->output_offset
15759 + stub_sec->output_section->vma
15760 + stub_sec->size - htab->sfpr->size
15761 - htab->sfpr->output_offset
15762 - htab->sfpr->output_section->vma);
15763 else
15764 relocation = (stub_entry->stub_offset
15765 + stub_sec->output_offset
15766 + stub_sec->output_section->vma);
15767 addend = 0;
15768 reloc_dest = DEST_STUB;
15769
15770 if (((stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call
15771 && ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE)
15772 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save
15773 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
15774 && !(h != NULL
15775 && is_tls_get_addr (&h->elf, htab)
15776 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt)
15777 && rel + 1 < relend
15778 && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset + 4
15779 && ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC64_TOCSAVE)
15780 relocation += 4;
15781 else if ((stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both
15782 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both
15783 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
15784 && r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC)
15785 relocation += 4;
15786
15787 if (r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
15788 && (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc
15789 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both))
15790 htab->notoc_plt = 1;
15791 }
15792
15793 if (insn != 0)
15794 {
15795 if (is_isa_v2)
15796 {
15797 /* Set 'a' bit. This is 0b00010 in BO field for branch
15798 on CR(BI) insns (BO == 001at or 011at), and 0b01000
15799 for branch on CTR insns (BO == 1a00t or 1a01t). */
15800 if ((insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x04 << 21))
15801 insn |= 0x02 << 21;
15802 else if ((insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x10 << 21))
15803 insn |= 0x08 << 21;
15804 else
15805 break;
15806 }
15807 else
15808 {
15809 /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default. */
15810 if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + addend - from) < 0)
15811 insn ^= 0x01 << 21;
15812 }
15813
15814 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
15815 }
15816
15817 /* NOP out calls to undefined weak functions.
15818 We can thus call a weak function without first
15819 checking whether the function is defined. */
15820 else if (h != NULL
15821 && h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
15822 && h->elf.dynindx == -1
15823 && (r_type == R_PPC64_REL24
15824 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC)
15825 && relocation == 0
15826 && addend == 0)
15827 {
15828 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
15829 goto copy_reloc;
15830 }
15831 break;
15832
15833 case R_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
15834 from = TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
15835 if (relocation + addend - from + 0x8000 < 0x10000
15836 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf))
15837 {
15838 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
15839 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26 | 0x3)) == 58u << 26 /* ld */)
15840 {
15841 insn += (14u << 26) - (58u << 26);
15842 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
15843 r_type = R_PPC64_TOC16;
15844 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15845 }
15846 }
15847 break;
15848
15849 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
15850 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
15851 from = TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
15852 if (relocation + addend - from + 0x80008000ULL < 0x100000000ULL
15853 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf))
15854 {
15855 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
15856 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26 | 0x3)) == 58u << 26 /* ld */)
15857 {
15858 insn += (14u << 26) - (58u << 26);
15859 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
15860 r_type = R_PPC64_TOC16_LO;
15861 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15862 }
15863 else if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26 /* addis */)
15864 {
15865 r_type = R_PPC64_TOC16_HA;
15866 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15867 }
15868 }
15869 break;
15870
15871 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
15872 from = (rel->r_offset
15873 + input_section->output_section->vma
15874 + input_section->output_offset);
15875 if (relocation - from + (1ULL << 33) < 1ULL << 34
15876 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf))
15877 {
15878 offset = rel->r_offset;
15879 pinsn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
15880 pinsn <<= 32;
15881 pinsn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset + 4);
15882 if ((pinsn & ((-1ULL << 50) | (63ULL << 26)))
15883 == ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52) | (57ULL << 26) /* pld */))
15884 {
15885 /* Replace with paddi. */
15886 pinsn += (2ULL << 56) + (14ULL << 26) - (57ULL << 26);
15887 r_type = R_PPC64_PCREL34;
15888 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15889 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn >> 32, contents + offset);
15890 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn, contents + offset + 4);
15891 goto pcrelopt;
15892 }
15893 }
15894 break;
15895
15896 case R_PPC64_PCREL34:
15897 if (SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf))
15898 {
15899 offset = rel->r_offset;
15900 pinsn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
15901 pinsn <<= 32;
15902 pinsn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset + 4);
15903 if ((pinsn & ((-1ULL << 50) | (63ULL << 26)))
15904 == ((1ULL << 58) | (2ULL << 56) | (1ULL << 52)
15905 | (14ULL << 26) /* paddi */))
15906 {
15907 pcrelopt:
15908 if (rel + 1 < relend
15909 && rel[1].r_offset == offset
15910 && rel[1].r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_PCREL_OPT))
15911 {
15912 bfd_vma off2 = rel[1].r_addend;
15913 if (off2 == 0)
15914 /* zero means next insn. */
15915 off2 = 8;
15916 off2 += offset;
15917 if (off2 + 4 <= input_section->size)
15918 {
15919 uint64_t pinsn2;
15920 bfd_signed_vma addend_off;
15921 pinsn2 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + off2);
15922 pinsn2 <<= 32;
15923 if ((pinsn2 & (63ULL << 58)) == 1ULL << 58)
15924 {
15925 if (off2 + 8 > input_section->size)
15926 break;
15927 pinsn2 |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
15928 contents + off2 + 4);
15929 }
15930 if (xlate_pcrel_opt (&pinsn, &pinsn2, &addend_off))
15931 {
15932 addend += addend_off;
15933 rel->r_addend = addend;
15934 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn >> 32,
15935 contents + offset);
15936 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn,
15937 contents + offset + 4);
15938 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn2 >> 32,
15939 contents + off2);
15940 if ((pinsn2 & (63ULL << 58)) == 1ULL << 58)
15941 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn2,
15942 contents + off2 + 4);
15943 }
15944 }
15945 }
15946 }
15947 }
15948 break;
15949 }
15950
15951 tls_type = 0;
15952 save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc;
15953 switch (r_type)
15954 {
15955 default:
15956 /* xgettext:c-format */
15957 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
15958 input_bfd, ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
15959
15960 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
15961 ret = FALSE;
15962 goto copy_reloc;
15963
15964 case R_PPC64_NONE:
15965 case R_PPC64_TLS:
15966 case R_PPC64_TLSGD:
15967 case R_PPC64_TLSLD:
15968 case R_PPC64_TOCSAVE:
15969 case R_PPC64_GNU_VTINHERIT:
15970 case R_PPC64_GNU_VTENTRY:
15971 case R_PPC64_ENTRY:
15972 case R_PPC64_PCREL_OPT:
15973 goto copy_reloc;
15974
15975 /* GOT16 relocations. Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's
15976 address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the
15977 symbol's value itself. Also, create a GOT entry for the
15978 symbol and put the symbol value there. */
15979 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16:
15980 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
15981 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
15982 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
15983 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD34:
15984 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
15985 goto dogot;
15986
15987 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16:
15988 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
15989 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
15990 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
15991 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD34:
15992 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
15993 goto dogot;
15994
15995 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS:
15996 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
15997 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
15998 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
15999 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL34:
16000 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
16001 goto dogot;
16002
16003 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS:
16004 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
16005 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
16006 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
16007 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL34:
16008 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
16009 goto dogot;
16010
16011 case R_PPC64_GOT16:
16012 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO:
16013 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HI:
16014 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
16015 case R_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
16016 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
16017 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
16018 dogot:
16019 {
16020 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
16021 offset table. */
16022 asection *got;
16023 bfd_vma *offp;
16024 bfd_vma off;
16025 unsigned long indx = 0;
16026 struct got_entry *ent;
16027
16028 if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
16029 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf))
16030 ent = ppc64_tlsld_got (input_bfd);
16031 else
16032 {
16033 if (h != NULL)
16034 {
16035 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
16036 || h->elf.dynindx == -1
16037 || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf)
16038 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &h->elf))
16039 /* This is actually a static link, or it is a
16040 -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined
16041 locally, or the symbol was forced to be local
16042 because of a version file. */
16043 ;
16044 else
16045 {
16046 indx = h->elf.dynindx;
16047 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
16048 }
16049 ent = h->elf.got.glist;
16050 }
16051 else
16052 {
16053 if (local_got_ents == NULL)
16054 abort ();
16055 ent = local_got_ents[r_symndx];
16056 }
16057
16058 for (; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
16059 if (ent->addend == orig_rel.r_addend
16060 && ent->owner == input_bfd
16061 && ent->tls_type == tls_type)
16062 break;
16063 }
16064
16065 if (ent == NULL)
16066 abort ();
16067 if (ent->is_indirect)
16068 ent = ent->got.ent;
16069 offp = &ent->got.offset;
16070 got = ppc64_elf_tdata (ent->owner)->got;
16071 if (got == NULL)
16072 abort ();
16073
16074 /* The offset must always be a multiple of 8. We use the
16075 least significant bit to record whether we have already
16076 processed this entry. */
16077 off = *offp;
16078 if ((off & 1) != 0)
16079 off &= ~1;
16080 else
16081 {
16082 /* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker, except in
16083 the case of TLSLD where we'll use one entry per
16084 module. */
16085 asection *relgot;
16086 bfd_boolean ifunc;
16087
16088 *offp = off | 1;
16089 relgot = NULL;
16090 ifunc = (h != NULL
16091 ? h->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
16092 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
16093 if (ifunc)
16094 {
16095 relgot = htab->elf.irelplt;
16096 if (indx == 0)
16097 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
16098 else if (is_static_defined (&h->elf))
16099 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
16100 }
16101 else if (indx != 0
16102 || (bfd_link_pic (info)
16103 && (h == NULL
16104 || !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &h->elf))
16105 && !(tls_type != 0
16106 && bfd_link_executable (info)
16107 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf))))
16108 relgot = ppc64_elf_tdata (ent->owner)->relgot;
16109 if (relgot != NULL)
16110 {
16111 outrel.r_offset = (got->output_section->vma
16112 + got->output_offset
16113 + off);
16114 outrel.r_addend = orig_rel.r_addend;
16115 if (tls_type & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
16116 {
16117 outrel.r_addend = 0;
16118 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC64_DTPMOD64);
16119 if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
16120 {
16121 loc = relgot->contents;
16122 loc += (relgot->reloc_count++
16123 * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
16124 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd,
16125 &outrel, loc);
16126 outrel.r_offset += 8;
16127 outrel.r_addend = orig_rel.r_addend;
16128 outrel.r_info
16129 = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC64_DTPREL64);
16130 }
16131 }
16132 else if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
16133 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC64_DTPREL64);
16134 else if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL))
16135 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC64_TPREL64);
16136 else if (indx != 0)
16137 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT);
16138 else
16139 {
16140 if (ifunc)
16141 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_IRELATIVE);
16142 else
16143 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
16144
16145 /* Write the .got section contents for the sake
16146 of prelink. */
16147 loc = got->contents + off;
16148 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, outrel.r_addend + relocation,
16149 loc);
16150 }
16151
16152 if (indx == 0 && tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
16153 {
16154 outrel.r_addend += relocation;
16155 if (tls_type & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL))
16156 {
16157 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
16158 outrel.r_addend = 0;
16159 else
16160 outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
16161 }
16162 }
16163 loc = relgot->contents;
16164 loc += (relgot->reloc_count++
16165 * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
16166 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
16167 }
16168
16169 /* Init the .got section contents here if we're not
16170 emitting a reloc. */
16171 else
16172 {
16173 relocation += orig_rel.r_addend;
16174 if (tls_type != 0)
16175 {
16176 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
16177 relocation = 0;
16178 else
16179 {
16180 if (tls_type & TLS_LD)
16181 relocation = 0;
16182 else
16183 relocation -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
16184 if (tls_type & TLS_TPREL)
16185 relocation += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET;
16186 }
16187
16188 if (tls_type & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD))
16189 {
16190 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, relocation,
16191 got->contents + off + 8);
16192 relocation = 1;
16193 }
16194 }
16195 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, relocation,
16196 got->contents + off);
16197 }
16198 }
16199
16200 if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
16201 abort ();
16202
16203 relocation = got->output_section->vma + got->output_offset + off;
16204 addend = 0;
16205 if (!(r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34
16206 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD34
16207 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD34
16208 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL34
16209 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL34))
16210 addend = -(TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off);
16211 }
16212 break;
16213
16214 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
16215 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HI:
16216 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO:
16217 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
16218 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34:
16219 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC:
16220 case R_PPC64_PLT32:
16221 case R_PPC64_PLT64:
16222 case R_PPC64_PLTSEQ:
16223 case R_PPC64_PLTSEQ_NOTOC:
16224 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL:
16225 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC:
16226 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
16227 procedure linkage table. */
16228 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
16229 {
16230 struct plt_entry **plt_list = NULL;
16231 if (h != NULL)
16232 plt_list = &h->elf.plt.plist;
16233 else if (local_got_ents != NULL)
16234 {
16235 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
16236 (local_got_ents + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
16237 plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx;
16238 }
16239 if (plt_list)
16240 {
16241 struct plt_entry *ent;
16242
16243 for (ent = *plt_list; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
16244 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1
16245 && ent->addend == orig_rel.r_addend)
16246 {
16247 asection *plt;
16248 bfd_vma got;
16249
16250 plt = htab->elf.splt;
16251 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
16252 || h == NULL
16253 || h->elf.dynindx == -1)
16254 {
16255 if (h != NULL
16256 ? h->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
16257 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
16258 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
16259 else
16260 plt = htab->pltlocal;
16261 }
16262 relocation = (plt->output_section->vma
16263 + plt->output_offset
16264 + ent->plt.offset);
16265 if (r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_HA
16266 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_HI
16267 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_LO
16268 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS)
16269 {
16270 got = (elf_gp (output_bfd)
16271 + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off);
16272 relocation -= got;
16273 }
16274 addend = 0;
16275 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
16276 break;
16277 }
16278 }
16279 }
16280 break;
16281
16282 case R_PPC64_TOC:
16283 /* Relocation value is TOC base. */
16284 relocation = TOCstart;
16285 if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF)
16286 relocation += htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
16287 else if (unresolved_reloc)
16288 ;
16289 else if (sec != NULL && sec->id < htab->sec_info_arr_size)
16290 relocation += htab->sec_info[sec->id].toc_off;
16291 else
16292 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
16293 goto dodyn;
16294
16295 /* TOC16 relocs. We want the offset relative to the TOC base,
16296 which is the address of the start of the TOC plus 0x8000.
16297 The TOC consists of sections .got, .toc, .tocbss, and .plt,
16298 in this order. */
16299 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
16300 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
16301 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
16302 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
16303 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
16304 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
16305 addend -= TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
16306 if (h != NULL)
16307 goto dodyn;
16308 break;
16309
16310 /* Relocate against the beginning of the section. */
16311 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF:
16312 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO:
16313 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HI:
16314 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
16315 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
16316 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HA:
16317 if (sec != NULL)
16318 addend -= sec->output_section->vma;
16319 break;
16320
16321 case R_PPC64_REL16:
16322 case R_PPC64_REL16_LO:
16323 case R_PPC64_REL16_HI:
16324 case R_PPC64_REL16_HA:
16325 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGH:
16326 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA:
16327 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER:
16328 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA:
16329 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST:
16330 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA:
16331 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER34:
16332 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34:
16333 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST34:
16334 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34:
16335 case R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA:
16336 case R_PPC64_REL14:
16337 case R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
16338 case R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN:
16339 case R_PPC64_REL24:
16340 case R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC:
16341 case R_PPC64_PCREL34:
16342 case R_PPC64_PCREL28:
16343 break;
16344
16345 case R_PPC64_TPREL16:
16346 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
16347 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI:
16348 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
16349 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
16350 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
16351 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:
16352 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
16353 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:
16354 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
16355 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:
16356 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
16357 case R_PPC64_TPREL34:
16358 if (h != NULL
16359 && h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
16360 && h->elf.dynindx == -1)
16361 {
16362 /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol
16363 resolve to zero. This is really just a tweak, since
16364 code using weak externs ought to check that they are
16365 defined before using them. */
16366 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset;
16367
16368 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
16369 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 13);
16370 if (insn != 0)
16371 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
16372 break;
16373 }
16374 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
16375 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
16376 /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared
16377 libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in
16378 DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway. */
16379 goto dodyn;
16380
16381 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16:
16382 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO:
16383 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HI:
16384 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA:
16385 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
16386 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
16387 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGH:
16388 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA:
16389 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHER:
16390 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA:
16391 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHEST:
16392 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA:
16393 case R_PPC64_DTPREL34:
16394 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
16395 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
16396 break;
16397
16398 case R_PPC64_ADDR64_LOCAL:
16399 addend += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (h != NULL
16400 ? h->elf.other
16401 : sym->st_other);
16402 break;
16403
16404 case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
16405 relocation = 1;
16406 addend = 0;
16407 goto dodyn;
16408
16409 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
16410 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
16411 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
16412 goto dodyn;
16413
16414 case R_PPC64_DTPREL64:
16415 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
16416 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
16417 /* Fall through. */
16418
16419 /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a
16420 dynamic object. */
16421 case R_PPC64_REL30:
16422 case R_PPC64_REL32:
16423 case R_PPC64_REL64:
16424 case R_PPC64_ADDR14:
16425 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
16426 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
16427 case R_PPC64_ADDR16:
16428 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
16429 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA:
16430 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI:
16431 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH:
16432 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA:
16433 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER:
16434 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA:
16435 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST:
16436 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA:
16437 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO:
16438 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
16439 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER34:
16440 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34:
16441 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST34:
16442 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34:
16443 case R_PPC64_ADDR24:
16444 case R_PPC64_ADDR32:
16445 case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
16446 case R_PPC64_UADDR16:
16447 case R_PPC64_UADDR32:
16448 case R_PPC64_UADDR64:
16449 case R_PPC64_D34:
16450 case R_PPC64_D34_LO:
16451 case R_PPC64_D34_HI30:
16452 case R_PPC64_D34_HA30:
16453 case R_PPC64_D28:
16454 dodyn:
16455 if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
16456 break;
16457
16458 if (NO_OPD_RELOCS && is_opd)
16459 break;
16460
16461 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
16462 ? ((h == NULL
16463 || h->dyn_relocs != NULL)
16464 && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h))
16465 || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
16466 : (h != NULL
16467 ? h->dyn_relocs != NULL
16468 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC))
16469 {
16470 bfd_boolean skip, relocate;
16471 asection *sreloc;
16472 bfd_vma out_off;
16473 long indx = 0;
16474
16475 /* When generating a dynamic object, these relocations
16476 are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
16477 time. */
16478
16479 skip = FALSE;
16480 relocate = FALSE;
16481
16482 out_off = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
16483 input_section, rel->r_offset);
16484 if (out_off == (bfd_vma) -1)
16485 skip = TRUE;
16486 else if (out_off == (bfd_vma) -2)
16487 skip = TRUE, relocate = TRUE;
16488 out_off += (input_section->output_section->vma
16489 + input_section->output_offset);
16490 outrel.r_offset = out_off;
16491 outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
16492
16493 /* Optimize unaligned reloc use. */
16494 if ((r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR64 && (out_off & 7) != 0)
16495 || (r_type == R_PPC64_UADDR64 && (out_off & 7) == 0))
16496 r_type ^= R_PPC64_ADDR64 ^ R_PPC64_UADDR64;
16497 else if ((r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR32 && (out_off & 3) != 0)
16498 || (r_type == R_PPC64_UADDR32 && (out_off & 3) == 0))
16499 r_type ^= R_PPC64_ADDR32 ^ R_PPC64_UADDR32;
16500 else if ((r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR16 && (out_off & 1) != 0)
16501 || (r_type == R_PPC64_UADDR16 && (out_off & 1) == 0))
16502 r_type ^= R_PPC64_ADDR16 ^ R_PPC64_UADDR16;
16503
16504 if (skip)
16505 memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
16506 else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf)
16507 && !is_opd
16508 && r_type != R_PPC64_TOC)
16509 {
16510 indx = h->elf.dynindx;
16511 BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1);
16512 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
16513 }
16514 else
16515 {
16516 /* This symbol is local, or marked to become local,
16517 or this is an opd section reloc which must point
16518 at a local function. */
16519 outrel.r_addend += relocation;
16520 if (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR64 || r_type == R_PPC64_TOC)
16521 {
16522 if (is_opd && h != NULL)
16523 {
16524 /* Lie about opd entries. This case occurs
16525 when building shared libraries and we
16526 reference a function in another shared
16527 lib. The same thing happens for a weak
16528 definition in an application that's
16529 overridden by a strong definition in a
16530 shared lib. (I believe this is a generic
16531 bug in binutils handling of weak syms.)
16532 In these cases we won't use the opd
16533 entry in this lib. */
16534 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
16535 }
16536 if (!is_opd
16537 && r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR64
16538 && (h != NULL
16539 ? h->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
16540 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC))
16541 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_IRELATIVE);
16542 else
16543 {
16544 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
16545
16546 /* We need to relocate .opd contents for ld.so.
16547 Prelink also wants simple and consistent rules
16548 for relocs. This make all RELATIVE relocs have
16549 *r_offset equal to r_addend. */
16550 relocate = TRUE;
16551 }
16552 }
16553 else
16554 {
16555 if (h != NULL
16556 ? h->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
16557 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
16558 {
16559 info->callbacks->einfo
16560 /* xgettext:c-format */
16561 (_("%H: %s for indirect "
16562 "function `%pT' unsupported\n"),
16563 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
16564 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name,
16565 sym_name);
16566 ret = FALSE;
16567 }
16568 else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
16569 ;
16570 else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
16571 {
16572 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
16573 return FALSE;
16574 }
16575 else
16576 {
16577 asection *osec = sec->output_section;
16578
16579 if ((osec->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
16580 {
16581 /* TLS symbol values are relative to the
16582 TLS segment. Dynamic relocations for
16583 local TLS symbols therefore can't be
16584 reduced to a relocation against their
16585 section symbol because it holds the
16586 address of the section, not a value
16587 relative to the TLS segment. We could
16588 change the .tdata dynamic section symbol
16589 to be zero value but STN_UNDEF works
16590 and is used elsewhere, eg. for TPREL64
16591 GOT relocs against local TLS symbols. */
16592 osec = htab->elf.tls_sec;
16593 indx = 0;
16594 }
16595 else
16596 {
16597 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
16598 if (indx == 0)
16599 {
16600 if ((osec->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0
16601 && htab->elf.data_index_section != NULL)
16602 osec = htab->elf.data_index_section;
16603 else
16604 osec = htab->elf.text_index_section;
16605 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
16606 }
16607 BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0);
16608 }
16609
16610 /* We are turning this relocation into one
16611 against a section symbol, so subtract out
16612 the output section's address but not the
16613 offset of the input section in the output
16614 section. */
16615 outrel.r_addend -= osec->vma;
16616 }
16617
16618 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
16619 }
16620 }
16621
16622 sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
16623 if (h != NULL
16624 ? h->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
16625 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
16626 {
16627 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
16628 if (indx == 0)
16629 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
16630 else if (is_static_defined (&h->elf))
16631 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
16632 }
16633 if (sreloc == NULL)
16634 abort ();
16635
16636 if (sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela)
16637 >= sreloc->size)
16638 abort ();
16639 loc = sreloc->contents;
16640 loc += sreloc->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
16641 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
16642
16643 if (!warned_dynamic
16644 && !ppc64_glibc_dynamic_reloc (ELF64_R_TYPE (outrel.r_info)))
16645 {
16646 info->callbacks->einfo
16647 /* xgettext:c-format */
16648 (_("%X%P: %pB: %s against %pT "
16649 "is not supported by glibc as a dynamic relocation\n"),
16650 input_bfd,
16651 ppc64_elf_howto_table[ELF64_R_TYPE (outrel.r_info)]->name,
16652 sym_name);
16653 warned_dynamic = TRUE;
16654 }
16655
16656 /* If this reloc is against an external symbol, it will
16657 be computed at runtime, so there's no need to do
16658 anything now. However, for the sake of prelink ensure
16659 that the section contents are a known value. */
16660 if (!relocate)
16661 {
16662 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
16663 /* The value chosen here is quite arbitrary as ld.so
16664 ignores section contents except for the special
16665 case of .opd where the contents might be accessed
16666 before relocation. Choose zero, as that won't
16667 cause reloc overflow. */
16668 relocation = 0;
16669 addend = 0;
16670 /* Use *r_offset == r_addend for R_PPC64_ADDR64 relocs
16671 to improve backward compatibility with older
16672 versions of ld. */
16673 if (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR64)
16674 addend = outrel.r_addend;
16675 /* Adjust pc_relative relocs to have zero in *r_offset. */
16676 else if (ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->pc_relative)
16677 addend = outrel.r_offset;
16678 }
16679 }
16680 break;
16681
16682 case R_PPC64_COPY:
16683 case R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT:
16684 case R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT:
16685 case R_PPC64_JMP_IREL:
16686 case R_PPC64_RELATIVE:
16687 /* We shouldn't ever see these dynamic relocs in relocatable
16688 files. */
16689 /* Fall through. */
16690
16691 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16:
16692 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS:
16693 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA:
16694 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HI:
16695 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO:
16696 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO_DS:
16697 case R_PPC64_PLTREL32:
16698 case R_PPC64_PLTREL64:
16699 /* These ones haven't been implemented yet. */
16700
16701 info->callbacks->einfo
16702 /* xgettext:c-format */
16703 (_("%P: %pB: %s is not supported for `%pT'\n"),
16704 input_bfd,
16705 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name, sym_name);
16706
16707 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
16708 ret = FALSE;
16709 goto copy_reloc;
16710 }
16711
16712 /* Multi-instruction sequences that access the TOC can be
16713 optimized, eg. addis ra,r2,0; addi rb,ra,x;
16714 to nop; addi rb,r2,x; */
16715 switch (r_type)
16716 {
16717 default:
16718 break;
16719
16720 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
16721 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
16722 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
16723 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
16724 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HI:
16725 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
16726 /* These relocs would only be useful if building up an
16727 offset to later add to r2, perhaps in an indexed
16728 addressing mode instruction. Don't try to optimize.
16729 Unfortunately, the possibility of someone building up an
16730 offset like this or even with the HA relocs, means that
16731 we need to check the high insn when optimizing the low
16732 insn. */
16733 break;
16734
16735 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC:
16736 if (!unresolved_reloc)
16737 htab->notoc_plt = 1;
16738 /* Fall through. */
16739 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL:
16740 if (unresolved_reloc)
16741 {
16742 /* No plt entry. Make this into a direct call. */
16743 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
16744 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
16745 insn &= 1;
16746 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B_DOT | insn, p);
16747 if (r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL)
16748 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p + 4);
16749 unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc;
16750 r_type = R_PPC64_REL24;
16751 }
16752 break;
16753
16754 case R_PPC64_PLTSEQ_NOTOC:
16755 case R_PPC64_PLTSEQ:
16756 if (unresolved_reloc)
16757 {
16758 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
16759 goto nop_it;
16760 }
16761 break;
16762
16763 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC:
16764 if (!unresolved_reloc)
16765 htab->notoc_plt = 1;
16766 /* Fall through. */
16767 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34:
16768 if (unresolved_reloc)
16769 {
16770 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
16771 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, PNOP >> 32, p);
16772 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, PNOP, p + 4);
16773 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
16774 goto copy_reloc;
16775 }
16776 break;
16777
16778 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
16779 if (unresolved_reloc)
16780 {
16781 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
16782 goto nop_it;
16783 }
16784 /* Fall through. */
16785 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
16786 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
16787 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
16788 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
16789 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
16790 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
16791 if (htab->do_toc_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000
16792 && !ppc64_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->unexpected_toc_insn)
16793 {
16794 bfd_byte *p;
16795 nop_it:
16796 p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
16797 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
16798 goto copy_reloc;
16799 }
16800 break;
16801
16802 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO:
16803 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
16804 if (unresolved_reloc)
16805 {
16806 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
16807 goto nop_it;
16808 }
16809 /* Fall through. */
16810 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
16811 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
16812 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
16813 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
16814 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO:
16815 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
16816 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
16817 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
16818 if (htab->do_toc_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000
16819 && !ppc64_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->unexpected_toc_insn)
16820 {
16821 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
16822 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
16823 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 12u << 26 /* addic */)
16824 {
16825 /* Transform addic to addi when we change reg. */
16826 insn &= ~((0x3fu << 26) | (0x1f << 16));
16827 insn |= (14u << 26) | (2 << 16);
16828 }
16829 else
16830 {
16831 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
16832 insn |= 2 << 16;
16833 }
16834 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
16835 }
16836 break;
16837
16838 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
16839 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
16840 {
16841 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
16842 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
16843 if ((insn & ((0x3fu << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
16844 != ((15u << 26) | (13 << 16)) /* addis rt,13,imm */)
16845 /* xgettext:c-format */
16846 info->callbacks->minfo
16847 (_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"),
16848 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
16849 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name, insn);
16850 else
16851 {
16852 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
16853 goto copy_reloc;
16854 }
16855 }
16856 break;
16857
16858 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
16859 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
16860 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
16861 {
16862 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
16863 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
16864 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
16865 insn |= 13 << 16;
16866 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
16867 }
16868 break;
16869 }
16870
16871 /* Do any further special processing. */
16872 switch (r_type)
16873 {
16874 default:
16875 break;
16876
16877 case R_PPC64_REL16_HA:
16878 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA:
16879 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA:
16880 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA:
16881 case R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA:
16882 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA:
16883 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA:
16884 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA:
16885 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA:
16886 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
16887 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HA:
16888 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
16889 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
16890 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
16891 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
16892 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA:
16893 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA:
16894 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA:
16895 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA:
16896 /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol
16897 that's not actually defined anywhere. In that case,
16898 'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol
16899 alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link). */
16900 if (sec == NULL)
16901 break;
16902 /* Fall through. */
16903
16904 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
16905 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA:
16906 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
16907 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
16908 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
16909 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
16910 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
16911 /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set.
16912 Bits 0:15 are not used. */
16913 addend += 0x8000;
16914 break;
16915
16916 case R_PPC64_D34_HA30:
16917 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34:
16918 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34:
16919 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34:
16920 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34:
16921 if (sec != NULL)
16922 addend += 1ULL << 33;
16923 break;
16924
16925 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
16926 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
16927 case R_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
16928 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
16929 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
16930 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
16931 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
16932 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
16933 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
16934 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS:
16935 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO_DS:
16936 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS:
16937 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
16938 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS:
16939 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
16940 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
16941 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
16942 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
16943 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
16944 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
16945 mask = 3;
16946 /* If this reloc is against an lq, lxv, or stxv insn, then
16947 the value must be a multiple of 16. This is somewhat of
16948 a hack, but the "correct" way to do this by defining _DQ
16949 forms of all the _DS relocs bloats all reloc switches in
16950 this file. It doesn't make much sense to use these
16951 relocs in data, so testing the insn should be safe. */
16952 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (56u << 26)
16953 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (61u << 26) && (insn & 3) == 1))
16954 mask = 15;
16955 relocation += addend;
16956 addend = insn & (mask ^ 3);
16957 if ((relocation & mask) != 0)
16958 {
16959 relocation ^= relocation & mask;
16960 info->callbacks->einfo
16961 /* xgettext:c-format */
16962 (_("%H: error: %s not a multiple of %u\n"),
16963 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
16964 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name,
16965 mask + 1);
16966 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
16967 ret = FALSE;
16968 goto copy_reloc;
16969 }
16970 break;
16971 }
16972
16973 /* Dynamic relocs are not propagated for SEC_DEBUGGING sections
16974 because such sections are not SEC_ALLOC and thus ld.so will
16975 not process them. */
16976 howto = ppc64_elf_howto_table[(int) r_type];
16977 if (unresolved_reloc
16978 && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
16979 && h->elf.def_dynamic)
16980 && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
16981 rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
16982 {
16983 info->callbacks->einfo
16984 /* xgettext:c-format */
16985 (_("%H: unresolvable %s against `%pT'\n"),
16986 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
16987 howto->name,
16988 h->elf.root.root.string);
16989 ret = FALSE;
16990 }
16991
16992 /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a
16993 few insns have 16-bit unsigned values. Really, we should
16994 have different reloc types. */
16995 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont
16996 && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff
16997 && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
16998 {
16999 enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed;
17000
17001 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
17002 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */)
17003 complain = complain_overflow_bitfield;
17004 else if (howto->rightshift == 0
17005 ? ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */
17006 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */
17007 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */)
17008 : ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 29u << 26 /* andis */
17009 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 25u << 26 /* oris */
17010 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 27u << 26 /* xoris */))
17011 complain = complain_overflow_unsigned;
17012 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain)
17013 {
17014 alt_howto = *howto;
17015 alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain;
17016 howto = &alt_howto;
17017 }
17018 }
17019
17020 switch (r_type)
17021 {
17022 /* Split field relocs aren't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate. */
17023 case R_PPC64_D34:
17024 case R_PPC64_D34_LO:
17025 case R_PPC64_D34_HI30:
17026 case R_PPC64_D34_HA30:
17027 case R_PPC64_PCREL34:
17028 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
17029 case R_PPC64_TPREL34:
17030 case R_PPC64_DTPREL34:
17031 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD34:
17032 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD34:
17033 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL34:
17034 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL34:
17035 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34:
17036 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC:
17037 case R_PPC64_D28:
17038 case R_PPC64_PCREL28:
17039 if (rel->r_offset + 8 > input_section->size)
17040 r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
17041 else
17042 {
17043 relocation += addend;
17044 if (howto->pc_relative)
17045 relocation -= (rel->r_offset
17046 + input_section->output_offset
17047 + input_section->output_section->vma);
17048 relocation >>= howto->rightshift;
17049
17050 pinsn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
17051 pinsn <<= 32;
17052 pinsn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
17053
17054 pinsn &= ~howto->dst_mask;
17055 pinsn |= (((relocation << 16) | (relocation & 0xffff))
17056 & howto->dst_mask);
17057 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn >> 32, contents + rel->r_offset);
17058 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
17059 r = bfd_reloc_ok;
17060 if (howto->complain_on_overflow == complain_overflow_signed
17061 && (relocation + (1ULL << (howto->bitsize - 1))
17062 >= 1ULL << howto->bitsize))
17063 r = bfd_reloc_overflow;
17064 }
17065 break;
17066
17067 case R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA:
17068 if (rel->r_offset + 4 > input_section->size)
17069 r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
17070 else
17071 {
17072 relocation += addend;
17073 relocation -= (rel->r_offset
17074 + input_section->output_offset
17075 + input_section->output_section->vma);
17076 relocation = (bfd_signed_vma) relocation >> 16;
17077 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
17078 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
17079 insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15);
17080 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
17081 r = bfd_reloc_ok;
17082 if (relocation + 0x8000 > 0xffff)
17083 r = bfd_reloc_overflow;
17084 }
17085 break;
17086
17087 default:
17088 r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
17089 contents, rel->r_offset,
17090 relocation, addend);
17091 }
17092
17093 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
17094 {
17095 char *more_info = NULL;
17096 const char *reloc_name = howto->name;
17097
17098 if (reloc_dest != DEST_NORMAL)
17099 {
17100 more_info = bfd_malloc (strlen (reloc_name) + 8);
17101 if (more_info != NULL)
17102 {
17103 strcpy (more_info, reloc_name);
17104 strcat (more_info, (reloc_dest == DEST_OPD
17105 ? " (OPD)" : " (stub)"));
17106 reloc_name = more_info;
17107 }
17108 }
17109
17110 if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
17111 {
17112 /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow
17113 on a branch to zero when foo is undefined. */
17114 if (!warned
17115 && (reloc_dest == DEST_STUB
17116 || !(h != NULL
17117 && (h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
17118 || h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
17119 && is_branch_reloc (r_type))))
17120 info->callbacks->reloc_overflow (info, &h->elf.root,
17121 sym_name, reloc_name,
17122 orig_rel.r_addend,
17123 input_bfd, input_section,
17124 rel->r_offset);
17125 }
17126 else
17127 {
17128 info->callbacks->einfo
17129 /* xgettext:c-format */
17130 (_("%H: %s against `%pT': error %d\n"),
17131 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
17132 reloc_name, sym_name, (int) r);
17133 ret = FALSE;
17134 }
17135 if (more_info != NULL)
17136 free (more_info);
17137 }
17138 copy_reloc:
17139 if (wrel != rel)
17140 *wrel = *rel;
17141 }
17142
17143 if (wrel != rel)
17144 {
17145 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
17146 size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
17147
17148 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
17149 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
17150 if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
17151 {
17152 /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section. Leave
17153 one NONE reloc.
17154 ??? What is wrong with an empty section??? */
17155 rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
17156 deleted -= 1;
17157 }
17158 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
17159 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
17160 input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
17161 }
17162
17163 /* If we're emitting relocations, then shortly after this function
17164 returns, reloc offsets and addends for this section will be
17165 adjusted. Worse, reloc symbol indices will be for the output
17166 file rather than the input. Save a copy of the relocs for
17167 opd_entry_value. */
17168 if (is_opd && (info->emitrelocations || bfd_link_relocatable (info)))
17169 {
17170 bfd_size_type amt;
17171 amt = input_section->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela);
17172 rel = bfd_alloc (input_bfd, amt);
17173 BFD_ASSERT (ppc64_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->opd.relocs == NULL);
17174 ppc64_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->opd.relocs = rel;
17175 if (rel == NULL)
17176 return FALSE;
17177 memcpy (rel, relocs, amt);
17178 }
17179 return ret;
17180 }
17181
17182 /* Adjust the value of any local symbols in opd sections. */
17183
17184 static int
17185 ppc64_elf_output_symbol_hook (struct bfd_link_info *info,
17186 const char *name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
17187 Elf_Internal_Sym *elfsym,
17188 asection *input_sec,
17189 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
17190 {
17191 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
17192 long adjust;
17193 bfd_vma value;
17194
17195 if (h != NULL)
17196 return 1;
17197
17198 opd = get_opd_info (input_sec);
17199 if (opd == NULL || opd->adjust == NULL)
17200 return 1;
17201
17202 value = elfsym->st_value - input_sec->output_offset;
17203 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info))
17204 value -= input_sec->output_section->vma;
17205
17206 adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (value)];
17207 if (adjust == -1)
17208 return 2;
17209
17210 elfsym->st_value += adjust;
17211 return 1;
17212 }
17213
17214 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
17215 dynamic sections here. */
17216
17217 static bfd_boolean
17218 ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
17219 struct bfd_link_info *info,
17220 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
17221 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
17222 {
17223 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
17224 struct plt_entry *ent;
17225
17226 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
17227 if (htab == NULL)
17228 return FALSE;
17229
17230 if (!htab->opd_abi && !h->def_regular)
17231 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
17232 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
17233 {
17234 /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as
17235 defined in glink. Leave the value if there were
17236 any relocations where pointer equality matters
17237 (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to make
17238 function pointer comparisons work between an
17239 application and shared library), otherwise set it
17240 to zero. */
17241 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
17242 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
17243 sym->st_value = 0;
17244 else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
17245 {
17246 /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but
17247 that is better than breaking tests for a NULL
17248 function pointer. */
17249 sym->st_value = 0;
17250 }
17251 break;
17252 }
17253
17254 if (h->needs_copy
17255 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
17256 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
17257 && (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
17258 || h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro))
17259 {
17260 /* This symbol needs a copy reloc. Set it up. */
17261 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
17262 asection *srel;
17263 bfd_byte *loc;
17264
17265 if (h->dynindx == -1)
17266 abort ();
17267
17268 rela.r_offset = defined_sym_val (h);
17269 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC64_COPY);
17270 rela.r_addend = 0;
17271 if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
17272 srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
17273 else
17274 srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
17275 loc = srel->contents;
17276 loc += srel->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
17277 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
17278 }
17279
17280 return TRUE;
17281 }
17282
17283 /* Used to decide how to sort relocs in an optimal manner for the
17284 dynamic linker, before writing them out. */
17285
17286 static enum elf_reloc_type_class
17287 ppc64_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
17288 const asection *rel_sec,
17289 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
17290 {
17291 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
17292 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
17293
17294 if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt)
17295 return reloc_class_ifunc;
17296
17297 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rela->r_info);
17298 switch (r_type)
17299 {
17300 case R_PPC64_RELATIVE:
17301 return reloc_class_relative;
17302 case R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT:
17303 return reloc_class_plt;
17304 case R_PPC64_COPY:
17305 return reloc_class_copy;
17306 default:
17307 return reloc_class_normal;
17308 }
17309 }
17310
17311 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
17312
17313 static bfd_boolean
17314 ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
17315 struct bfd_link_info *info)
17316 {
17317 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
17318 bfd *dynobj;
17319 asection *sdyn;
17320
17321 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
17322 if (htab == NULL)
17323 return FALSE;
17324
17325 dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
17326 sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
17327
17328 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
17329 {
17330 Elf64_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
17331
17332 if (sdyn == NULL || htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
17333 abort ();
17334
17335 dyncon = (Elf64_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
17336 dynconend = (Elf64_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
17337 for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
17338 {
17339 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
17340 asection *s;
17341
17342 bfd_elf64_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
17343
17344 switch (dyn.d_tag)
17345 {
17346 default:
17347 continue;
17348
17349 case DT_PPC64_GLINK:
17350 s = htab->glink;
17351 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
17352 /* We stupidly defined DT_PPC64_GLINK to be the start
17353 of glink rather than the first entry point, which is
17354 what ld.so needs, and now have a bigger stub to
17355 support automatic multiple TOCs. */
17356 dyn.d_un.d_ptr += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE (htab) - 8 * 4;
17357 break;
17358
17359 case DT_PPC64_OPD:
17360 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".opd");
17361 if (s == NULL)
17362 continue;
17363 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
17364 break;
17365
17366 case DT_PPC64_OPT:
17367 if ((htab->do_multi_toc && htab->multi_toc_needed)
17368 || htab->notoc_plt)
17369 dyn.d_un.d_val |= PPC64_OPT_MULTI_TOC;
17370 if (htab->has_plt_localentry0)
17371 dyn.d_un.d_val |= PPC64_OPT_LOCALENTRY;
17372 break;
17373
17374 case DT_PPC64_OPDSZ:
17375 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".opd");
17376 if (s == NULL)
17377 continue;
17378 dyn.d_un.d_val = s->size;
17379 break;
17380
17381 case DT_PLTGOT:
17382 s = htab->elf.splt;
17383 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
17384 break;
17385
17386 case DT_JMPREL:
17387 s = htab->elf.srelplt;
17388 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
17389 break;
17390
17391 case DT_PLTRELSZ:
17392 dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
17393 break;
17394
17395 case DT_TEXTREL:
17396 if (htab->local_ifunc_resolver)
17397 info->callbacks->einfo
17398 (_("%X%P: text relocations and GNU indirect "
17399 "functions will result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
17400 else if (htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver)
17401 info->callbacks->einfo
17402 (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect "
17403 "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
17404 continue;
17405 }
17406
17407 bfd_elf64_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
17408 }
17409 }
17410
17411 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->elf.sgot->size != 0
17412 && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
17413 {
17414 /* Fill in the first entry in the global offset table.
17415 We use it to hold the link-time TOCbase. */
17416 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd,
17417 elf_gp (output_bfd) + TOC_BASE_OFF,
17418 htab->elf.sgot->contents);
17419
17420 /* Set .got entry size. */
17421 elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
17422 = 8;
17423 }
17424
17425 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
17426 && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
17427 {
17428 /* Set .plt entry size. */
17429 elf_section_data (htab->elf.splt->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
17430 = PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
17431 }
17432
17433 /* brlt is SEC_LINKER_CREATED, so we need to write out relocs for
17434 brlt ourselves if emitrelocations. */
17435 if (htab->brlt != NULL
17436 && htab->brlt->reloc_count != 0
17437 && !_bfd_elf_link_output_relocs (output_bfd,
17438 htab->brlt,
17439 elf_section_data (htab->brlt)->rela.hdr,
17440 elf_section_data (htab->brlt)->relocs,
17441 NULL))
17442 return FALSE;
17443
17444 if (htab->glink != NULL
17445 && htab->glink->reloc_count != 0
17446 && !_bfd_elf_link_output_relocs (output_bfd,
17447 htab->glink,
17448 elf_section_data (htab->glink)->rela.hdr,
17449 elf_section_data (htab->glink)->relocs,
17450 NULL))
17451 return FALSE;
17452
17453
17454 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
17455 && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0
17456 && htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
17457 && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
17458 htab->glink_eh_frame,
17459 htab->glink_eh_frame->contents))
17460 return FALSE;
17461
17462 /* We need to handle writing out multiple GOT sections ourselves,
17463 since we didn't add them to DYNOBJ. We know dynobj is the first
17464 bfd. */
17465 while ((dynobj = dynobj->link.next) != NULL)
17466 {
17467 asection *s;
17468
17469 if (!is_ppc64_elf (dynobj))
17470 continue;
17471
17472 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (dynobj)->got;
17473 if (s != NULL
17474 && s->size != 0
17475 && s->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr
17476 && !bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, s->output_section,
17477 s->contents, s->output_offset,
17478 s->size))
17479 return FALSE;
17480 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (dynobj)->relgot;
17481 if (s != NULL
17482 && s->size != 0
17483 && s->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr
17484 && !bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, s->output_section,
17485 s->contents, s->output_offset,
17486 s->size))
17487 return FALSE;
17488 }
17489
17490 return TRUE;
17491 }
17492
17493 #include "elf64-target.h"
17494
17495 /* FreeBSD support */
17496
17497 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
17498 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
17499
17500 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
17501 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf64_fbsd_vec
17502 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
17503 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf64-powerpc-freebsd"
17504
17505 #undef ELF_OSABI
17506 #define ELF_OSABI ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
17507
17508 #undef elf64_bed
17509 #define elf64_bed elf64_powerpc_fbsd_bed
17510
17511 #include "elf64-target.h"
This page took 0.504058 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.